SCPLC Half Year Results 2025 - Part 2

Source: RNS
RNS Number : 2973T
Standard Chartered PLC
31 July 2025
 

Standard Chartered PLC - Half Year Results 2025 - Part 2

Table of content

Risk review

02

Capital review

50

Statement of directors' responsibilities

56

Independent review report to Standard Chartered PLC

57

Financial statements

59

Notes to the financial statements

65

Other supplementary information

108

Shareholder information

118

Important notices

120

Glossary

122

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Unless another currency is specified, the word 'dollar' or symbol '$' in this document means US dollar and the word 'cent' or symbol 'c' means one-hundredth of one US dollar.

The information within Performance highlights to Capital review and Other supplementary information to Glossary is unreviewed.

Unless the context requires, within this document, 'China' refers to the People's Republic of China and, for the purposes of this document only, excludes Hong Kong Special Administrative Region (Hong Kong), Macau Special Administrative Region (Macau) and Taiwan. 'Korea' or 'South Korea' refers to the Republic of Korea.

Within the tables in this report, blank spaces indicate that the number is not disclosed, dashes indicate that the number is zero and nm stands for not meaningful. Standard Chartered PLC is incorporated in England and Wales with limited liability. Standard Chartered PLC is headquartered in London.

The Group's head office provides guidance on governance and regulatory standards. Standard Chartered PLC stock codes are: HKSE 02888 and LSE STAN.LN.

 

 

- page 01 -


 

Risk review and Capital review

Risk Index


Risk profile

Credit Risk


Basis of preparation


Credit risk overview


Impairment model


Staging of financial instruments


IFRS 9 Expected Credit Loss (ECL) principles and approaches


Summary of Credit Risk performance


Maximum exposure to Credit Risk


Analysis of financial instrument by stage


Credit quality analysis


•  Credit quality by client segment


•  Credit quality by key geography


Movement in gross exposures and credit impairment for loans and advances, debt securities, undrawn commitments and financial guarantees


Analysis of stage 2 balances


Credit impairment charge


Problem credit management and provisioning


•  Forborne and other modified loans by client segment


•  Forborne and other modified loans by key geography


Credit risk mitigation


•  Collateral held on loans and advances


•  Collateral - Corporate & Investment Banking


•  Collateral - Wealth & Retail Banking


•  Mortgage loan-to-value ratios by geography


•  Collateral and other credit enhancements possessed or called upon


•  Other Credit Risk mitigation


Other portfolio analysis


•  Credit quality by industry


•  Industry and retail products analysis of loans and advances by key geography


•  High-carbon sectors


•  Commercial real estate


•  Debt securities and other eligible bills


IFRS 9 ECL methodology


Traded Risk


Market Risk movements


Counterparty Credit Risk


Derivative financial instruments Credit Risk mitigation


Liquidity and Funding Risk


Liquidity and Funding Risk metrics


Liquidity analysis of the Group's balance sheet


Interest Rate Risk in the Banking Book


Operational and Technology Risk


Operational and Technology Risk profile


Other principal risks

Capital

Capital summary


•  Capital ratio


•  Capital base


•  Movement in total capital


Risk-weighted asset


Leverage ratio

The following parts of the Risk review and Capital review form part of these financial statements and are reviewed by the external auditors:

a) Risk review: Disclosures marked as 'reviewed' from the start of the 'Credit Risk' section to the end of other principal risks in the same section; and

b) Capital review: Tables marked as 'reviewed' from the start of 'Capital base' to the end of 'Movement in total capital', excluding 'Total risk-weighted assets'.

- page 02 -


Risk review

Credit Risk (reviewed)

Basis of preparation

Unless otherwise stated, the balance sheet and income statement information within this section is based on the financial booking location. The accounting policy for the presentation of geographic information has been changed in 2025 as set out in Note 1 to the financial statements, and prior period amounts have been re-presented in line with this change.

Loans and advances to customers and banks held at amortised cost in this 'Risk profile' section include reverse repurchase agreement balances held at amortised cost, per Note 15 Reverse repurchase and repurchase agreements including other similar secured lending and borrowing.

Credit Risk overview

Credit Risk is the potential for loss due to the failure of a counterparty to meet its agreed obligations to pay the Group. Credit exposures arise from both the banking and trading books.

Impairment model

IFRS 9 mandates an impairment model that requires the recognition of ECL on all financial debt instruments held at amortised cost, Fair Value through Other Comprehensive Income (FVOCI), undrawn loan commitments and financial guarantees.

Staging of financial instruments

Financial instruments that are not already credit-impaired are originated into stage 1 and a 12-month expected credit loss provision is recognised. Instruments will remain in stage 1 until they are repaid, unless they experience significant credit deterioration (stage 2) or they become credit-impaired (stage 3).

Instruments will transfer to stage 2 and a lifetime expected credit loss provision is recognised when there has been a significant change in the Credit Risk compared to what was expected at origination. The framework used to determine a Significant increase in Credit Risk (SICR) is set out below.

Stage 1

12-month ECL

Performing

Stage 2

Lifetime expected credit loss

Performing but has exhibited SICR

Stage 3

Credit-impaired

Non-performing

IFRS 9 ECL principles and approaches

The main methodology principles and approach adopted by the Group are set out in the following table. Refer to the 2024 Annual Report for the 'Application of lifetime ECL' on page 236, 'Sensitivity of ECL calculation to macroeconomic variables' on page 242, 'SICR' on page 244, 'Assessment of credit-impaired financial assets' on page 245 and 'Governance of Post Model Adjustments and application of expert credit judgement in respect of ECL' on page 246.

Title

Supplementary Information

Approach for determining ECL

•  IFRS 9 ECL methodology

Key assumptions and judgements in determining ECL

•  Incorporation of forward-looking information


•  Forecast of key macroeconomic variables underlying the ECL calculation and the impact of non-linearity


•  Impact of multiple economic scenarios


•  Judgemental adjustments and management overlays

Transfers between stages

•  Movement in gross exposures and credit impairment

Modified financial assets

•  Forborne and other modified loans



- page 03 -


 

Summary of Credit Risk Performance

Maximum Exposure

The Group's on-balance sheet maximum exposure to Credit Risk increased by $50.4 billion to $873.8 billion (31 December 2024: $823.4 billion). Cash and balances at Central banks increased by $16.7 billion to $80.2 billion (31 December 2024: $63.4 billion) due to increased placements. Loans to banks held at amortised cost decreased by $1.2 billion to $42.4 billion (31 December 2024: $43.6 billion). Debt securities (not held at fair value through profit or loss) increased by $14.1 billion to $157.6 billion (31 December 2024: $143.6 billion) as exposures increased due to investments in high quality liquid assets. Loans and advances to customers increased by $5.7 billion to $286.7 billion (31 December 2024: $281.0 billion). Fair Value through profit and loss increased by $22.0 billion to $194.1 billion (31 December 2024: $172 billion), largely due to an increase in debt securities and reverse repos. Off-balance sheet instruments increased by $23.7 billion to $296.9 billion (31 December 2024: $273.2 billion), due to an increase in undrawn commitments, financial guarantees and other equivalents. Derivative financial instruments decreased by $17.2 billion to $64.2 billion (31 December 2024: $81.5 billion) mainly due to the weakening of the US dollar.

Loans and Advances

94 per cent (31 December 2024: 94 per cent) of the Group's gross loans and advances to customers remain in stage 1 at $273.2 billion (31 December 2024: $269.1 billion), reflecting our continued focus on high-quality origination. For WRB, stage 1 balances increased by $7.3 billion to $124.3 billion (31 December 2024: $117 billion), mainly due to a $5.2 billion increase in the mortgage portfolio across Korea, Taiwan and Singapore and $2.5 billion increase in Secured wealth products due to the higher demand in Singapore. For CIB, stage 1 balances remained stable at $129.1 billion (31 December 2024: $128.7 billion). For Central and other items, stage 1 balances decreased by $3.7 billion to $18.3 billion (31 December 2024: $22 billion) due to exposure reductions in the Government sector.

Stage 2 loans and advances to customers increased by $1.9 billion to $12.5 billion (31 December 2024: $10.6 billion). For WRB, stage 2 balances remained stable at $2.1 billion (31 December 2024: $1.9 billion). For CIB, stage 2 balances increased by $1.7 billion to $10.4 billion (31 December 2024: $8.6 billion), due to exposure increases to Sovereign related and Commercial real estate clients.

Stage 3 loans and advances decreased by $0.1 billion to $6.1 billion (31 December 2024: $6.2 billion) due to repayments in CIB, and in Central and other items, which was offset by an increase in WRB mainly due to secured lending. While the WRB stage 3 cover ratio before collateral remained stable at 47.0 per cent (31 December 2024: 46.9 per cent), the stage 3 cover ratio after collateral increased to 85.6 per cent (31 December 2024: 83.1 per cent) driven by the increase of credit impairment provisions and collateral value.

Analysis of Stage 2

The key SICR driver which caused exposures to be classified as stage 2 remains an increase in probability of default (PD). The proportion of CIB exposures in stage 2 increased due to PD driven changes. In WRB, the exposures in stage 2 loans with more than 30 days past due remained stable at $0.2 billion (31 December 2024: $0.2 billion). The 'Others' category includes exposures where origination data is incomplete and the exposures are allocated into stage 2.

Credit Impairment charges

The Group's ongoing credit impairment was a net charge of $336 million (30 June 2024: $240 million).

WRB contributed a net charge of $332 million (30 June 2024: $267 million), driven by a high interest rate environment impacting repayments on unsecured portfolio as well as growth in Indonesia partnerships. CIB contributed to a net release of $14 million (30 June 2024: $54 million release) due to $48 million stage 3 releases from the sovereign upgrade of Sri Lanka foreign currency exposures. The non-linearity impact increased impairment charges by $34 million in H1 2025 and $15 million from June 2024, to $77 million (31 December 2024: $43 million; 30 June 2024: $62 million). This reflects an increased probability weighting of the overall downside scenarios from 32 per cent to 45 per cent, given heightened levels of tariffs and geopolitical uncertainty.



- page 04 -


 

Commercial Real Estate (CRE)

The Group provides loans to CRE counterparties of which $9.5 billion is to counterparties in the CIB segment where the source of repayment is substantially derived from rental or sale of real estate and is secured by real estate collateral. The remaining CRE loans comprise working capital loans to real estate corporates, loans with non-property collateral, unsecured loans and loans to real estate entities of diversified conglomerates. The average LTV ratio of the performing book CRE portfolio has increased to 55 per cent (31 December 2024: 54 per cent). The proportion of loans with an LTV greater than 80 per cent has increased to 5 per cent (31 December 2024: 4 per cent).

China CRE

Total exposure to China CRE was stable at $1.9 billion (31 December 2024: $2.0 billion). The proportion of credit impaired exposures increased to 73 per cent (31 December 2024: 70 per cent) due to a stage 3 downgrade during the period. Stage 3 provision coverage increased to 89 per cent (31 December 2024: 87 per cent), reflecting increased provision charges during the period. The proportion of the loan book rated as Higher risk decreased to 1.8 per cent (31 December 2024: 2.8 per cent) mainly due to downgrades to stage 3 during the period.

The Group continues to hold a judgemental management overlay, which decreased by $12.0 million to $58.0 million (31 December 2024: $70.0 million), reflecting changes in exposure during the period.

The Group is further indirectly exposed to China CRE through its associate investment in China Bohai Bank.

High carbon sectors

Total net on-balance sheet exposure to high carbon sectors increased by $1.9 billion to $27.2 billion (31 December 2024: $25.4 billion). This was driven by exposure increases to portfolios in Oil and Gas at $7.7 billion (31 December 2024: $6.4 billion), CRE at $4.3 billion (31 December 2024: $4.2 billion) and Power at $5.6 billion (31 December 2024: $4.8 billion). The Group monitors the lending to these portfolios against each sector's carbon budget and interim 2030 net zero targets.



- page 05 -


 

Maximum exposure to Credit Risk (reviewed)

The table below presents the Group's maximum exposure to Credit Risk for its on-balance sheet and off-balance sheet financial instruments as at 30 June 2025, before and after taking into account any collateral held or other Credit Risk mitigation.


30.06.25

31.12.24

Maximum exposure
$million

Credit risk management

Net Exposure
$million

Maximum exposure
$million

Credit risk management

Net exposure
$million

Collateral8
$million

Master netting agreements
$million

Collateral8
$million

Master netting agreements
$million

On-balance sheet









Cash and balances at central banks

80,165

-

-

80,165

63,447

-

-

63,447

Loans and advances to banks1

42,386

4,250

-

38,136

43,593

2,946

-

40,647

of which - reverse repurchase agreements and other similar secured lending7

4,250

4,250

-

-

2,946

2,946

-

-










Loans and advances to customers1

286,731

125,538

-

161,193

281,032

119,047

-

161,985

of which - reverse repurchase agreements and other similar secured lending7

4,189

4,189

-

-

9,660

9,660

-

-

Investment securities - Debt securities and other eligible bills2

157,617

-

-

157,617

143,562

-

-

143,562










Fair value through profit or loss3, 7

194,073

90,333

-

103,740

172,031

86,195

-

85,836

Loans and advances to banks

2,393

-

-

2,393

2,213

-

-

2,213

Loans and advances to customers

8,119

-

-

8,119

7,084

-

-

7,084

Reverse repurchase agreements and
other similar lending
7

90,333

90,333

-

-

86,195

86,195

-

-

Investment securities - Debt securities
and other eligible bills
2

93,228

-

-

93,228

76,539

-

-

76,539

Derivative financial instruments4, 7

64,225

12,831

48,308

3,086

81,472

15,005

60,280

6,187

Accrued income

2,612

-

-

2,612

2,776

-

-

2,776

Assets held for sale9

622

-

-

622

889

-

-

889

Other assets5

45,372

-

-

45,372

34,585

-

-

34,585

Total balance sheet

873,803

232,952

48,308

592,543

823,387

223,193

60,280

539,914

Off-balance sheet6









Undrawn Commitments

192,947

3,503

-

189,444

182,529

2,489

-

180,040

Financial Guarantees and other equivalents

103,959

2,046

-

101,913

90,632

1,807

-

88,825

Total off-balance sheet

296,906

5,549

-

291,357

273,161

4,296

-

268,865

Total

1,170,709

238,501

48,308

883,900

1,096,548

227,489

60,280

808,779

1   Amounts are net of ECL provisions. An analysis of credit quality is set out in the credit quality analysis section. Further details of collateral held by client segment and stage are set out in the collateral analysis section. The Group also has credit mitigation through Credit Linked Notes as set out below.

2   Excludes equity and other investments of $971 million (31 December 2024: $994 million). Further details are set out in Note 13 financial instruments

3   Excludes equity and other investments of $7,450 million (31 December 2024: $5,486 million). Further details are set out in Note 13 financial instruments

4   The Group enters into master netting agreements, which in the event of default result in a single amount owed by or to the counterparty through netting the sum of the positive and negative mark-to-market values of applicable derivative transactions

5   Other assets include Hong Kong certificates of indebtedness, cash collateral, and acceptances, in addition to unsettled trades and other financial assets

6   Excludes ECL provisions of $236 million (31 December 2024: $255 million) which are reported under Provisions for liabilities and charges

7   Collateral capped at maximum exposure (over-collateralised)

8   Adjusted for over-collateralisation, which has been determined with reference to the drawn and undrawn component as this best reflects the effect on the amount arising from expected credit losses

9   The amount is after ECL provisions. Further details are set out in Note 20 Assets held for sale and associated liabilities



- page 06 -


 

Analysis of financial instruments by stage (reviewed)

The table below presents the gross and credit impairment balances by stage for the Group's amortised cost and FVOCI financial instruments as at 30 June 2025.


30.06.25

Stage 1

Stage 2

Stage 3

Total

Gross balance1
$million

Total credit impairment
$million

Net carrying value
$million

Gross balance1
$million

Total credit impairment
$million

Net carrying value
$million

Gross balance1
$million

Total credit impairment
$million

Net carrying value
$million

Gross balance1
$million

Total credit impairment
$million

Net carrying value
$million

Cash and balances at central banks

79,158

-

79,158

417

(3)

414

603

(10)

593

80,178

(13)

80,165

Loans and advances
to banks (amortised cost)

41,613

(6)

41,607

737

(2)

735

48

(4)

44

42,398

(12)

42,386

Loans and advances to customers (amortised cost)

273,155

(553)

272,602

12,520

(465)

12,055

6,136

(4,062)

2,074

291,811

(5,080)

286,731

Debt securities and other eligible bills5

156,264

(29)


1,059

(7)


306

(6)


157,629

(42)


Amortised cost

55,128

(11)

55,117

41

(1)

40

53

-

53

55,222

(12)

55,210

FVOCI2

101,136

(18)


1,018

(6)


253

(6)


102,407

(30)

-

Accrued income (amortised cost)4

2,612


2,612



-



-

2,612

-

2,612

Assets held for sale4

556

-

556

62

-

62

45

(41)

4

663

(41)

622

Other assets

45,372

-

45,372

-

-

-

7

(7)

-

45,379

(7)

45,372

Undrawn commitments3

188,364

(60)


4,546

(37)


37

(1)


192,947

(98)


Financial guarantees,
trade credits
and irrevocable letter of credits
3

101,740

(16)


1,794

(16)


425

(106)


103,959

(138)


Total

888,834

(664)


21,135

(530)


7,607

(4,237)


917,576

(5,431)


1   Gross carrying amount for off-balance sheet refers to notional values

2   These instruments are held at fair value on the balance sheet. The ECL provision in respect of debt securities measured at FVOCI is held within the OCI reserve

3   These are off-balance sheet instruments. Only the ECL is recorded on-balance sheet as a financial liability and therefore there is no 'net carrying amount'. ECL allowances on off-balance sheet instruments are held as liability provisions to the extent that the drawn and undrawn components of loan exposures can be separately identified. Otherwise they will be reported against the drawn component

4   Stage 1 ECL is not material

5   Stage 3 gross includes $289 million originated credit-impaired debt securities with impairment of $6 million

 

- page 07 -


 



 


31.12.24

Stage 1

Stage 2

Stage 3

Total

Gross balance1
$million

Total credit impairment
$million

Net carrying value
$million

Gross balance1
$million

Total credit impairment
$million

Net carrying value
$million

Gross balance1
$million

Total credit impairment
$million

Net carrying value
$million

Gross balance1
$million

Total credit impairment
$million

Net carrying value
$million

Cash and balances at central banks

62,597

-

62,597

432

(4)

428

426

(4)

422

63,455

(8)

63,447

Loans and advances
to banks (amortised cost)

43,208

(10)

43,198

318

(1)

317

83

(5)

78

43,609

(16)

43,593

Loans and advances to customers (amortised cost)

269,102

(483)

268,619

10,631

(473)

10,158

6,203

(3,948)

2,255

285,936

(4,904)

281,032

Debt securities and other eligible bills5

141,862

(23)


1,614

(4)


103

(2)


143,579

(29)


Amortised cost

54,637

(15)

54,622

475

(2)

473

42

-

42

55,154

(17)

55,137

FVOCI2

87,225

(8)


1,139

(2)


61

(2)


88,425

(12)


Accrued income (amortised cost)4

2,776


2,776



-



-

2,776

-

2,776

Assets held for sale4

840

(7)

833

38

-

38

58

(45)

13

936

(52)

884

Other assets

34,585

-

34,585

-

-

-

3

(3)

-

34,588

(3)

34,585

Undrawn commitments3

178,516

(50)


4,006

(52)


7

(1)


182,529

(103)


Financial guarantees,
trade credits
and irrevocable letter of credits
3

87,991

(16)


2,038

(7)


603

(129)


90,632

(152)


Total

821,477

(589)


19,077

(541)


7,486

(4,137)


848,040

(5,267)


1   Gross carrying amount for off-balance sheet refers to notional values

2   These instruments are held at fair value on the balance sheet. The ECL provision in respect of debt securities measured at FVOCI is held within the OCI reserve

3   These are off-balance sheet instruments. Only the ECL is recorded on-balance sheet as a financial liability and therefore there is no 'net carrying amount'. ECL allowances on off-balance sheet instruments are held as liability provisions to the extent that the drawn and undrawn components of loan exposures can be separately identified. Otherwise they will be reported against the drawn component

4   Stage 1 ECL is not material

5   Stage 3 gross includes $59 million originated credit-impaired debt securities with impairment of $Nil million

Credit quality analysis (reviewed)

Credit quality by client segment

For CIB, exposures are analysed by credit grade (CG), which plays a central role in the quality assessment and monitoring of risk. All loans are assigned a CG, which is reviewed periodically and amended in light of changes in the borrower's circumstances or behaviour. CGs 1 to 12 are assigned to stage 1 and stage 2 (performing) clients or accounts, while CGs 13 and 14 are assigned to stage 3 (credit-impaired) clients. Consumer and Business Banking portfolios are analysed by days past due and Private Banking by the type of collateral held.

Mapping of credit quality

The Group uses the following internal risk mapping to determine the credit quality for loans.

Credit quality description

Corporate & Investment Banking

Private Banking1

Wealth & Retail Banking4

Internal grade mapping

S&P external ratings equivalent

Regulatory PD range (%)

Internal ratings

Internal grade mapping

Strong

1A to 5B

AAA/AA+ to BBB-/ BB+2

0 to 0.425

Class I and Class IV

Current loans (no past dues nor impaired)

Satisfactory

6A to 11C

BB to CCC+3

0.426 to 15.75

Class II and Class III

Loans past due till 29 days

Higher risk

Grade 12

CCC+ to C

15.751 to 99.999

Stressed Assets Group (SAG) Managed

Past due loans 30 days and over till 90 days

1   For Private Banking, classes of risk represent the type of collateral held. Class I represents facilities with liquid collateral, such as cash and marketable securities. Class II represents unsecured/partially secured facilities and those with illiquid collateral, such as equity in private enterprises. Class III represents facilities with residential or commercial real estate collateral. Class IV covers margin trading facilities

2   Banks' rating: AAA/AA+ to BB+/BB. Sovereigns' rating: AAA to BB+

3   Banks' rating: BB to 'CCC+ to C'. Sovereigns' rating: BB+/BB to B-/CCC+

4   Wealth & Retail Banking excludes Private Banking. Medium enterprise clients within Business Banking are managed using the same internal credit grades as CIB



- page 08 -


 

The table below sets out the gross loans and advances held at amortised cost, ECL provisions and expected credit loss coverage by business segment and stage. ECL coverage represents the ECL reported for each segment and stage as a proportion of the gross loan balance for each segment and stage.

Loans and advances by client segment (reviewed)

Amortised cost

30.06.25

Banks
$million

Customers

Undrawn commitments
$million

Financial Guarantees
$million

Corporate & Investment Banking
$million

Wealth & Retail Banking
$million

Ventures
$million

Central &
other items
$million

Customer Total
$million

Stage 1

41,613

129,064

124,273

1,549

18,269

273,155

188,364

101,740

- Strong

28,979

91,162

118,929

1,528

17,799

229,418

171,907

66,028

- Satisfactory

12,634

37,902

5,344

21

470

43,737

16,457

35,712

Stage 2

737

10,374

2,078

47

21

12,520

4,546

1,794

- Strong

41

1,888

1,563

30

-

3,481

1,144

471

- Satisfactory

263

6,845

146

6

-

6,997

3,133

990

- Higher risk

433

1,641

369

11

21

2,042

269

333

Of which (stage 2):









 - Less than 30 days past due

-

118

146

6

-

270

-

-

 - More than 30 days past due

2

57

369

11

-

437

-

-

Stage 3, credit-impaired financial assets

48

4,421

1,701

14

-

6,136

37

425

Gross balance¹

42,398

143,859

128,052

1,610

18,290

291,811

192,947

103,959

Stage 1

(6)

(124)

(403)

(26)

-

(553)

(60)

(16)

- Strong

(3)

(49)

(328)

(24)

-

(401)

(34)

(7)

- Satisfactory

(3)

(75)

(75)

(2)

-

(152)

(26)

(9)

Stage 2

(2)

(306)

(141)

(18)

-

(465)

(37)

(16)

- Strong

-

(6)

(65)

(11)

-

(82)

(4)

-

- Satisfactory

-

(209)

(38)

(2)

-

(249)

(24)

(5)

- Higher risk

(2)

(91)

(38)

(5)

-

(134)

(9)

(11)

Of which (stage 2):









 - Less than 30 days past due

-

(11)

(38)

(2)

-

(51)

-

-

 - More than 30 days past due

-

-

(38)

(5)

-

(43)

-

-

Stage 3, credit-impaired financial assets

(4)

(3,251)

(800)

(11)

-

(4,062)

(1)

(106)

Total credit impairment

(12)

(3,681)

(1,344)

(55)

-

(5,080)

(98)

(138)

Net carrying value

42,386

140,178

126,708

1,555

18,290

286,731



Stage 1

0.0%

0.1%

0.3%

1.7%

0.0%

0.2%

0.0%

0.0%

- Strong

0.0%

0.1%

0.3%

1.6%

0.0%

0.2%

0.0%

0.0%

- Satisfactory

0.0%

0.2%

1.4%

9.5%

0.0%

0.3%

0.2%

0.0%

Stage 2

0.3%

2.9%

6.8%

38.3%

0.0%

3.7%

0.8%

0.9%

- Strong

0.0%

0.3%

4.2%

36.7%

0.0%

2.4%

0.3%

0.0%

- Satisfactory

0.0%

3.1%

26.0%

33.3%

0.0%

3.6%

0.8%

0.5%

- Higher risk

0.5%

5.5%

10.3%

45.5%

0.0%

6.6%

3.3%

3.3%

Of which (stage 2):









 - Less than 30 days past due

0.0%

9.3%

26.0%

33.3%

0.0%

18.9%

0.0%

0.0%

 - More than 30 days past due

0.0%

0.0%

10.3%

45.5%

0.0%

9.8%

0.0%

0.0%

Stage 3, credit-impaired financial assets (S3)

8.3%

73.5%

47.0%

78.6%

0.0%

66.2%

2.7%

24.9%

- Stage 3 Collateral

-

294

656

-

-

950

-

37

- Stage 3 Cover ratio (after collateral)

8.3%

80.2%

85.6%

78.6%

0.0%

81.7%

2.7%

33.6%

Cover ratio

0.0%

2.6%

1.0%

3.4%

0.0%

1.7%

0.1%

0.1%

Fair value through profit or loss









Performing

36,958

63,870

5

-

-

63,875



- Strong

32,385

44,257

4

-

-

44,261



- Satisfactory

4,468

19,524

1

-

-

19,525



- Higher risk

105

89

-

-

-

89



Defaulted (CG13-14)

-

12

-

-

-

12



Gross balance (FVTPL)2

36,958

63,882

5

-

-

63,887



Net carrying value (incl FVTPL)

79,344

204,060

126,713

1,555

18,290

350,618



1   Loans and advances includes reverse repurchase agreements and other similar secured lending of $4,189 million under Customers and of $4,250 million under Banks, held at amortised cost

2   Loans and advances includes reverse repurchase agreements and other similar secured lending of $55,768 million under Customers and of $34,565 million under Banks, held at fair value through profit or loss



- page 09 -


 

Amortised cost

31.12.24

Banks
$million

Customers

Undrawn commitments
$million

Financial Guarantees
$million

Corporate & Investment Banking
$million

Wealth & Retail Banking
$million

Ventures
$million

Central &
other items
$million

Customer Total
$million

Stage 1

43,208

128,746

117,015

1,383

21,958

269,102

178,516

87,991

- Strong

31,239

90,725

111,706

1,367

21,540

225,338

162,574

56,070

- Satisfactory

11,969

38,021

5,309

16

418

43,764

15,942

31,921

Stage 2

318

8,643

1,905

48

35

10,631

4,006

2,038

- Strong

8

1,229

1,413

31

-

2,673

994

471

- Satisfactory

125

6,665

155

6

-

6,826

2,862

1,403

- Higher risk

185

749

337

11

35

1,132

150

164

Of which (stage 2):









 - Less than 30 days past due

-

55

155

6

-

216

-

-

 - More than 30 days past due

2

7

337

11

-

355

-

-

Stage 3, credit-impaired financial assets

83

4,476

1,617

12

98

6,203

7

603

Gross balance¹

43,609

141,865

120,537

1,443

22,091

285,936

182,529

90,632

Stage 1

(10)

(80)

(383)

(20)

-

(483)

(50)

(16)

- Strong

(7)

(28)

(325)

(18)

-

(371)

(33)

(7)

- Satisfactory

(3)

(52)

(58)

(2)

-

(112)

(17)

(9)

Stage 2

(1)

(303)

(147)

(23)

-

(473)

(52)

(7)

- Strong

-

(41)

(70)

(14)

-

(125)

(10)

-

- Satisfactory

(1)

(218)

(32)

(3)

-

(253)

(32)

(4)

- Higher risk

-

(44)

(45)

(6)

-

(95)

(10)

(3)

Of which (stage 2):









- Less than 30 days past due

-

(1)

(32)

(3)

-

(36)

-

-

- More than 30 days past due

-

-

(45)

(6)

-

(51)

-

-

Stage 3, credit-impaired financial assets

(5)

(3,178)

(759)

(11)

-

(3,948)

(1)

(129)

Total credit impairment

(16)

(3,561)

(1,289)

(54)

-

(4,904)

(103)

(152)

Net carrying value

43,593

138,304

119,248

1,389

22,091

281,032

-

-

Stage 1

0.0%

0.1%

0.3%

1.4%

0.0%

0.2%

0.0%

0.0%

- Strong

0.0%

0.0%

0.3%

1.3%

0.0%

0.2%

0.0%

0.0%

- Satisfactory

0.0%

0.1%

1.1%

12.5%

0.0%

0.3%

0.1%

0.0%

Stage 2

0.3%

3.6%

7.7%

47.9%

0.0%

4.4%

1.3%

0.3%

- Strong

0.0%

3.3%

5.0%

45.2%

0.0%

4.7%

1.0%

0.0%

- Satisfactory

0.8%

3.3%

20.6%

50.0%

0.0%

3.7%

1.1%

0.3%

- Higher risk

0.0%

5.9%

13.4%

54.5%

0.0%

8.4%

6.7%

1.8%

Of which (stage 2):









- Less than 30 days past due

0.0%

1.8%

20.6%

50.0%

0.0%

16.7%

0.0%

0.0%

- More than 30 days past due

0.0%

0.0%

13.4%

54.5%

0.0%

14.4%

0.0%

0.0%

Stage 3, credit-impaired financial assets (S3)

6.0%

71.0%

46.9%

91.7%

0.0%

63.6%

14.3%

21.4%

- Stage 3 Collateral

1

297

584

-

-

881

-

46

- Stage 3 Cover ratio (after collateral)

7.2%

77.6%

83.1%

91.7%

0.0%

77.8%

14.3%

29.0%

Cover ratio

0.0%

2.5%

1.1%

3.7%

0.0%

1.7%

0.1%

0.2%

Fair value through profit or loss









Performing

36,967

58,506

6

-

-

58,512



- Strong

30,799

38,084

3

-

-

38,087



- Satisfactory

6,158

20,314

3

-

-

20,317



- Higher risk

10

108

-

-

-

108



Defaulted (CG13-14)

-

13

-

-

-

13



Gross balance (FVTPL)2

36,967

58,519

6

-

-

58,525



Net carrying value (incl FVTPL)

80,560

196,823

119,254

1,389

22,091

339,557



1   Loans and advances includes reverse repurchase agreements and other similar secured lending of $9,660 million under Customers and of $2,946 million under Banks, held at amortised cost

2   Loans and advances includes reverse repurchase agreements and other similar secured lending of $51,441 million under Customers and of $34,754 million under Banks, held at fair value through profit or loss



- page 10 -


 

Loans and advances by client segment credit quality analysis

Credit grade

Regulatory 1-year
PD range (%)

S&P external ratings equivalent

30.06.25

Corporate & Investment Banking and Central & other items

Gross

Credit impairment

Stage 1
$million

Stage 2
$million

Stage 3
$million

Total
$million

Stage 1
$million

Stage 2
$million

Stage 3
$million

Total
$million

Strong



 108,961

 1,888

-

 110,849

 (49)

 (6)

-

 (55)

1A-2B

0-0.045

A+ and above

 30,153

 36

-

 30,189

 (1)

-

-

 (1)

3A-4A

0.046-0.110

A/A- to BBB+/BBB

 34,562

 544

-

 35,106

 (7)

-

-

 (7)

4B-5B

0.111-0.425

BBB to BBB-/BB+

 44,246

 1,308

-

 45,554

 (41)

 (6)

-

 (47)

Satisfactory



 38,372

 6,845

-

 45,217

 (75)

 (209)

-

 (284)

6A-7B

0.426-1.350

BB+/BB to BB-

 25,061

 1,643

-

 26,704

 (28)

 (13)

-

 (41)

8A-9B

1.351-4.000

BB-/B+ to B

 8,524

 3,005

-

 11,529

 (26)

 (166)

-

 (192)

10A-11C

4.001-15.75

B/B- to B-/CCC+

 4,787

 2,197

-

 6,984

 (21)

 (30)

-

 (51)

Higher risk



-

 1,662

-

 1,662

-

 (91)

-

 (91)

12

15.751-99.999

CCC/C

-

 1,662

-

 1,662

-

 (91)

-

 (91)

Credit-impaired



-

-

 4,421

 4,421

-

-

 (3,251)

 (3,251)

13-14

100

Defaulted

-

-

 4,421

 4,421

-

-

 (3,251)

 (3,251)

Total



 147,333

 10,395

 4,421

 162,149

 (124)

 (306)

 (3,251)

 (3,681)

 




31.12.24

Strong



112,265

1,229

-

113,494

(28)

(41)

-

(69)

1A-2B

0-0.045

A+ and above

32,160

31

-

32,191

(2)

-

-

(2)

3A-4A

0.046-0.110

A/A- to BBB+/BBB

40,712

524

-

41,236

(8)

(33)

-

(41)

4B-5B

0.111-0.425

BBB to BBB-/BB+

39,393

674

-

40,067

(18)

(8)

-

(26)

Satisfactory



38,439

6,665

-

45,104

(52)

(218)

-

(270)

6A-7B

0.426-1.350

BB+/BB to BB-

24,928

2,677

-

27,605

(21)

(24)

-

(45)

8A-9B

1.351-4.000

BB-/B+ to B

9,514

2,618

-

12,132

(20)

(169)

-

(189)

10A-11C

4.001-5.75

B/B- to B-/CCC+

3,997

1,370

-

5,367

(11)

(25)

-

(36)

Higher risk



-

784

-

784

-

(44)

-

(44)

12

15.751-99.999

CCC/C

-

784

-

784

-

(44)

-

(44)

Credit-impaired



-

-

4,574

4,574

-

-

(3,178)

(3,178)

13-14

100

Defaulted

-

-

4,574

4,574

-

-

(3,178)

(3,178)

Total



150,704

8,678

4,574

163,956

(80)

(303)

(3,178)

(3,561)

 



- page 11 -


 

Undrawn commitment and financial guarantees - by client segment credit quality

Credit grade

Regulatory 1-year
PD range (%)

S&P external ratings equivalent

30.06.25

Corporate & Investment Banking and Central & other items

Notional

Credit impairment

Stage 1 $million

Stage 2 $million

Stage 3 $million

Total $million

Stage 1 $million

Stage 2 $million

Stage 3 $million

Total $million

Strong



160,041

1,392

-

161,433

(25)

(1)

-

(26)

1A-2B

0-0.045

A+ and above

34,283

252

-

34,535

(1)

-

-

(1)

3A-4A

0.046-0.110

A/A- to BBB+/BBB

58,220

594

-

58,814

(4)

-

-

(4)

4B-5B

0.111-0.425

BBB to BBB-/BB+

67,538

546

-

68,084

(20)

(1)

-

(21)

Satisfactory



50,662

4,059

-

54,721

(31)

(27)

-

(58)

6A-7B

0.426-1.350

BB+/BB to BB-

39,644

1,435

-

41,079

(18)

(6)

-

(24)

8A-9B

1.351-4.000

BB-/B+ to B

8,070

2,030

-

10,100

(9)

(14)

-

(23)

10A-11C

4.001-15.75

B/B- to B-/CCC+

2,948

594

-

3,542

(4)

(7)

-

(11)

Higher risk



-

572

-

572

-

(18)

-

(18)

12

15.751-99.999

CCC+/C

-

572

-

572

-

(18)

-

(18)

Credit-impaired



-

-

450

450

-

-

(107)

(107)

13-14

100

Defaulted

-

-

450

450

-

-

(107)

(107)

Total



210,703

6,023

450

217,176

(56)

(46)

(107)

(209)

 




31.12.24

Strong



 140,733

 1,265

-

 141,998

 (22)

 (6)

-

 (28)

1A-2B

0-0.045

A+ and above

 29,623

 280

-

 29,903

 (1)

-

-

 (1)

3A-4A

0.046-0.110

A/A- to BBB+/BBB

 53,568

 492

-

 54,060

 (4)

-

-

 (4)

4B-5B

0.111-0.425

BBB to BBB-/BB+

 57,542

 493

-

 58,035

 (17)

 (6)

-

 (23)

Satisfactory



 46,394

 4,200

-

 50,594

 (23)

 (33)

-

 (56)

6A-7B

0.426-1.350

BB+/BB to BB-

 2,544

 1,065

-

 3,609

 (4)

 (6)

-

 (10)

8A-9B

1.351-4.000

BB-/B+ to B

 30,438

 1,162

-

 31,600

 (11)

 (16)

-

 (27)

10A-11C

4.001-15.75

B/B- to B-/CCC+

 13,412

 1,973

-

 15,385

 (8)

 (11)

-

 (19)

Higher risk



-

 286

-

 286

-

 (11)

-

 (11)

12

15.751-99.999

CCC+/C

-

 286

-

 286

-

 (11)

-

 (11)

Credit-impaired



-

-

 593

 593

-

-

 (129)

 (129)

13-14

100

Defaulted

-

-

 593

 593

-

-

 (129)

 (129)

Total



 187,127

 5,751

 593

 193,471

 (45)

 (50)

 (129)

 (224)

 



- page 12 -


 

Loans and advances analysis by client segment, credit quality and key geography


Corporate & Investment Banking and Central & other items

30.06.25

Gross

Credit impairment

Stage 1

Stage 2

Stage 3

Stage 1

Stage 2

Stage 3

Total
Coverage
%

Strong $million

Satis-factory $million

Total $million

Strong $million

Satis-factory $million

Higher Risk $million

Total $million

De-faulted $million

Total $million

Strong $million

Satis-factory $million

Total $million

Strong $million

Satis-factory $million

Higher Risk $million

Total $million

Im-paired $million

Total $million

Hong Kong

28,893

12,244

41,137

226

1,847

367

2,440

1,432

1,432

(18)

(18)

(36)

-

(103)

(63)

(166)

(1,240)

(1,240)

(3.2)%

Corporate Lending

14,112

5,695

19,807

213

1,219

367

1,799

1,419

1,419

(15)

(6)

(21)

-

(100)

(63)

(163)

(1,239)

(1,239)

(6.2)%

Non Corporate Lending1

5,741

2,541

8,282

12

620

-

632

13

13

(1)

(11)

(12)

-

(3)

-

(3)

(1)

(1)

(0.2)%

Banks

9,040

4,008

13,048

1

8

-

9

-

-

(2)

(1)

(3)

-

-

-

-

-

-

(0.0)%

Singapore

30,742

8,835

39,577

1,023

1,065

225

2,313

241

241

(5)

(11)

(16)

(2)

(4)

-

(6)

(192)

(192)

(0.5)%

Corporate Lending

8,803

4,083

12,886

975

603

21

1,599

196

196

(4)

(9)

(13)

(2)

(4)

-

(6)

(192)

(192)

(1.4)%

Non Corporate Lending1

17,532

973

18,505

32

420

180

632

-

-

(1)

(1)

(2)

-

-

-

-

-

-

(0.0)%

Banks

4,407

3,779

8,186

16

42

24

82

45

45

-

(1)

(1)

-

-

-

-

-

-

(0.0)%

China

10,610

2,164

12,774

-

273

37

310

161

161

(3)

(1)

(4)

-

-

(1)

(1)

(86)

(86)

(0.7)%

Corporate Lending

5,403

1,472

6,875

-

270

37

307

159

159

(2)

(1)

(3)

-

-

(1)

(1)

(84)

(84)

(1.2)%

Non Corporate Lending1

3,402

404

3,806

-

-

-

-

-

-

(1)

-

(1)

-

-

-

-

-

-

(0.0)%

Banks

1,805

288

2,093

-

3

-

3

2

2

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

(2)

(2)

(0.1)%

UK

14,382

6,804

21,186

57

1,792

574

2,423

868

868

(2)

(2)

(4)

(1)

(24)

-

(25)

(389)

(389)

(1.7)%

Corporate Lending

6,096

3,379

9,475

57

1,165

497

1,719

779

779

(2)

(2)

(4)

(1)

(23)

-

(24)

(363)

(363)

(3.3)%

Non Corporate Lending1

6,224

1,363

7,587

-

611

74

685

88

88

-

-

-

-

(1)

-

(1)

(25)

(25)

(0.3)%

Banks

2,062

2,062

4,124

-

16

3

19

1

1

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

(1)

(1)

(0.0)%

US

18,653

3,705

22,358

215

329

-

544

3

3

(5)

(3)

(8)

(1)

(3)

-

(4)

(4)

(4)

(0.1)%

Corporate Lending

6,819

2,262

9,081

148

230

-

378

-

-

(4)

(2)

(6)

(1)

(3)

-

(4)

(1)

(1)

(0.1)%

Non Corporate Lending1

11,190

262

11,452

67

69

-

136

3

3

(1)

(1)

(2)

-

-

-

-

(3)

(3)

(0.0)%

Banks

644

1,181

1,825

-

30

-

30

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

0.0%

Others

34,660

17,254

51,914

408

1,802

892

3,102

1,764

1,764

(19)

(43)

(62)

(2)

(75)

(29)

(106)

(1,344)

(1,344)

(2.7)%

Corporate Lending

19,043

13,399

32,442

372

1,245

456

2,073

1,592

1,592

(18)

(33)

(51)

(2)

(63)

(27)

(92)

(1,186)

(1,186)

(3.7)%

Non Corporate Lending1

4,596

2,539

7,135

26

379

30

435

172

172

-

(9)

(9)

-

(12)

-

(12)

(157)

(157)

(2.3)%

Banks

11,021

1,316

12,337

10

178

406

594

-

-

(1)

(1)

(2)

-

-

(2)

(2)

(1)

(1)

(0.0)%

Total

137,940

51,006

188,946

1,929

7,108

2,095

11,132

4,469

4,469

(52)

(78)

(130)

(6)

(209)

(93)

(308)

(3,255)

(3,255)

(1.8)%

1   Include financing, insurance and non-banking corporations and governments

- page 13 -


 



 


Corporate & Investment Banking and Central & other items2

31.12.24

Gross

Credit impairment

Stage 1

Stage 2

Stage 3

Stage 1

Stage 2

Stage 3

Total
coverage
%

Strong $million

Satis-factory $million

Total $million

Strong $million

Satis-factory $million

Higher risk $million

Total $million

De-faulted $million

Total $million

Strong $million

Satis-factory $million

Total $million

Strong $million

Satis-factory $million

Higher risk $million

Total $million

Im-paired $million

Total $million

Hong Kong

29,643

12,079

41,722

230

1,539

64

1,833

1,308

1,308

(8)

(8)

(16)

(33)

(107)

(9)

(149)

(1,157)

(1,157)

(2.9)%

Corporate Lending

13,230

6,180

19,410

225

1,329

64

1,618

1,296

1,296

(5)

(4)

(9)

(33)

(102)

(9)

(144)

(1,157)

(1,157)

(5.9)%

Non Corporate Lending1

4,526

2,730

7,256

4

206

-

210

12

12

(1)

(3)

(4)

-

(5)

-

(5)

-

-

(0.1)%

Banks

11,887

3,169

15,056

1

4

-

5

-

-

(2)

(1)

(3)

-

-

-

-

-

-

(0.0)%

Singapore

34,114

8,762

42,876

500

1,019

35

1,554

337

337

-

(8)

(8)

(4)

(14)

-

(18)

(196)

(196)

(0.5)%

Corporate Lending

9,545

4,457

14,002

469

658

35

1,162

265

265

-

(6)

(6)

(4)

(14)

-

(18)

(195)

(195)

(1.4)%

Non Corporate Lending1

20,156

1,091

21,247

29

358

-

387

-

-

-

(1)

(1)

-

-

-

-

-

-

(0.0)%

Banks

4,413

3,214

7,627

2

3

-

5

72

72

-

(1)

(1)

-

-

-

-

(1)

(1)

(0.0)%

China

10,370

2,744

13,114

49

133

14

196

171

171

(3)

(1)

(4)

-

-

-

-

(86)

(86)

(0.7)%

Corporate Lending

4,934

2,143

7,077

49

133

14

196

168

168

(1)

(1)

(2)

-

-

-

-

(83)

(83)

(1.1)%

Non Corporate Lending1

3,241

363

3,604

-

-

-

-

-

-

(1)

-

(1)

-

-

-

-

-

-

(0.0)%

Banks

2,195

238

2,433

-

-

-

-

3

3

(1)

-

(1)

-

-

-

-

(3)

(3)

(0.2)%

UK

21,555

5,985

27,540

48

1,940

141

2,129

756

756

(10)

(4)

(14)

-

(27)

(6)

(33)

(258)

(258)

(1.0)%

Corporate Lending

2,331

2,082

4,413

47

1,433

27

1,507

658

658

(9)

(3)

(12)

-

(27)

(6)

(33)

(237)

(237)

(4.3)%

Non Corporate Lending1

17,040

1,753

18,793

1

507

112

620

97

97

(1)

(1)

(2)

-

-

-

-

(21)

(21)

(0.1)%

Banks

2,184

2,150

4,334

-

-

2

2

1

1

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

0.0%

US

15,707

4,400

20,107

92

433

33

558

4

4

(4)

(1)

(5)

(1)

(1)

-

(2)

(3)

(3)

(0.0)%

Corporate Lending

5,334

2,705

8,039

77

322

-

399

1

1

(3)

(1)

(4)

(1)

(1)

-

(2)

-

-

(0.1)%

Non Corporate Lending1

9,688

123

9,811

15

79

-

94

3

3

(1)

-

(1)

-

-

-

-

(3)

(3)

(0.0)%

Banks

685

1,572

2,257

-

32

33

65

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

0.0%

Others

32,116

16,437

48,553

318

1,726

681

2,725

2,081

2,081

(10)

(33)

(43)

(3)

(70)

(29)

(102)

(1,483)

(1,483)

(3.1)%

Corporate Lending

21,909

12,516

34,425

291

1,030

490

1,811

1,883

1,883

(6)

(26)

(32)

(3)

(38)

(28)

(69)

(1,333)

(1,333)

(3.8)%

Non Corporate Lending1

332

2,296

2,628

22

610

41

673

191

191

-

(6)

(6)

-

(31)

(1)

(32)

(149)

(149)

(5.4)%

Banks

9,875

1,625

11,500

5

86

150

241

7

7

(4)

(1)

(5)

-

(1)

-

(1)

(1)

(1)

(0.1)%

Total

143,505

50,407

193,912

1,237

6,790

968

8,995

4,657

4,657

(35)

(55)

(90)

(41)

(219)

(44)

(304)

(3,183)

(3,183)

(1.7)%

1   Include financing, insurance and non-banking corporations and governments

2   Amounts have been re-presented from management view to financial booking basis in line with RNS on Re-Presentation of Financial Information issued on 2 April 2025

- page 14 -


 



 


Wealth & Retail Banking and Ventures

30.06.25

Gross

Credit impairment

Stage 1

Stage 2

Stage 3

Stage 1

Stage 2

Stage 3

Total
coverage
%

Strong $million

Satis-factory $million

Total $million

Strong $million

Satis-factory $million

Higher risk $million

Total $million

De-faulted $million

Total $million

Strong $million

Satis-factory $million

Total $million

Strong $million

Satis-factory $million

Higher risk $million

Total $million

Im-paired $million

Total $million

Hong Kong

42,020

269

42,289

324

49

54

427

231

231

(62)

(21)

(83)

(25)

(14)

(10)

(49)

(78)

(78)

(0.5)%

Mortgages

30,622

213

30,835

99

30

22

151

71

71

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

(3)

(3)

(0.0)%

Credit cards

3,999

24

4,023

93

17

19

129

14

14

(32)

(17)

(49)

(19)

(13)

(7)

(39)

(14)

(14)

(2.4)%

Others

7,399

32

7,431

132

2

13

147

146

146

(30)

(4)

(34)

(6)

(1)

(3)

(10)

(61)

(61)

(1.4)%

Singapore

29,807

76

29,883

436

40

43

519

334

334

(38)

(36)

(74)

(1)

(7)

(8)

(16)

(269)

(269)

(1.2)%

Mortgages

14,571

18

14,589

193

34

14

241

11

11

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

(5)

(5)

(0.0)%

Credit cards

2,427

37

2,464

17

5

22

44

19

19

(18)

(35)

(53)

-

(7)

(6)

(13)

(19)

(19)

(3.4)%

Others

12,809

21

12,830

226

1

7

234

304

304

(20)

(1)

(21)

(1)

-

(2)

(3)

(245)

(245)

(2.0)%

Korea

21,492

269

21,761

327

10

43

380

134

134

(25)

(3)

(28)

(21)

(13)

(1)

(35)

(50)

(50)

(0.5)%

Mortgages

16,435

200

16,635

265

9

15

289

77

77

(1)

-

(1)

-

-

-

-

(4)

(4)

(0.0)%

Credit cards

24

1

25

1

-

-

1

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

0.0%

Others

5,033

68

5,101

61

1

28

90

57

57

(24)

(3)

(27)

(21)

(13)

(1)

(35)

(46)

(46)

(2.1)%

Rest of World

27,138

4,751

31,889

506

53

240

799

1,016

1,016

(227)

(17)

(244)

(29)

(6)

(24)

(59)

(414)

(414)

(2.1)%

Mortgages

16,006

2,143

18,149

300

36

143

479

489

489

(4)

(3)

(7)

-

-

(1)

(1)

(127)

(127)

(0.7)%

Credit cards

1,311

41

1,352

39

1

14

54

35

35

(26)

(4)

(30)

(15)

-

(10)

(25)

(25)

(25)

(5.6)%

Others

9,821

2,567

12,388

167

16

83

266

492

492

(197)

(10)

(207)

(14)

(6)

(13)

(33)

(262)

(262)

(3.8)%

Total

120,457

5,365

125,822

1,593

152

380

2,125

1,715

1,715

(352)

(77)

(429)

(76)

(40)

(43)

(159)

(811)

(811)

(1.1)%

 


Wealth & Retail Banking and Ventures

31.12.24

Gross

Credit impairment

Stage 1

Stage 2

Stage 3

Stage 1

Stage 2

Stage 3

Total Coverage
%

Strong $million

Satis-factory $million

Total $million

Strong $million

Satis-factory $million

Higher Risk $million

Total $million

De-faulted $million

Total $million

Strong $million

Satis-factory $million

Total $million

Strong $million

Satis-factory $million

Higher Risk $million

Total $million

Im-paired $million

Total $million

Hong Kong

41,906

320

42,226

288

47

40

375

228

228

(59)

(14)

(73)

(33)

(20)

(4)

(57)

(69)

(69)

(0.5)%

Mortgages

31,080

265

31,345

55

14

24

93

75

75

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

(7)

(7)

(0.0)%

Credit cards

4,210

19

4,229

93

30

1

124

14

14

(36)

(11)

(47)

(27)

(19)

(1)

(47)

(14)

(14)

(2.5)%

Others

6,616

36

6,652

140

3

15

158

139

139

(23)

(3)

(26)

(6)

(1)

(3)

(10)

(48)

(48)

(1.2)%

Singapore

26,755

52

26,807

441

39

34

514

312

312

(29)

(26)

(55)

(6)

(6)

(6)

(18)

(265)

(265)

(1.2)%

Mortgages

13,531

12

13,543

160

32

15

207

9

9

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

(4)

(4)

(0.0)%

Credit cards

2,248

25

2,273

14

5

16

35

16

16

(9)

(26)

(35)

(5)

(5)

(4)

(14)

(19)

(19)

(2.9)%

Others

10,976

15

10,991

267

2

3

272

287

287

(20)

-

(20)

(1)

(1)

(2)

(4)

(242)

(242)

(2.3)%

Korea

18,062

220

18,282

378

9

22

409

112

112

(22)

(1)

(23)

(28)

(4)

(1)

(33)

(33)

(33)

(0.5)%

Mortgages

13,198

171

13,369

250

8

17

275

62

62

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

(2)

(2)

(0.0)%

Credit cards

36

1

37

1

-

-

1

-

-

(1)

-

(1)

-

-

-

-

-

-

(2.6)%

Others

4,828

48

4,876

127

1

5

133

50

50

(21)

(1)

(22)

(28)

(4)

(1)

(33)

(31)

(31)

(1.7)%

Rest of World

26,085

4,998

31,083

338

76

241

655

977

977

(239)

(13)

(252)

(39)

(5)

(18)

(62)

(403)

(403)

(2.2)%

Mortgages

15,079

2,007

17,086

136

43

141

320

459

459

(4)

(2)

(6)

-

-

(1)

(1)

(124)

(124)

(0.7)%

Credit cards

1,148

351

1,499

29

12

19

60

40

40

(33)

(1)

(34)

(21)

-

(1)

(22)

(27)

(27)

(5.2)%

Others

9,858

2,640

12,498

173

21

81

275

478

478

(202)

(10)

(212)

(18)

(5)

(16)

(39)

(252)

(252)

(3.8)%

Total

112,808

5,590

118,398

1,445

171

337

1,953

1,629

1,629

(349)

(54)

(403)

(106)

(35)

(29)

(170)

(770)

(770)

(1.1)%

 

- page 15 -




 

Undrawn commitment and financial guarantees - by client segment credit quality

Amortised cost

Wealth & Retail Banking and Ventures

30.06.25

Notional

ECL

Stage 1
$million

Stage 2
$million

Stage 3
$million

Total
$million

Stage 1
$million

Stage 2
$million

Stage 3
$million

Total
$million

Strong

70,794

113

-

70,907

(15)

(3)

-

(18)

Satisfactory

625

12

-

637

(3)

(2)

-

(5)

Higher risk

-

30

-

30

-

(2)

-

(2)

Impaired

-

-

3

3

-

-

-

-

Total

71,419

155

3

71,577

(18)

(7)

-

(25)

 

Amortised cost

31.12.24

Notional

ECL

Stage 1
$million

Stage 2
$million

Stage 3
$million

Total
$million

Stage 1
$million

Stage 2
$million

Stage 3
$million

Total
$million

Strong

70,595

100

-

70,695

(15)

(3)

-

(18)

Satisfactory

850

11

-

861

(5)

(1)

-

(6)

Higher risk

-

21

-

21

-

(3)

-

(3)

Impaired

-

-

8

8

-

-

-

-

Total

71,445

132

8

71,585

(20)

(7)

-

(27)

Movement in gross exposures and credit impairment for loans and advances, debt securities, undrawn commitments and financial guarantees (reviewed)

The tables overleaf set out the movement in gross exposures and credit impairment by stage in respect of amortised cost loans to banks and customers, undrawn commitments, financial guarantees and debt securities classified at amortised cost and FVOCI. The tables are presented for the Group and separately for CIB and WRB (which also includes a separate presentation for secured and unsecured exposures).

Methodology

The movement lines within the tables are an aggregation of monthly movements over the year and will therefore reflect the accumulation of multiple trades during the year. The credit impairment charge in the income statement comprises the amounts within the boxes in the table below, less recoveries of amounts previously written off. Discount unwind is reported in net interest income and related to stage 3 financial instruments only.

The approach for determining the key line items in the tables is set out below.

Transfers - transfers between stages are deemed to occur at the beginning of a month based on prior month closing balances.

Net remeasurement from stage changes - the remeasurement of credit impairment provisions arising from a change in stage is reported within the stage that the assets are transferred to. For example, assets transferred into stage 2 are remeasured from a 12-month to a lifetime ECL, with the effect of remeasurement reported in stage 2. For stage 3, this represents the initial remeasurement from specific provisions recognised on individual assets transferred into stage 3 in the year.

Net changes in exposures - new business written less repayments in the year. Within stage 1, new business written will attract up to 12 months of ECL charges. Repayments of non-amortising loans (primarily within CIB) will have low amounts of ECL provisions attributed to them, due to the release of provisions over the term to maturity. In stages 2 and 3, the net change in exposures reflect repayments although stage 2 may include new facilities where clients are on non-purely precautionary early alert, are CG 12, or when non-investment grade debt securities are acquired.

- page 16 -




 

Changes in risk parameters - for stages 1 and 2, this reflects changes in the probability of default (PD), loss given default (LGD) and exposure at default (EAD) of assets during the year, which includes the impact of releasing provisions over the term to maturity. It also includes the effect of changes in forecasts of macroeconomic variables during the year. In stage 3, this line represents additional specific provisions recognised on exposures held within stage 3.

Interest due but not paid - change in contractual amount of interest due in stage 3 financial instruments but not paid, being the net of accruals, repayments and write-offs, together with the corresponding change in credit impairment.

Changes to ECL models, which incorporate changes to model approaches and methodologies, are not reported as a separate line item as these have an impact over a number of lines and stages.

Movements during the year

Stage 1 gross exposures increased by $40.5 billion to $761.1 billion (31 December 2024: $720.7 billion). CIB exposure increased by $22.3 billion to $389.4 billion (31 December 2024: $367.1 billion), mainly due to an increase in exposures to financial guarantees and undrawn commitments. WRB increased by $6.5 billion to $186.1 billion (31 December 2024: $179.6 billion), mainly due to an increase in the mortgage portfolio across Korea, Taiwan and Singapore and in Secured wealth products due to the higher demand in Singapore.

Total stage 1 provisions increased by $82 million to $664 million (31 December 2024: $582 million). CIB provisions increased by $55 million to $188 million (31 December 2024: $133 million), due to portfolio movements and new exposures. WRB provisions increased by $20 million to $412 million (31 December 2024: $392 million), due to Secured wealth and unsecured lending portfolios.

Stage 2 gross exposures increased by $2.0 billion to $20.7 billion (31 December 2024: $18.6 billion), primarily driven by exposure increases in CIB to Sovereign related and Commercial real estate clients. WRB exposures increased by $0.2 billion to $2.2 billion (31 December 2024: $2.0 billion), mainly due to the China secured portfolio.

Stage 2 provisions decreased by $10 million to $527 million (31 December 2024: $537 million). CIB provisions decreased by $9 million to $353 million (31 December 2024: $362 million) due to China CRE overlay releases. WRB provisions decreased by $5 million to $146 million (31 December 2024: $151 million), mainly in the unsecured portfolio.

The non-linearity impact increased stage 1 and 2 provisions by $34 million to $77 million (31 December 2024: $43 million). This reflects an increased probability weighting of the overall downside scenarios from 32 per cent to 45 per cent, given heightened levels of tariffs and geopolitical uncertainty.

Stage 3 gross exposures for CIB decreased by $0.2 billion to $4.9 billion (31 December 2024: $5.2 billion) due to repayments. CIB provisions remained stable at $3.4 billion (31 December 2024: $3.3 billion). WRB stage 3 loans increased by $0.1 billion to $1.7 billion (31 December 2024: $1.6 billion) mainly in the secured portfolio but provisions remained stable at $0.8 billion (31 December 2024: $0.8 billion).



- page 17 -


 

All segments (reviewed)

Amortised cost and FVOCI

Stage 1

Stage 2

Stage 35

Total

Gross balance3
$million

Total credit impair-ment
$million

Net
$million

Gross balance3
$million

Total credit impair-ment
$million

Net
$million

Gross balance3
$million

Total credit impair-ment
$million

Net
$million

Gross balance3
$million

Total credit impair-ment
$million

Net
$million

As at 1 January 2024

723,876

(526)

723,350

22,268

(517)

21,751

8,144

(4,499)

3,645

754,288

(5,542)

748,746

Transfers to stage 1

16,433

(543)

15,890

(16,423)

543

(15,880)

(10)

-

(10)

-

-

-

Transfers to stage 2

(33,301)

128

(33,173)

33,770

(153)

33,617

(469)

25

(444)

-

-

-

Transfers to stage 3

(1,631)

63

(1,568)

(146)

168

22

1,777

(231)

1,546

-

-

-

Net change in exposures

29,928

(173)

29,755

(18,435)

80

(18,355)

(1,383)

622

(761)

10,110

529

10,639

Net remeasurement from stage changes

-

61

61

-

(185)

(185)

-

(203)

(203)

-

(327)

(327)

Changes in risk parameters

-

84

84

-

(242)

(242)

-

(873)

(873)

-

(1,031)

(1,031)

Write-offs

-

-

-

-

-

-

(1,260)

1,260

-

(1,260)

1,260

-

Interest due but unpaid

-

-

-

-

-

-

53

(53)

-

53

(53)

-

Discount unwind

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

135

135

-

135

135

Exchange translation differences and other movements¹

(14,626)

324

(14,302)

(2,427)

(231)

(2,658)

147

(268)

(121)

(16,906)

(175)

(17,081)

As at 31 December 2024²

720,679

(582)

720,097

18,607

(537)

18,070

6,999

(4,085)

2,914

746,285

(5,204)

741,081

Income statement ECL (charge)/release6


(28)



(347)



(454)



(829)


Recoveries of amounts previously written off


-



-



279



279


Total credit impairment (charge)/release4


(28)



(347)



(175)



(550)


As at 1 January 2025

720,679

(582)

720,097

18,607

(537)

18,070

6,999

(4,085)

2,914

746,285

(5,204)

741,081

Transfers to stage 1

5,946

(408)

5,538

(5,945)

408

(5,537)

(1)

-

(1)

-

-

-

Transfers to stage 2

(18,668)

57

(18,611)

18,954

(71)

18,883

(286)

14

(272)

-

-

-

Transfers to stage 3

(70)

-

(70)

(988)

145

(843)

1,058

(145)

913

-

-

-

Net change in exposures

31,424

(129)

31,295

(9,472)

(40)

(9,512)

(553)

304

(249)

21,399

135

21,534

Net remeasurement from stage changes

-

43

43

-

(88)

(88)

-

(25)

(25)

-

(70)

(70)

Changes in risk parameters

-

66

66

-

(28)

(28)

-

(606)

(606)

-

(568)

(568)

Write-offs

-

-

-

-

-

-

(518)

518

-

(518)

518

-

Interest due but unpaid

-

-

-

-

-

-

88

(88)

-

88

(88)

-

Discount unwind

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

55

55

-

55

55

Exchange translation differences and other movements¹

21,825

289

22,114

(500)

(316)

(816)

165

(121)

44

21,490

(148)

21,342

As at 30 June 2025²

761,136

(664)

760,472

20,656

(527)

20,129

6,952

(4,179)

2,773

788,744

(5,370)

783,374

Income statement ECL (charge)/release6


(20)



(156)



(327)



(503)


Recoveries of amounts previously written off


-



-



175



175


Total credit impairment (charge)/release4


(20)



(156)



(152)



(328)


1   Includes fair value adjustments and amortisation on debt securities

2   Excludes Cash and balances at central banks, Accrued income, Assets held for sale and Other assets gross balances of $128,832 million (31 December 2024: $101,755 million) and Total credit impairment of $61 million (31 December 2024: $63 million)

3   The gross balance includes the notional amount of off balance sheet instruments

4   Reported basis

5   Stage 3 gross includes $289 million (31 December 2024: $59 million) originated credit-impaired debt securities with impairment of $6 million (31 December 2024: $Nil)

6   Does not include charge relating to Other assets of $8 million (31 December 2024: $3 million)



- page 18 -


 

Corporate & Investment Banking (reviewed)

Amortised cost and FVOCI

Stage 1

Stage 2

Stage 3

Total

Gross balance1
$million

Total credit impair-ment
$million

Net
$million

Gross balance1
$million

Total credit impair-ment
$million

Net
$million

Gross balance1
$million

Total credit impair-ment
$million

Net
$million

Gross balance1
$million

Total credit impair-ment
$million

Net
$million

As at 1 January 2024

337,189

(151)

337,038

16,873

(318)

16,555

6,256

(3,651)

2,605

360,318

(4,120)

356,198

Transfers to stage 1

10,390

(245)

10,145

(10,390)

245

(10,145)

-

-

-

-

-

-

Transfers to stage 2

(25,698)

47

(25,651)

25,810

(58)

25,752

(112)

11

(101)

-

-

-

Transfers to stage 3

(186)

(4)

(190)

(186)

22

(164)

372

(18)

354

-

-

-

Net change in exposures

50,866

(50)

50,816

(16,508)

88

(16,420)

(1,063)

607

(456)

33,295

645

33,940

Net remeasurement from stage changes

-

16

16

(4)

(36)

(40)

-

(100)

(100)

(4)

(120)

(124)

Changes in risk parameters2

-

32

32

-

(129)

(129)

-

(324)

(324)

-

(421)

(421)

Write-offs

-

-

-

-

-

-

(321)

321

-

(321)

321

-

Interest due but unpaid

-

-

-

-

-

-

25

(25)

-

25

(25)

-

Discount unwind

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

104

104

-

104

104

Exchange translation differences and other movements2

(5,455)

222

(5,233)

(726)

(176)

(902)

13

(237)

(224)

(6,168)

(191)

(6,359)

As at 31 December 2024

367,106

(133)

366,973

14,869

(362)

14,507

5,170

(3,312)

1,858

387,145

(3,807)

383,338

Income statement ECL (charge)/release2


(2)



(77)



183



104


Recoveries of amounts previously written off


-



-



26



26


Total credit impairment (charge)/release


(2)



(77)



209



130


As at 1 January 2025

367,106

(133)

366,973

14,869

(362)

14,507

5,170

(3,312)

1,858

387,145

(3,807)

383,338

Transfers to stage 1

3,585

(281)

3,304

(3,585)

281

(3,304)

-

-

-

-

-

-

Transfers to stage 2

(14,748)

8

(14,740)

14,975

(22)

14,953

(227)

14

(213)

-

-

-

Transfers to stage 3

(2)

-

(2)

(326)

39

(287)

328

(39)

289

-

-

-

Net change in exposures

25,369

(71)

25,298

(8,166)

(28)

(8,194)

(347)

310

(37)

16,856

211

17,067

Net remeasurement from stage changes

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

14

14

-

14

14

Changes in risk parameters

-

24

24

-

(12)

(12)

-

(256)

(256)

-

(244)

(244)

Write-offs

-

-

-

-

-

-

(39)

39

-

(39)

39

-

Interest due but unpaid

-

-

-

-

-

-

76

(76)

-

76

(76)

-

Discount unwind

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

39

39

-

39

39

Exchange translation differences and other movements

8,050

265

8,315

(470)

(249)

(719)

(33)

(95)

(128)

7,547

(79)

7,468

As at 30 June 2025

389,360

(188)

389,172

17,297

(353)

16,944

4,928

(3,362)

1,566

411,585

(3,903)

407,682

Income statement ECL (charge)/release


(47)



(40)



68



(19)


Recoveries of amounts previously written off


-



-



29



29


Total credit impairment (charge)/release


(47)



(40)



97



10


1   The gross balance includes the notional amount of off balance sheet instruments

2   Business segments have been re-presented in line with the RNS on Re-Presentation of Financial Information issued on 2 April 2025



- page 19 -


 

Wealth & Retail Banking (reviewed)

Amortised cost and FVOCI

Stage 1

Stage 2

Stage 3

Total

Gross balance1
$million

Total credit impair-ment
$million

Net
$million

Gross balance1
$million

Total credit impair-ment
$million

Net
$million

Gross balance1
$million

Total credit impair-ment
$million

Net
$million

Gross balance1
$million

Total credit impair-ment
$million

Net
$million

As at 1 January 2024

190,999

(325)

190,674

2,472

(140)

2,332

1,485

(759)

726

194,956

(1,224)

193,732

Transfers to stage 1

5,126

(288)

4,838

(5,116)

288

(4,828)

(10)

-

(10)

-

-

-

Transfers to stage 2

(7,393)

80

(7,313)

7,525

(80)

7,445

(132)

-

(132)

-

-

-

Transfers to stage 3

(98)

1

(97)

(1,254)

211

(1,043)

1,352

(212)

1,140

-

-

-

Net change in exposures

(3,926)

(89)

(4,015)

(1,505)

21

(1,484)

(431)

-

(431)

(5,862)

(68)

(5,930)

Net remeasurement from stage changes

-

29

29

-

(144)

(144)

-

(44)

(44)

-

(159)

(159)

Changes in risk parameters2

-

35

35

-

(152)

(152)

-

(531)

(531)

-

(648)

(648)

Write-offs

-

-

-

-

-

-

(808)

808

-

(808)

808

-

Interest due but unpaid

-

-

-

-

-

-

28

(28)

-

28

(28)

-

Discount unwind

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

30

30

-

30

30

Exchange translation differences and other movements2

(5,128)

165

(4,963)

(92)

(155)

(247)

139

(22)

117

(5,081)

(12)

(5,093)

As at 31 December 2024

179,580

(392)

179,188

2,030

(151)

1,879

1,623

(758)

865

183,233

(1,301)

181,932

Income statement ECL (charge)/release2


(25)



(275)



(575)



(875)


Recoveries of amounts previously written off


-



-



253



253


Total credit impairment (charge)/release


(25)



(275)



(322)



(622)


As at 1 January 2025

179,580

(392)

179,188

2,030

(151)

1,879

1,623

(758)

865

183,233

(1,301)

181,932

Transfers to stage 1

1,871

(118)

1,753

(1,870)

118

(1,752)

(1)

-

(1)

-

-

-

Transfers to stage 2

(3,647)

43

(3,604)

3,706

(43)

3,663

(59)

-

(59)

-

-

-

Transfers to stage 3

(20)

-

(20)

(690)

100

(590)

710

(100)

610

-

-

-

Net change in exposures

1,592

(29)

1,563

(1,039)

7

(1,032)

(312)

-

(312)

241

(22)

219

Net remeasurement from stage changes

-

22

22

-

(88)

(88)

-

(12)

(12)

-

(78)

(78)

Changes in risk parameters

-

7

7

-

(19)

(19)

-

(363)

(363)

-

(375)

(375)

Write-offs

-

-

-

-

-

-

(454)

454

-

(454)

454

-

Interest due but unpaid

-

-

-

-

-

-

11

(11)

-

11

(11)

-

Discount unwind

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

16

16

-

16

16

Exchange translation differences and other movements

6,679

55

6,734

87

(70)

17

185

(25)

160

6,951

(40)

6,911

As at 30 June 2025

186,055

(412)

185,643

2,224

(146)

2,078

1,703

(799)

904

189,982

(1,357)

188,625

Income statement ECL (charge)/release


-



(100)



(375)



(475)


Recoveries of amounts previously written off


-



-



146



146


Total credit impairment (charge)/release


-



(100)



(229)



(329)


1   The gross balance includes the notional amount of off-balance sheet instruments

2   Business segments have been re-presented in line with the RNS on Re-Presentation of Financial Information issued on 2 April 2025



- page 20 -


 

Wealth & Retail Banking - Secured (reviewed)

Amortised cost and FVOCI

Stage 1

Stage 2

Stage 3

Total

Gross balance1
$million

Total credit impair-ment
$million

Net
$million

Gross balance1
$million

Total credit impair-ment
$million

Net
$million

Gross balance1
$million

Total credit impair-ment
$million

Net
$million

Gross balance1
$million

Total credit impair-ment
$million

Net
$million

As at 1 January 2024

129,798

(33)

129,765

1,827

(16)

1,811

1,062

(525)

537

132,687

(574)

132,113

Transfers to stage 1

3,839

(23)

3,816

(3,836)

23

(3,813)

(3)

-

(3)

-

-

-

Transfers to stage 2

(4,952)

13

(4,939)

5,054

(13)

5,041

(102)

-

(102)

-

-

-

Transfers to stage 3

(43)

-

(43)

(566)

19

(547)

609

(19)

590

-

-

-

Net change in exposures

2,570

(11)

2,559

(917)

8

(909)

(268)

-

(268)

1,385

(3)

1,382

Net remeasurement from stage changes

-

6

6

-

(15)

(15)

-

(7)

(7)

-

(16)

(16)

Changes in risk parameters2

-

10

10

-

(6)

(6)

-

(123)

(123)

-

(119)

(119)

Write-offs

-

-

-

-

-

-

(114)

114

-

(114)

114

-

Interest due but unpaid

-

-

-

-

-

-

53

(53)

-

53

(53)

-

Discount unwind

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

16

16

-

16

16

Exchange translation differences and other movements2

(4,496)

(10)

(4,506)

(57)

(31)

(88)

(33)

41

8

(4,586)

-

(4,586)

As at 31 December 2024

126,716

(48)

126,668

1,505

(31)

1,474

1,204

(556)

648

129,425

(635)

128,790

Income statement ECL (charge)/release2


5



(13)



(130)



(138)


Recoveries of amounts previously written off


-



-



80



80


Total credit impairment (charge)/release


5



(13)



(50)



(58)


As at 1 January 2025

126,716

(48)

126,668

1,505

(31)

1,474

1,204

(556)

648

129,425

(635)

128,790

Transfers to stage 1

1,322

(6)

1,316

(1,321)

6

(1,315)

(1)

-

(1)

-

-

-

Transfers to stage 2

(2,521)

3

(2,518)

2,568

(3)

2,565

(47)

-

(47)

-

-

-

Transfers to stage 3

(14)

-

(14)

(338)

7

(331)

352

(7)

345

-

-

-

Net change in exposures

2,916

(8)

2,908

(749)

(2)

(751)

(255)

-

(255)

1,912

(10)

1,902

Net remeasurement from stage changes

-

3

3

-

(18)

(18)

-

(7)

(7)

-

(22)

(22)

Changes in risk parameters

-

(14)

(14)

-

25

25

-

(129)

(129)

-

(118)

(118)

Write-offs

-

-

-

-

-

-

(114)

114

-

(114)

114

-

Interest due but unpaid

-

-

-

-

-

-

53

(53)

-

53

(53)

-

Discount unwind

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

9

9

-

9

9

Exchange translation differences and other movements

5,735

13

5,748

69

(14)

55

63

62

125

5,867

61

5,928

As at 30 June 2025

134,154

(57)

134,097

1,734

(30)

1,704

1,255

(567)

688

137,143

(654)

136,489

Income statement ECL (charge)/release


(19)



5



(136)



(150)


Recoveries of amounts previously written off


-



-



46



46


Total credit impairment (charge)/release


(19)



5



(90)



(104)


1   The gross balance includes the notional amount of off balance sheet instruments

2   Business segments have been re-presented in line with the RNS on Re-Presentation of Financial Information issued on 2 April 2025



- page 21 -


 

Wealth & Retail Banking - Unsecured (reviewed)

Amortised cost and FVOCI

Stage 1

Stage 2

Stage 3

Total

Gross balance1
$million

Total credit impair-ment
$million

Net
$million

Gross balance1
$million

Total credit impair-ment
$million

Net
$million

Gross balance1
$million

Total credit impair-ment
$million

Net
$million

Gross balance1
$million

Total credit impair-ment
$million

Net
$million

As at 1 January 2024

61,201

(292)

60,909

645

(124)

521

423

(234)

189

62,269

(650)

61,619

Transfers to stage 1

1,287

(265)

1,022

(1,280)

265

(1,015)

(7)

-

(7)

-

-

-

Transfers to stage 2

(2,441)

67

(2,374)

2,471

(67)

2,404

(30)

-

(30)

-

-

-

Transfers to stage 3

(55)

1

(54)

(688)

192

(496)

743

(193)

550

-

-

-

Net change in exposures

(6,496)

(78)

(6,574)

(588)

13

(575)

(163)

-

(163)

(7,247)

(65)

(7,312)

Net remeasurement from stage changes

-

23

23

-

(129)

(129)

-

(37)

(37)

-

(143)

(143)

Changes in risk parameters

-

25

25

-

(146)

(146)

-

(408)

(408)

-

(529)

(529)

Write-offs

-

-

-

-

-

-

(694)

694

-

(694)

694

-

Interest due but unpaid

-

-

-

-

-

-

(25)

25

-

(25)

25

-

Discount unwind

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

14

14

-

14

14

Exchange translation differences and other movements

(632)

175

(457)

(35)

(124)

(159)

172

(63)

109

(495)

(12)

(507)

As at 31 December 2024

52,864

(344)

52,520

525

(120)

405

419

(202)

217

53,808

(666)

53,142

Income statement ECL (charge)/release


(30)



(262)



(445)



(737)


Recoveries of amounts previously written off


-



-



172



172


Total credit impairment (charge)/release


(30)



(262)



(273)



(565)


As at 1 January 2025

52,864

(344)

52,520

525

(120)

405

419

(202)

217

53,808

(666)

53,142

Transfers to stage 1

549

(112)

437

(549)

112

(437)

-

-

-

-

-

-

Transfers to stage 2

(1,126)

40

(1,086)

1,138

(40)

1,098

(12)

-

(12)

-

-

-

Transfers to stage 3

(6)

-

(6)

(352)

93

(259)

358

(93)

265

-

-

-

Net change in exposures

(1,324)

(21)

(1,345)

(290)

9

(281)

(57)

-

(57)

(1,671)

(12)

(1,683)

Net remeasurement from stage changes

-

19

19

-

(70)

(70)

-

(5)

(5)

-

(56)

(56)

Changes in risk parameters

-

21

21

-

(44)

(44)

-

(234)

(234)

-

(257)

(257)

Write-offs

-

-

-

-

-

-

(340)

340

-

(340)

340

-

Interest due but unpaid

-

-

-

-

-

-

(42)

42

-

(42)

42

-

Discount unwind

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

7

7

-

7

7

Exchange translation differences and other movements

944

42

986

18

(56)

(38)

122

(87)

35

1,084

(101)

983

As at 30 June 2025

51,901

(355)

51,546

490

(116)

374

448

(232)

216

52,839

(703)

52,136

Income statement ECL (charge)/release


19



(105)



(239)



(325)


Recoveries of amounts previously written off


-



-



100



100


Total credit impairment (charge)/release


19



(105)



(139)



(225)


1   The gross balance includes the notional amount of off balance sheet instruments



- page 22 -


 

Analysis of stage 2 balances

The table below analyses total stage 2 gross on-and off-balance sheet exposures and associated expected credit provisions by the key SICR driver that caused the exposures to be classified as stage 2 as at 30 June 2025 and 31 December 2024 for each segment.

Where multiple drivers apply, the exposure is allocated based on the table order. For example, a loan may have breached the PD thresholds and could also be on non-purely precautionary early alert; in this instance, the exposure is reported under 'Increase in PD'.


30.06.25

Corporate & Investment Banking

Wealth & Retail Banking

Ventures

Central & other items1

Total

Gross
$million

ECL
$million

Cove-rage
%

Gross
$million

ECL
$million

Cove-rage
%

Gross
$million

ECL
$million

Cove-rage
%

Gross
$million

ECL
$million

Cove-rage
%

Gross
$million

ECL
$million

Cove-rage
%

Increase in PD

9,051

137

1.5%

1,598

121

7.6%

51

17

33.3%

188

4

2.1%

10,888

279

2.6%

Non-purely precautionary early alert

3,911

27

0.7%

34

-

0.0%

-

-

0.0%

159

-

0.0%

4,104

27

0.7%

Higher risk (CG12)

1,618

45

2.8%

20

-

0.0%

-

-

0.0%

1,183

7

0.6%

2,821

52

1.8%

Top up/Sell down (Private Banking)

-

-

0.0%

187

-

0.0%

-

-

0.0%

-

-

0.0%

187

-

0.0%

Others

2,717

20

0.7%

180

5

2.8%

-

-

0.0%

26

-

0.0%

2,923

25

0.9%

30 days past due

-

-

0.0%

205

17

8.3%

7

3

42.9%

-

-

0.0%

212

20

9.4%

Management overlay

-

124

0.0%

-

3

0.0%

-

-

0.0%

-

-

0.0%

-

127

0.0%

Total stage 2

17,297

353

2.0%

2,224

146

6.6%

58

20

34.5%

1,556

11

0.7%

21,135

530

2.5%

 


31.12.24

Increase in PD

8,465

112

1.3%

1,366

104

7.6%

48

20

31.3%

154

-

0.0%

10,033

236

2.4%

Non-purely precautionary early alert

3,473

44

1.3%

30

-

0.0%

-

-

0.0%

-

-

0.0%

3,503

44

1.3%

Higher risk (CG12)

686

24

3.5%

18

-

0.0%

-

-

0.0%

1,488

1

0.4%

2,192

25

1.1%

Top up/Sell down (Private Banking)

-

-

0.0%

254

1

0.4%

-

-

0.0%

-

-

0.0%

254

1

0.4%

Others

2,245

25

1.1%

150

5

3.3%

-

-

0.0%

482

-

0.0%

2,877

30

1.0%

30 days past due

-

-

0.0%

212

19

9.0%

6

4

66.7%

-

-

0.0%

218

23

10.6%

Management overlay

-

157

0.0%

-

22

0.0%

-

3

0.0%

-

-

0.0%

-

182

0.0%

Total stage 2

14,869

362

2.4%

2,030

151

7.4%

54

27

40.7%

2,124

1

0.3%

19,077

541

2.8%

1   Includes Gross and ECL for Cash and balances at central banks and Assets held for sale

Credit impairment charge (reviewed)

The table below analyses credit impairment charges or releases of the ongoing business portfolio and restructuring business portfolio for the half year ended 30 June 2025.


30.06.25

30.06.241

Stage 1 & 2
$million

Stage 3
$million

Total
$million

Stage 1 & 2
$million

Stage 3
$million

Total
$million

Ongoing business portfolio







Corporate & Investment Banking

85

(99)

(14)

(51)

(3)

(54)

Wealth & Retail Banking

103

229

332

123

144

267

Ventures

(3)

27

24

7

36

43

Central & other items

(6)

-

(6)

(6)

(1)

(7)

Credit impairment charge

179

157

336

73

176

249

Restructuring business portfolio







Others

(2)

2

-

2

(11)

(9)

Credit impairment charge/(release)

(2)

2

-

2

(11)

(9)

Total credit impairment charge

177

159

336

75

165

240

1   Business segments have been re-presented in line with the RNS on Re-Presentation of Financial Information issued on 2 April 2025, with no change in total credit impairment charge



- page 23 -


 

Problem credit management and provisioning (reviewed)

Forborne and other modified loans by client segment

A forborne loan arises when a concession has been made to the contractual terms of a loan in response to a customer's financial difficulties.

Net forborne loans increased by $192 million to $976 million (31 December 2024: $784 billion), largely in CIB due to new loans classified as performing forborne in Hong Kong. Non-performing forborne loans stock increased by $41 million to $773 million (31 December 2024: $732 million), mainly in WRB.

Amortised cost

30.06.25

31.12.24

Corporate & Investment Banking
$million

Wealth &
Retail Banking
$million

Total
$million

Corporate & Investment Banking
$million

Wealth &
Retail Banking
$million

Total
$million

Gross stage 1 and 2 forborne loans

224

53

277

17

36

53

Modification of terms and conditions1

20

53

73

17

36

53

Refinancing2

204

-

204

-

-

-

Impairment provisions

(73)

(1)

(74)

-

(1)

(1)

Modification of terms and conditions1

(1)

(1)

(2)

-

(1)

(1)

Refinancing2

(72)

-

(72)

-

-

-

Net stage 1 and 2 forborne loans

151

52

203

17

35

52

Collateral

-

43

43

-

27

27

Gross stage 3 forborne loans

2,098

309

2,407

2,065

258

2,323

Modification of terms and conditions1

1,802

309

2,111

1,824

258

2,082

Refinancing2

296

-

296

241

-

241

Impairment provisions

(1,512)

(122)

(1,634)

(1,481)

(110)

(1,591)

Modification of terms and conditions1

(1,254)

(122)

(1,376)

(1,242)

(110)

(1,352)

Refinancing2

(258)

-

(258)

(239)

-

(239)

Net stage 3 forborne loans

586

187

773

584

148

732

Collateral

200

24

224

172

55

227

Net carrying value of forborne loans

737

239

976

601

183

784

1   Modification of terms is any contractual change apart from refinancing, as a result of credit stress of the counterparty, i.e. interest reductions, loan covenant waivers

2   Refinancing is a new contract to a borrower in credit stress, such that they are refinanced and can pay other debt contracts that they were unable to honour

Forborne and other modified loans by key geography

Net forborne loans increased by $192 million to $976 million (31 December 2024: $784 million), mainly on the performing forborne loans in Hong Kong.

Amortised cost

30.06.25

31.12.241

Hong Kong
$million

Korea
$million

China
$million

Singa-pore
$million

UK
$million

US
$million

Other
$million

Total
$million

Hong Kong
$million

Korea
$million

China
$million

Singa-pore
$million

UK
$million

US
$million

Other
$million

Total
$million

Performing forborne loans

134

14

-

3

-

-

52

203

2

8

-

3

-

-

39

52

Stage 3 forborne loans

113

24

75

27

102

1

431

773

110

25

85

25

81

1

405

732

Net forborne loans

247

38

75

30

102

1

483

976

112

33

85

28

81

1

444

784

1   Amounts have been re-presented from management view to financial booking basis in line with RNS on Re-Presentation of Financial Information issued on 2 April 2025

Credit Risk mitigation

Potential credit losses from any given account, customer or portfolio are mitigated using a range of tools such as collateral, netting arrangements, credit insurance and credit derivatives, and guarantees. The reliance that can be placed on these mitigants is carefully assessed in consideration of legal certainty and enforceability, market valuation correlation and counterparty risk of the guarantor.



- page 24 -


 

Collateral held on loans and advances

The table below details collateral held against exposures, separately disclosing stage 2 and stage 3 exposure and corresponding collateral.

Amortised cost

30.06.25

Net amount outstanding

Collateral

Net exposure

Total
$million

Stage 2 financial
assets
$million

Credit-impaired financial
assets (S3)
$million

Total2
$million

Stage 2 financial
|assets
$million

Credit-impaired financial
assets (S3)
$million

Total
$million

Stage 2 financial
assets
$million

Credit-impaired financial
assets (S3)
$million

Corporate & Investment Banking1

182,564

10,803

1,214

33,937

3,688

294

148,627

7,115

920

Wealth & Retail Banking

126,708

1,937

901

95,041

1,128

656

31,667

809

245

Ventures

1,555

29

3

-

-

-

1,555

29

3

Central & other items

18,290

21

-

810

21

-

17,480

-

-

Total

329,117

12,790

2,118

129,788

4,837

950

199,329

7,953

1,168

 


31.12.24

Corporate & Investment Banking1

181,897

8,657

1,376

36,750

3,052

298

145,147

5,605

1,078

Wealth & Retail Banking

119,248

1,758

858

85,163

891

584

34,085

867

274

Ventures

1,389

25

1

-

-

-

1,389

25

1

Central & other items

22,091

35

98

80

35

-

22,011

-

98

Total

324,625

10,475

2,333

121,993

3,978

882

202,632

6,497

1,451

1   Includes loans and advances to banks

2   Adjusted for over-collateralisation based on the drawn and undrawn components of exposures

Collateral - Corporate & Investment Banking (reviewed)

Our underwriting standards encourage taking specific charges on assets and we consistently seek high-quality, investment grade collateral.

Collateral taken for longer-term and sub-investment grade corporate loans decreased to 47 per cent (31 December 2024: 49 per cent).

The unadjusted market value of collateral across all asset types, in respect of CIB, without adjusting for over collateralisation, decreased to $378 billion (31 December 2024: $383 billion) predominantly due to a decrease in reverse repos.

87.0 per cent (31 December 2024: 88.5 per cent) of tangible collateral excluding reverse repurchase agreements and financial guarantees held comprises of physical assets with the remainder held in cash. Overall collateral decreased by $2.8 billion to $33.9 billion (31 December 2024: $36.8 billion) due to a reduction in reverse repos.

Non-tangible collateral, such as guarantees and standby letters of credit, is also held against corporate exposures, although the financial effect of this type of collateral is less significant in terms of recoveries. However, this is considered when determining the loss given default and other credit-related factors. Collateral is also held against off-balance sheet exposures, including undrawn commitments and trade-related instruments.



- page 25 -


 

Corporate & Investment Banking

Amortised cost

30.06.25
$million

31.12.24
$million

Maximum exposure

182,564

181,897

Property

9,917

8,504

Plant, machinery and other stock

901

935

Cash

2,367

1,973

Reverse repos

7,641

12,568

AAA

587

-

AA- to AA+

776

938

A- to A+

3,034

8,324

BBB- to BBB+

578

1,437

Lower than BBB-

-

95

Unrated

2,666

1,774

Financial guarantees and insurance

8,027

7,075

Commodities

9

33

Ships and aircraft

5,075

5,662

Total value of collateral1

33,937

36,750

Net exposure

148,627

145,147

1   Adjusted for over-collateralisation based on the drawn and undrawn components of exposures

Collateral - Wealth & Retail Banking (reviewed)

In WRB, fully secured products remained stable at 86 per cent of the total portfolio (31 December 2024: 85 per cent).

The following table presents an analysis of loans to individuals by product; split between fully secured, partially secured and unsecured.

Amortised cost

30.06.25

31.12.24

Fully secured1
$million

Partially secured1
$million

Unsecured
$million

Total2
$million

Fully secured1
$million

Partially secured1
$million

Unsecured
$million

Total²
$million

Maximum exposure

109,035

662

17,011

126,708

101,264

536

17,448

119,248

Loans to individuals









Mortgages

81,868

-

-

81,868

76,696

-

-

76,696

CCPL5

-

-

15,830

15,830

-

-

16,343

16,343

Secured wealth products

24,458

-

-

24,458

21,928

-

-

21,928

Other4,5

2,709

662

1,181

4,552

2,640

536

1,105

4,281

Total collateral2




95,041




85,163

Net exposure3




31,667




34,085

Percentage of total loans

86%

1%

13%


85%

0%

15%


1   Secured loans are fully secured if the fair value of the collateral is equal to or greater than the loan at the time of origination. All other secured loans are considered to be partially secured

2   Collateral values are adjusted where appropriate in accordance with our risk mitigation policy and for the effect of over-collateralisation

3   Amounts net of ECL

4   Includes Auto Loans previously presented separately. Prior period has been represented

5   Prior period has been represented between CCPL and Other under Fully secured

Mortgage loan-to-value ratios by geography (reviewed)

Loan-to-value (LTV) ratios measure the ratio of the current mortgage outstanding to the current fair value of the properties on which they are secured. An analysis of LTV ratios by geography for the mortgage portfolio is presented in the table below.

For the majority of mortgage loans, the value of property held as security significantly exceeds the principal outstanding of the loan. The average LTV of the overall mortgage portfolio remains stable at 49.0 per cent (31 December 2024: 48.9 per cent). The Hong Kong mortgage portfolio represents 32 per cent of total WRB mortgage portfolio and the increase in LTV from 58.6 per cent to 59.4 per cent was primarily due to a decrease in property prices. However, 29 per cent of the Hong Kong mortgage exposure is backed by credit insurance and, specifically, 94 per cent of mortgage exposure with LTV greater than 80 per cent is backed by credit insurance.



- page 26 -


 

Our other key markets continued to have low portfolio LTVs (Korea and Singapore at 42.9 per cent and 42.5 per cent respectively). Korea portfolio LTV increased slightly by 0.8 per cent (31 December 2024: 42.1 per cent) primarily due to government relaxations on LTV.

Amortised cost

30.06.25

31.12.24

Hong Kong
%
Gross

Singapore
%
Gross

Korea
%
Gross

Other
%
Gross

Total
%
Gross

Hong Kong
%
Gross

Singapore
%
Gross

Korea
%
Gross

Other
%
Gross

Total
%
Gross

Less than 50 per cent

39.2

53.6

61.3

48.6

50.4

40.9

52.7

64.1

50.2

51.3

50 per cent to 59 per cent

17.1

21.2

13.6

14.9

16.2

17.6

21.8

13.2

15.4

16.5

60 per cent to 69 per cent

13.5

14.0

15.0

17.5

14.9

12.7

15.6

13.5

17.0

14.3

70 per cent to 79 per cent

6.7

11.0

9.0

13.3

9.5

5.5

9.6

8.3

12.7

8.5

80 per cent to 89 per cent

5.2

0.1

0.9

5.0

3.0

5.1

0.1

0.8

4.1

2.9

90 per cent to 99 per cent

8.5

0.0

0.1

0.4

2.8

8.2

0.0

0.1

0.5

3.0

100 per cent and greater

9.8

0.1

0.1

0.2

3.2

10.1

0.1

0.1

0.2

3.5

Average portfolio loan-to-value

59.4

42.5

42.9

48.4

49.0

58.6

42.5

42.1

48.0

48.9

Loans to individuals - mortgages ($million)

31,055

14,836

16,997

18,980

81,868

31,506

13,756

13,703

17,731

76,696

Collateral and other credit enhancements possessed or called upon (reviewed)

The Group obtains assets by taking possession of collateral (such as property, plant and equipment) or calling upon other credit enhancements (such as guarantees). Repossessed properties are sold in an orderly fashion. Where the proceeds are in excess of the outstanding loan balance, the excess is returned to the borrower.

Certain equity securities acquired may be held by the Group for investment purposes and are classified as fair value through profit or loss, and the related loan written off. The carrying value of collateral possessed that is held on the Group's balance sheet at the end of 30 June 2025 was $nil (31 December 2024: $24 million).

Other Credit risk mitigation (reviewed)

Other forms of credit risk mitigation are set out below.

Credit default swaps

The Group has entered into credit default swaps for portfolio management purposes, referencing loan assets with a notional value of $5 billion (31 December 2024: $3.5 billion). These credit default swaps are accounted for as financial guarantees as per IFRS 9 as they will only reimburse the holder for an incurred loss on an underlying debt instrument. The Group continues to hold the underlying assets referenced in the credit default swaps and it continues to be exposed to related Credit Risk and Foreign Exchange Rate Risk on these assets.

Credit linked notes

The Group has issued credit linked notes for portfolio management purposes, referencing loan assets with a notional value of $21.6 billion (31 December 2024: $18.6 billion). The Group continues to hold the underlying assets for which the credit linked notes provide mitigation. The credit linked notes of $1.8 billion (31 December 2024: $2.0 billion) are recognised as a financial liability at amortised cost on the balance sheet and are adjusted, where appropriate, for reductions in expected future cash flows with a corresponding credit impairment in the income statement.

Off-balance sheet exposures

For certain types of exposures, such as letters of credit and guarantees, the Group obtains collateral such as cash depending on internal Credit Risk assessments, as well as in the case of letters of credit holding legal title to the underlying assets should a default take place.

Other portfolio analysis

This section provides analysis of credit quality by industry, and industry and retail products analysis of loans and advances by key geography.



- page 27 -


 

Credit quality by industry

Loans and advances

This section provides an analysis of the Group's amortised cost portfolio by industry on a gross, total credit impairment and net basis.

Amortised cost

30.06.25

Stage 1

Stage 2

Stage 3

Total

Gross balance
$million

Total credit impair-ment
$million

Net carrying amount
$million

Gross balance
$million

Total credit impair-ment
$million

Net carrying amount
$million

Gross balance
$million

Total credit impair-ment
$million

Net carrying amount
$million

Gross balance
$million

Total credit impair-ment
$million

Net carrying amount
$million

Industry:













Energy

12,862

(18)

12,844

709

(58)

651

797

(532)

265

14,368

(608)

13,760

Manufacturing

20,884

(12)

20,872

901

(14)

887

403

(309)

94

22,188

(335)

21,853

Financing, insurance
and non-banking

33,065

(21)

33,044

1,124

(3)

1,121

175

(161)

14

34,364

(185)

34,179

Transport, telecom
and utilities

16,723

(16)

16,707

2,309

(38)

2,271

396

(100)

296

19,428

(154)

19,274

Food and household products

8,846

(7)

8,839

338

(15)

323

212

(200)

12

9,396

(222)

9,174

Commercial real estate

11,977

(27)

11,950

2,139

(142)

1,997

1,609

(1,336)

273

15,725

(1,505)

14,220

Mining and quarrying

5,283

(3)

5,280

200

(5)

195

54

(51)

3

5,537

(59)

5,478

Consumer durables

6,969

(8)

6,961

229

(7)

222

254

(241)

13

7,452

(256)

7,196

Construction

1,949

(2)

1,947

484

(4)

480

161

(153)

8

2,594

(159)

2,435

Trading companies & distributors

524

-

524

12

(1)

11

94

(54)

40

630

(55)

575

Government

23,700

(5)

23,695

1,397

(14)

1,383

101

(24)

77

25,198

(43)

25,155

Other

4,551

(5)

4,546

553

(5)

548

165

(90)

75

5,269

(100)

5,169

Total

147,333

(124)

147,209

10,395

(306)

10,089

4,421

(3,251)

1,170

162,149

(3,681)

158,468

Retail Products:













Mortgage

80,210

(9)

80,201

1,160

(3)

1,157

648

(138)

510

82,018

(150)

81,868

Credit Cards

7,866

(134)

7,732

229

(79)

150

69

(58)

11

8,164

(271)

7,893

Personal Loan and other unsecured lending

9,375

(230)

9,145

228

(50)

178

306

(137)

169

9,909

(417)

9,492

Secured wealth products

23,985

(43)

23,942

349

(4)

345

532

(361)

171

24,866

(408)

24,458

Other

4,386

(13)

4,373

159

(23)

136

160

(117)

43

4,705

(153)

4,552

Total

125,822

(429)

125,393

2,125

(159)

1,966

1,715

(811)

904

129,662

(1,399)

128,263

Net carrying value (customers)¹

273,155

(553)

272,602

12,520

(465)

12,055

6,136

(4,062)

2,074

291,811

(5,080)

286,731

Net carrying value (Banks)1

41,613

(6)

41,607

737

(2)

735

48

(4)

44

42,398

(12)

42,386

1   Includes reverse repurchase agreements and other similar secured lending held at amortised cost of $4,189 million for customers and $4,250 million for Banks

- page 28 -




 

Amortised cost

31.12.24

Stage 1

Stage 2

Stage 3

Total

Gross balance
$million

Total credit impair-ment
$million

Net carrying amount
$million

Gross balance
$million

Total credit impair-ment
$million

Net carrying amount
$million

Gross balance
$million

Total credit impair-ment
$million

Net carrying amount
$million

Gross balance
$million

Total credit impair-ment
$million

Net carrying amount
$million

Industry:













Energy

12,147

(9)

12,138

468

(57)

411

870

(559)

311

13,485

(625)

12,860

Manufacturing

19,942

(12)

19,930

840

(16)

824

418

(305)

113

21,200

(333)

20,867

Financing, insurance
and non-banking

34,452

(16)

34,436

1,238

(6)

1,232

154

(142)

12

35,844

(164)

35,680

Transport, telecom
and utilities

16,099

(11)

16,088

2,309

(32)

2,277

330

(85)

245

18,738

(128)

18,610

Food and household products

8,425

(8)

8,417

267

(8)

259

251

(198)

53

8,943

(214)

8,729

Commercial real estate

12,135

(10)

12,125

1,714

(126)

1,588

1,485

(1,265)

220

15,334

(1,401)

13,933

Mining and quarrying

5,542

(3)

5,539

287

(12)

275

124

(57)

67

5,953

(72)

5,881

Consumer durables

5,988

(6)

5,982

218

(26)

192

292

(259)

33

6,498

(291)

6,207

Construction

1,925

(2)

1,923

528

(5)

523

171

(160)

11

2,624

(167)

2,457

Trading companies & distributors

589

-

589

24

(1)

23

88

(48)

40

701

(49)

652

Government

28,870

-

28,870

441

(12)

429

205

(18)

187

29,516

(30)

29,486

Other

4,590

(3)

4,587

344

(2)

342

186

(82)

104

5,120

(87)

5,033

Total

150,704

(80)

150,624

8,678

(303)

8,375

4,574

(3,178)

1,396

163,956

(3,561)

160,395

Retail Products:













Mortgage

75,340

(8)

75,332

896

(2)

894

606

(136)

470

76,842

(146)

76,696

Credit Cards

8,037

(121)

7,916

222

(80)

142

71

(60)

11

8,330

(261)

8,069

Personal Loan and other unsecured lending3

9,563

(228)

9,335

236

(53)

183

274

(129)

145

10,073

(410)

9,663

Secured wealth products

21,404

(37)

21,367

402

(6)

396

518

(353)

165

22,324

(396)

21,928

Other2,3

4,054

(9)

4,045

197

(29)

168

160

(92)

68

4,411

(130)

4,281

Total

118,398

(403)

117,995

1,953

(170)

1,783

1,629

(770)

859

121,980

(1,343)

120,637

Net carrying value (customers)¹

269,102

(483)

268,619

10,631

(473)

10,158

6,203

(3,948)

2,255

285,936

(4,904)

281,032

Net carrying value (Banks)1

43,208

(10)

43,198

318

(1)

317

83

(5)

78

43,609

(16)

43,593

1   Includes reverse repurchase agreements and other similar secured lending held at amortised cost of $9,660 million for customers and $2,946 million for Banks

2   Includes Auto Loans previously presented separately. Prior period has been represented

3   Prior period has been represented between Personal Loan and other unsecured lending and Other

Industry and Retail Products analysis of loans and advances by key geography

This section provides an analysis of the Group's amortised cost loan portfolio, net of provisions, by industry and geography.

The Manufacturing sector group is spread across a diverse range of industries, including automobiles and components, capital goods, pharmaceuticals, biotech and life sciences, technology hardware and equipment, chemicals, paper products and packaging, with lending spread over 3,052 clients.



- page 29 -


 

Corporate & Investment Banking and Central & other items

Amortised Cost

30.06.25

31.12.241

Hong Kong
$million

China
$million

Singa-pore
$million

UK
$million

US
$million

Other
$million

Total
$million

Hong Kong
$million

China
$million

Singa-pore
$million

UK
$million

US
$million

Other
$million

Total
$million

Energy

2,003

82

3,240

2,969

1,658

3,808

13,760

1,036

60

3,089

3,666

1,771

3,238

12,860

Manufacturing

4,179

4,340

2,105

831

2,875

7,523

21,853

4,077

4,200

1,655

660

2,307

7,968

20,867

Financing, insurance and non-banking

4,089

3,780

3,132

6,895

11,584

4,699

34,179

3,633

3,486

2,401

12,282

9,900

3,978

35,680

Transport, telecom and utilities

5,153

268

4,059

2,465

902

6,427

19,274

5,131

612

3,766

2,596

880

5,625

18,610

Food and household products

489

314

1,705

1,447

865

4,354

9,174

1,038

428

1,472

1,151

685

3,955

8,729

Commercial Real estate

4,193

320

1,040

1,496

1,978

5,193

14,220

4,512

334

1,421

1,107

1,575

4,984

13,933

Mining and Quarrying

518

718

501

1,405

102

2,234

5,478

608

606

866

1,644

214

1,943

5,881

Consumer durables

3,461

346

358

97

423

2,511

7,196

2,780

293

504

154

481

1,995

6,207

Construction

285

124

352

136

240

1,298

2,435

318

156

482

96

247

1,158

2,457

Trading Companies & Distributors

56

115

99

31

49

225

575

95

103

106

31

40

277

652

Government

4,821

26

16,003

1,440

3

2,862

25,155

3,836

117

20,266

1,671

4

3,592

29,486

Other

1,266

625

1,011

704

355

1,208

5,169

1,419

563

816

724

233

1,278

5,033

Net Loans and advances
to Customers

30,513

11,058

33,605

19,916

21,034

42,342

158,468

28,483

10,958

36,844

25,782

18,337

39,991

160,395

Net Loans and advances
to Banks

13,054

2,096

8,312

4,143

1,855

12,926

42,386

15,058

2,432

7,701

4,337

2,322

11,743

43,593

1   Amounts have been re-presented from management view to financial booking basis in line with RNS on Re-Presentation of Financial Information issued on 2 April 2025 and also to include Central & others amounts

Wealth & Retail Banking and Ventures

Amortised Cost

30.06.25

31.12.242

Hong Kong
$million

Korea
$million

Singapore
$million

Other
$million

Total
$million

Hong Kong
$million

Korea
$million

Singapore
$million

Other
$million

Total
$million

Mortgages

31,055

16,997

14,836

18,980

81,868

31,506

13,703

13,756

17,731

76,696

Credit Cards

4,063

25

2,441

1,364

7,893

4,262

38

2,252

1,517

8,069

Personal Loans and other unsecured lending3

1,057

2,838

336

5,261

9,492

1,057

2,796

301

5,509

9,663

Secured wealth products

5,976

24

12,605

5,853

24,458

5,229

24

10,793

5,882

21,928

Other Retail1,3

586

2,278

159

1,529

4,552

579

2,153

194

1,355

4,281

Net Loans and advances to Customers

42,737

22,162

30,377

32,987

128,263

42,633

18,714

27,296

31,994

120,637

1   Includes Auto Loans previously presented separately. Prior period has been represented

2   Prior year has been represented to include Ventures

3   Prior period has been represented between Personal Loans and other unsecured lending and Other Retail

High carbon sectors

Sectors are identified and grouped as per the International Standard Industrial Classification (ISIC) system and exposure numbers have been updated to include all in-scope ISIC codes used for target setting among the high carbon sectors.

The maximum exposures shown in the table include loans and advances to customers at amortised cost, Fair Value through profit or loss, and committed facilities available as per IFRS 9 - Financial Instruments.



- page 30 -


 

Maximum exposure

Amortised Cost

30.06.25

Maximum on Balance Sheet Exposure
(net of credit impairment)
$million

Collateral
$million

Net On
Balance Sheet Exposure
$million

Undrawn Commitments (net of credit impairment)
$million

Financial Guarantees
(net of credit impairment)
$million

Net Off Balance Sheet Exposure
$million

Total On & Off Balance Sheet
Net Exposure
$million

Industry:








Automotive manufacturers

3,960

395

3,565

4,066

717

4,783

8,348

Aviation

1,698

1,042

656

856

881

1,737

2,393

Steel

1,615

354

1,261

807

357

1,164

2,425

Coal Mining

1

1

-

-

-

-

-

Aluminium

1,263

48

1,215

303

65

368

1,583

Cement

691

65

626

946

244

1,190

1,816

Shipping

6,826

4,458

2,368

2,572

361

2,933

5,301

Commercial Real Estate

8,292

3,981

4,311

3,273

410

3,683

7,994

Oil & Gas

8,668

991

7,677

8,689

7,025

15,714

23,391

Power

6,888

1,318

5,570

4,916

1,103

6,019

11,589

Total1

39,902

12,653

27,249

26,428

11,163

37,591

64,840

Total Corporate & Investment Banking2

204,061

27,787

176,274

135,007

94,237

229,244

405,518

Total Group3

429,962

129,788

300,174

209,765

103,840

313,605

613,779

 


31.12.24

Industry:








Automotive manufacturers

3,881

69

3,812

3,331

605

3,936

7,748

Aviation

1,829

960

869

842

928

1,770

2,639

Steel

1,526

316

1,210

816

325

1,141

2,351

Coal Mining

25

-

25

-

-

-

25

Aluminium

1,341

32

1,309

354

53

407

1,716

Cement

709

55

654

637

267

904

1,558

Shipping

7,038

5,037

2,001

2,176

397

2,573

4,574

Commercial Real Estate

7,635

3,400

4,235

2,758

684

3,442

7,677

Oil & Gas

7,421

988

6,433

7,928

7,079

15,007

21,440

Power

6,341

1,500

4,841

4,538

1,124

5,662

10,503

Total1

37,746

12,357

25,389

23,380

11,462

34,842

60,231

Total Corporate & Investment Banking2

196,823

32,152

164,671

118,106

81,132

199,238

363,909

Total Group3

420,117

121,993

298,124

193,115

90,602

283,717

581,841

1   Maximum on Balance sheet exposure includes FVTPL amount of High Carbon sector is $644 million (31 December 2024: $749 million)

2   Include on balance sheet FVTPL amount of $63,882 million (31 December 2024: $ 58,519 million) for Corporate & Investment Banking loans to customers

3   Total Group includes net loans and advances to banks and net loans and advances to customers held at amortised cost of $42,386 million (31 December 2024: $43,593 million) and $286,731 (31 December 2024: $281,032 million) respectively and loans to banks and loans and advances to customers held at FVTPL of $36,958 million (31 December 2024: $ 36,967 million) and $63,887 million (31 December 2024: $ 58,525 million) respectively. Refer to the credit quality table below

Maturity and expected credit loss for high-carbon sectors

Sector

30.06.25

31.12.24

Loans and advances (Drawn funding)
$million

Maturity Buckets1

Expected Credit Loss
$million

Loans and advances (Drawn funding)
$million

Maturity Buckets1

Expected Credit Loss
$million

Less than
1 year
$million

More than
1 to 5 years
$million

More than
5 years
$million

Less than
1 year
$million

More than
1 to 5 years
$million

More than
5 years
$million

Automotive Manufacturers

3,961

3,511

372

78

1

3,883

3,458

369

56

2

Aviation

1,704

405

56

1,243

6

1,833

231

404

1,198

4

Cement

731

372

359

-

40

724

356

368

-

15

Coal Mining

15

15

-

-

14

38

25

13

-

13

Steel

1,676

927

156

593

61

1,598

941

133

524

72

Aluminium

1,271

1,116

155

-

8

1,352

1,089

177

86

11

Oil & Gas

8,823

2,678

2,630

3,515

155

7,580

2,601

2,407

2,572

159

Power

6,957

1,899

1,688

3,370

69

6,401

1,700

1,404

3,297

60

Shipping

6,845

1,070

2,170

3,605

19

7,053

1,035

2,450

3,568

15

Commercial Real Estate

8,456

4,104

4,147

205

164

7,773

3,880

3,680

213

138

Total balance1

40,439

16,097

11,733

12,609

537

38,235

15,316

11,405

11,514

489

1   Gross of credit impairment



- page 31 -


 

Sectors of interest

Commercial Real Estate


30.06.25

Maximum on Balance Sheet Exposure
(net of credit impairment)
1
$million

Collateral
$million

Net On
Balance Sheet Exposure
$million

Undrawn Commitments (net of credit impairment)
$million

Financial Guarantees
(net of credit impairment)
$million

Net Off
Balance Sheet Exposure
$million

Total On & Off Balance Sheet
Net Exposure
$million

Commercial Real Estate

14,561

6,637

7,924

5,894

713

6,607

14,531

 


31.12.24

Commercial Real Estate

14,037

5,947

8,090

4,932

670

5,602

13,692

1   Includes net loans and advances of $14,220 million (31 December 2024: $13,933 million) as detailed in the table below.

Analysis of credit quality of loans and advances of Commercial Real Estate

Amortised Costs

30.06.25
Gross
$million

31.12.24
Gross
$million

Strong

7,707

7,222

Satisfactory

6,005

6,515

Higher risk

403

112

Credit impaired (stage 3)

1,609

1,485

Total Gross Balance

15,724

15,334

Strong

(24)

(83)

Satisfactory

(83)

(44)

Higher risk

(61)

(9)

Credit impaired (stage 3)

(1,336)

(1,265)

Total Credit Impairment

(1,504)

(1,401)

Total Net of Credit Impairment

14,220

13,933

Strong

0.3%

1.1%

Satisfactory

1.4%

0.7%

Higher risk

15.1%

8.0%

Credit impaired (stage 3)

83.0%

85.1%

Cover Ratio

9.6%

9.1%

An analysis of the net CRE loans and advances balance by key geography, is set out below.

China commercial real estate

The table below represents the on and off-balance sheet items that are exposed to China CRE by credit quality.


30.06.25

31.12.24

China
$million

Hong Kong
$million

Total
$million

China
$million

Hong Kong
$million

Total
$million

Loans to customers

312

1,567

1,879

324

1,598

1,922

Off balance sheet

-

26

26

1

40

41

Total

312

1,593

1,905

325

1,638

1,963








Loans to customers - By Credit quality







Gross







Strong

-

-

-

-

12

12

Satisfactory

148

323

471

172

338

510

Higher risk

33

-

33

12

42

54

Credit impaired (stage 3)

131

1,244

1,375

140

1,206

1,346

Total

312

1,567

1,879

324

1,598

1,922








Loans to customers - ECL







Strong

-

-

-

-

-

-

Satisfactory

-

(60)

(60)

(2)

(73)

(75)

Higher risk

-

-

-

-

(1)

(1)

Credit impaired (stage 3)

(64)

(1,155)

(1,219)

(63)

(1,111)

(1,174)

Total

(64)

(1,215)

(1,279)

(65)

(1,185)

(1,250)

 

- page 32 -




 

Debt securities and other eligible bills (reviewed)

This section provides further detail on gross debt securities and treasury bills.

The credit quality descriptions in the table below align to those used for CIB and Central and other items, as described below. Debt securities held that have a short-term external rating are reported against the long-term rating of the issuer. For securities that are unrated, the Group applies an internal credit rating, as described under the 'Credit rating and measurement' section on page 201 of the 2024 Annual Report.

Total gross debt securities and other eligible bills increased by $14 billion to $157.6 billion (31 December 2024: $143.6 billion) due to investments in high quality liquid assets.

Stage 1 gross balance increased by $14.4 billion to $156.3 billion (31 December 2024: $141.9 billion), mainly due Hong Kong exposures.

Stage 2 gross balance decreased by $0.6 billion to $1.1 billion (31 December 2024: $1.6 billion).

Stage 3 gross balance increased by $0.2 billion to $0.3 billion (31 December 2024: $0.1 billion) due to increases across two sovereign exposures.

Amortised cost and FVOCI

30.06.25

31.12.24

Gross
$million

ECL
$million

Net2
$million

Gross
$million

ECL
$million

Net2
$million

Stage 1

156,264

(29)

156,235

141,862

(23)

141,839

- Strong

152,430

(24)

152,406

138,353

(19)

138,334

- Satisfactory

3,834

(5)

3,829

3,509

(4)

3,505

Stage 2

1,059

(7)

1,052

1,614

(4)

1,610

- Strong

216

(2)

214

562

-

562

- Satisfactory

255

(3)

252

31

-

31

- High Risk

588

(2)

586

1,021

(4)

1,017

Stage 3

306

(6)

300

103

(2)

101

Gross balance¹

157,629

(42)

157,587

143,579

(29)

143,550

1   Stage 3 gross includes $289 million (31 December 2024: $59 million) originated credit-impaired debt securities with $6 million impairment (31 December 2024: $Nil)

2   FVOCI instruments are not presented net of ECL on the balance sheet. While the presentation is on a net basis for the table, the total net on-balance sheet amount is $157,617 million (31 December 2024: $143,562 million). Refer to the Analysis of financial instrument by stage table

- page 33 -




 

IFRS 9 ECL methodology (reviewed)

Refer to page 236 of the 2024 Annual Report for the 'Approach for determining ECL', 'Application of lifetime ECL' and pages 244 to 246 for 'SICR', 'Assessment of credit-impaired financial assets' and 'Governance of PMAs and application of expert credit judgement in respect of ECL'. There have been no changes to the Group's approach in determining SICR compared to 31 December 2024.

Composition of credit impairment provisions (reviewed)

The table below summarises the key components of the Group's credit impairment provision balances as at 30 June 2025 and 31 December 2024.


30.06.2025

31.12.2024

Corporate & Investment Banking
$ million

Wealth & Retail Banking
$ million

Ventures
$ million

Central & other items
$ million
4

Total
$ million

Corporate & Investment Banking
$ million

Wealth & Retail Banking
$ million

Ventures
$ million

Central & other items
$ million
4

Total
$ million

Modelled ECL provisions
(base forecast)

372

639

64

40

1,115

337

613

61

37

1,048

Impact of multiple economic scenarios1

43

33

-

1

77

24

19

-

-

43

Total ECL provisions before management judgements

415

672

64

41

1,192

361

632

61

37

1,091

Of which: Model performance
post model adjustments

(10)

7

-

-

(3)

-

14

-

-

14

Judgemental post model adjustments2

-

(11)

-

-

(11)

-

(23)

-

-

(23)

Management overlays3











- China commercial real estate

58

-

-

-

58

70

-

-

-

70

- Other

93

19

1

-

113

109

27

7

-

143

Total modelled provisions

566

680

65

41

1,352

540

636

68

37

1,281

Of which:











Stage 1

188

412

34

30

664

133

392

30

34

589

Stage 2

353

146

20

11

530

362

151

27

1

541

Stage 3

25

122

11

-

158

45

93

11

2

151

Stage 3 non-modelled provisions

3,337

677

-

65

4,079

3,267

665

-

54

3,986

Total credit impairment provisions

3,903

1,357

65

106

5,431

3,807

1,301

68

91

5,267

1   Includes upwards judgemental post-model adjustment of $47 million (31 December 2024: $28 million)

2   Excludes $47 million (31 December 2024: $28 million) upwards judgemental post-model adjustment which is included in 'Impact of multiple economic scenarios'

3   $29 million (31 December 2024: $32 million) is in stage 1, $128 million (31 December 2024: $181 million) in stage 2 and $14 million (31 December 2024: nil) in stage 3

4   Includes ECL on cash and balances at central banks, accrued income, assets held for sale and other assets

Model performance post model adjustments (PMA)

As part of model monitoring and independent validation processes, where a model's performance breaches the approved monitoring thresholds or validation standards, an assessment is performed to determine whether a model performance PMA is required to temporarily remediate the model issue. The process for the determination of PMAs is set out in the 'Governance of PMAs and application of expert credit judgement in respect of ECL' section on page 246 of the 2024 Annual Report.

As at 30 June 2025, model performance PMAs have been applied for five models out of the total of 110 models. In aggregate, these PMAs reduce the Group's impairment provisions by $3 million (less than 1 per cent of modelled provisions) compared with a $14 million increase as at 31 December 2024. The change from 31 December 2024 was primarily due to a new PMA in CIB to address overprediction in the commercial banking portfolio.

In addition to these model performance PMAs, separate judgemental post model and management adjustments have also been applied as set out below.


30.06.25
$ million

31.12.24
$ million

Model performance PMAs



Corporate & Investment Banking

(10)

-

Wealth & Retail Banking

7

14

Total model performance PMAs

(3)

14

 

- page 34 -




 

Key assumptions and judgements in determining ECL

Incorporation of forward-looking information

The evolving economic environment is a key determinant of the ability of a bank's clients to meet their obligations as they fall due. It is a fundamental principle of IFRS 9 that the provisions banks hold against potential future Credit Risk losses should depend, not just on the health of the economy today, but should also take into account potential changes to the economic environment. For example, if a bank was to anticipate a sharp slowdown in the world economy over the coming year, it should hold more provisions today to absorb the credit losses likely to occur in the near future.

To capture the effect of changes to the economic environment, the PDs and LGDs used to calculate ECL incorporate forward-looking information in the form of forecasts of the values of economic variables and asset prices that are likely to have an effect on the repayment ability of the Group's clients.

The 'base forecast' of the economic variables and asset prices is based on management's view of the five-year outlook, supported by projections from the Group's in-house research team and outputs from a third-party model that project specific economic variables and asset prices. The research team takes consensus views into consideration, and senior management review projections for some core country variables against consensus when forming their view of the outlook. For the period beyond five years, management utilises the in-house research view and third-party model outputs, which allow for a reversion to long-term growth rates or norms. All projections are updated on a quarterly basis.

Forecast of key macroeconomic variables underlying the ECL calculation and the impact on non-linearity

In the Base Forecast, management's view of the most likely outcome - the pace of growth of the world economy is expected to slow from 3.2 per cent in 2024 to 3.1 per cent in 2025. This compares to the average of 3.7 per cent growth for the 10 years prior to COVID-19 (between 2010 and 2019). For many economies 2025 is a year of two halves as tariff front-running now gives way to implementation. Front-loaded exports to the US ahead of higher tariffs supported economic activity in H1 2025, leading to a record Q1 2025 US trade deficit and stronger than expected growth in China. H2 2025 is likely to see weaker economic momentum in both economies, as well as elevated recession risks in Europe. Asia is expected to remain as the outperformer this year.

The global economy faces continued challenges due to ongoing trade policy instability. US tariffs remain fluid as tariff negotiations continue, elevating the uncertainty over the outlook for the rest of the year. Geopolitical tensions and sovereign debt pressures also continue to pose significant risks.

Whilst the quarterly Base Forecasts inform the Group's strategic plan, one key requirement of IFRS 9 is that the assessment of provisions should consider multiple future economic environments. For example, the global economy may grow more quickly or more slowly than the Base Forecast, and these variations would have different implications for the provisions that the Group should hold today. As the negative impact of an economic downturn on credit losses tends to be greater than the positive impact of an economic upturn, if the Group sets provisions only on the ECL under the Base Forecast it might maintain a level of provisions that does not appropriately capture the range of potential outcomes. To address the inherent uncertainty in economic forecast, and the property of skewness (or non-linearity), IFRS 9 requires reported ECL to be a probability-weighted ECL, calculated over a range of possible outcomes.

To assess the range of possible outcomes the Group simulates a set of 50 scenarios around the Base Forecast, calculates the ECL under each of them and assigns an equal weight of 2 per cent to each scenario outcome. These scenarios are generated by a Monte Carlo simulation, which addresses the challenges of crafting many realistic alternative scenarios in the many countries in which the Group operates by means of a model, which produces these alternative scenarios whilst considering the degree of historical uncertainty (or volatility) observed from Q1 1990 to Q1 2025 around economic outcomes, the trends in each macroeconomic variable modelled and the correlation in the unexplained movements around these trends. This naturally means that each of the 50 scenarios do not have a specific narrative, although collectively they explore a range of hypothetical alternative outcomes for the global economy, including scenarios that turn out better than expected and scenarios that amplify anticipated stresses. Further details on the impact of mutiple economic scenarios (including any PMAs) are set out below.

The GDP graphs below illustrate the shape of the Base Forecast for key footprint markets in relation to prior periods' actuals. The long-term growth rates are based on the pace of economic expansion expected for 2030. The tables below provide a summary of the Group's Base Forecast for these markets. The peak/trough amounts show the highest and lowest points within the Base Forecast.



- page 35 -


 

In 2025, China's GDP growth is projected to moderate slightly to 4.8 per cent from 5.0 per cent in 2024, primarily due to persistent challenges in the property sector and the anticipated impact of higher tariffs on export momentum. Singapore's growth is expected to slow more significantly, reaching 1 per cent in 2025, down from 4.4 per cent last year, with weaker global demand and trade uncertainty contributing to the slowdown. South Korea and Hong Kong are also expected to experience limited growth in 2025 due to the uncertain global environment, with projections of 0.8 per cent and 2.2 per cent respectively. India's growth is anticipated to record 6.5 percent in 2025, up from 6.2 per cent in 2024, driven by consumption, particularly in rural areas, supported by lower inflation and potentially higher crop yields.

Long-term growth = GDP growth expected for 2030


30.06.25

China

Hong Kong

GDP growth
(YoY%)

Unemployment
%

3-month
interest rates
%

House prices5
(YoY %)

GDP growth
(YoY %)

Unemployment
%

3-month
interest rates
%

House prices
(YoY %)

Base forecast1









2025

4.8

3.5

1.5

(4.9)

2.2

3.2

2.9

1.0

2026

4.3

3.4

1.3

(3.2)

2.5

3.3

3.6

7.6

2027

4.1

3.3

1.2

(0.9)

2.5

3.3

3.9

5.0

2028

3.5

3.3

1.2

0.9

2.2

3.3

4.1

3.4

2029

3.9

3.3

1.2

2.0

1.8

3.3

4.1

2.4

5-year average2

3.9

3.4

1.3

(0.4)

2.2

3.3

3.8

4.4

Quarterly peak

6.4

3.5

1.4

2.6

2.6

3.3

4.1

8.0

Quarterly trough

2.1

3.3

1.2

(4.7)

1.5

3.2

2.4

2.2

Monte Carlo









Low3

(6.3)

2.9

(0.9)

(9.9)

(3.7)

1.6

(0.5)

(20.5)

High4

16.3

3.7

3.4

12.2

8.2

5.9

8.8

33.3

 


30.06.25

Singapore

Korea

GDP growth (YoY%)

Unemployment6
%

3-month
interest rates
%

House prices (YoY%)

GDP growth (YoY%)

Unemployment
%

3-month
interest rates
%

House prices (YoY %)

Base forecast1









2025

1.0

2.9

2.1

2.5

0.8

2.8

2.6

0.4

2026

1.9

3.0

2.0

2.3

2.3

2.9

2.2

2.2

2027

2.5

2.9

2.6

2.6

2.0

2.9

2.2

2.3

2028

2.7

2.9

3.1

2.7

2.0

2.9

2.2

2.1

2029

2.8

2.9

3.1

2.7

2.2

3.0

2.2

2.0

5-year average2

2.2

2.9

2.7

2.6

2.1

2.9

2.2

2.0

Quarterly peak

2.9

3.1

3.1

2.8

2.5

3.0

2.4

2.4

Quarterly trough

(0.7)

2.9

1.9

1.8

0.9

2.8

2.2

0.5

Monte Carlo









Low3

 (4.3)

 1.5

 (0.0)

 (18.6)

 (3.2)

 1.5

 (1.0)

 (6.5)

High4

 8.5

 4.5

 6.2

 22.9

 7.1

 5.1

 6.0

 9.3

 


30.06.25

India

Brent Crude
$ pb

GDP growth
(YoY%)

Unemployment7
%

3-month
interest rates
%

House prices
(YoY%)

Base forecast1






2025

6.5

NA

5.6

5.8

68.9

2026

6.5

NA

5.7

6.4

67.5

2027

6.5

NA

5.7

6.4

69.5

2028

6.4

NA

5.7

6.3

71.6

2029

6.3

NA

5.7

6.2

73.1

5-year average2

6.4

NA

5.7

6.3

70.4

Quarterly peak

7.1

NA

5.8

7.3

74.5

Quarterly trough

6.0

NA

5.5

5.2

66.1

Monte Carlo






Low3

 2.9

 N/A

 1.1

 1.1

 29.0

High4

 9.8

 N/A

 10.2

 12.9

 136.3



- page 36 -


 


31.12.24

China

Hong Kong

GDP growth
(YoY%)

Unemployment
%

3-month
interest rates
%

House prices5
(YoY%)

GDP growth
(YoY%)

Unemployment
%

3-month
interest rates
%

House prices
(YoY%)

5-year average2

4.1

3.3

1.7

(1.3)

2.2

3.1

2.4

3.8

Quarterly peak

5.3

3.5

1.9

2.3

3.5

3.2

2.9

6.8

Quarterly trough

3.2

3.1

1.6

(5.6)

1.5

3.0

2.1

(2.6)

Monte Carlo









Low3

(1.0)

2.8

0.6

(10.1)

(1.8)

1.8

0.3

(13.1)

High4

9.3

3.7

3.0

7.8

5.8

5.1

5.3

22.2

 


31.12.24

Singapore

Korea

GDP growth
(YoY%)

Unemployment6
%

3-month
interest rates
%

House prices
(YoY%)

GDP growth
(YoY%)

Unemployment
%

3-month
interest rates
%

House prices
(YoY%)

5-year average2

2.3

2.7

2.0

2.4

2.0

2.8

2.9

2.8

Quarterly peak

3.4

2.8

2.4

3.2

2.2

2.9

3.2

4.8

Quarterly trough

0.6

2.7

1.6

(0.4)

1.5

2.8

2.9

1.9

Monte Carlo









Low3

(2.7)

2.0

0.3

(10.5)

(1.3)

2.2

0.8

(4.3)

High4

7.0

3.6

3.9

17.5

5.2

3.5

5.7

9.8

 


31.12.24

India

Brent crude
$ pb

GDP growth
(YoY%)

Unemployment
%

3-month
interest rates
%

House prices
(YoY%)

5-year average2

6.6

NA

6.0

6.4

76.2

Quarterly peak

7.1

NA

6.2

7.3

77.8

Quarterly trough

5.9

NA

6.0

6.0

74.8

Monte Carlo






Low3

3.2

NA

1.9

(0.1)

44.5

High4

10.0

NA

10.3

12.6

107.8

1   Data presented are those used in the calculation of ECL and presented as average growth for the year. These may differ slightly to forecasts presented elsewhere in this Half-Year Report as they are finalised before the period end. The annual averages are calendar year where 2025 = Q1 2025 to Q4 2025.

2   5 year averages reported for 30.06.25 cover 20 quarters from Q3 2025 to Q2 2030. They cover Q1 2025 to Q4 2029 for the numbers reported for the 2024 Annual report

3   Represents the 10th percentile in the range of economic scenarios used to determine non-linearity

4   Represents the 90th percentile in the range of economic scenarios used to determine non-linearity

5   A judgemental management adjustment is held in respect of the China commercial real estate sector, as discussed below

6   Singapore unemployment rate covers the resident unemployment rate, which refers to citizens and permanent residents

7   India unemployment is not available due to insufficient data

Impact of multiple economic scenarios

The final probability weighted ECL reported by the Group is a simple average of the ECL for each of the 50 scenarios simulated using a Monte Carlo model. The Monte Carlo approach has the advantage that it generates many alternative scenarios that cover our global footprint. The range of scenarios is restricted through the use of ceilings and floors applied to the underlying macroeconomic variables, and these were redeveloped in the first half of 2025 to capture a broader range of outcomes.

Given continuing heightened levels of tariff and geopolitical uncertainty, a $47 million (31 December 2024: $28 million) non-linearity PMA has been applied, $24 million (31 December 2024: $13 million) for CIB and Central and other items, and $23 million (31 December 2024: $15 million) for WRB.

The total amount of non-linearity has been estimated by assigning probability weights of 55 per cent, 27 per cent and 18 per cent respectively to the Base Forecast, 'Moderate Global Trade and Geopolitical Tensions', and 'Bank Capital Stress Test' scenarios which are presented below and comparing this to the unweighted Base Forecast ECL. At 31 December 2024, probability weights of 68 per cent, 22 per cent and 10 per cent respectively to the Base Forecast, 'Higher for Longer Commodities and Rates', and 'Global Trade and Geopolitical Tensions' scenarios as disclosed in the 2024 Annual Report.



- page 37 -


 

The non-linearity PMA represents the difference between the probability weighted ECL calculated using the three scenarios and the probability weighted ECL calculated by the Monte Carlo model.

The total amount of non-linearity including the PMA is $77 million (31 December 2024: $43 million). The CIB and Central and other items portfolio accounted for $44 million (31 December 2024: $24 million) of the calculated non-linearity, with the remaining $33 million (31 December 2024: $19 million) attributable to WRB portfolios.

The impact of multiple economic scenarios on total modelled ECL is set out in the table below, together with the management overlay and other judgemental adjustments.


Base forecast
$million

Multiple economic scenarios1
$million

Management overlays and other judgemental adjustments
$million

Total
modelled
ECL
2
$million

Total expected credit loss at 30 June 2025

1,115

77

160

1,352

Total expected credit loss at 31 December 2024

1,048

43

190

1,281

1   Includes an upwards judgemental PMA of $47 million (31 December 2024: $28 million)

2   Total modelled ECL comprises stage 1 and stage 2 balances of $1,194 million (31 December 2024: $1,130 million) and $158 million (31 December 2024: $151 million) of modelled ECL on stage 3 loans

The average ECL under multiple scenarios is 7 per cent (31 December 2024: 4 per cent) higher than the ECL calculated using only the most likely scenario (the Base Forecast). Portfolios that are more sensitive to non-linearity include those with greater leverage and/or a longer tenor, such as Project and Shipping Finance portfolios. Other portfolios display minimal non-linearity owing to limited responsiveness to macroeconomic impacts for structural reasons, such as significant collateralisation as with the WRB mortgage portfolios.

Judgemental management adjustments

As at 30 June 2025, the Group held judgemental adjustments for ECL as set out in the table below. All of the judgemental adjustments have been determined after taking account of the model performance PMAs reported on below. They are reassessed quarterly and are reviewed and approved by the IFRS 9 Impairment Committee (IIC) and will be released when no longer relevant.

30 June 2025

Corporate & Investment Banking
$million

Wealth & Retail Banking

Ventures
$million

Central & other items
$million

Total
$million

Mortgages
$million

Credit Cards
$million

Other
$million

Total
$million

Judgemental post model adjustments

23

(1)

14

(1)

12

-

1

36

Judgemental management overlays:









- China CRE

58

-

-

-

-

-

-

58

- Other

93

-

1

18

19

1

-

113

Total judgemental adjustments

174

(1)

15

17

31

1

1

207

Judgemental adjustments by stage:









Stage 1

36

-

9

8

17

1

1

55

Stage 2

138

(1)

6

9

14

-

-

152

Stage 3

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

31 December 2024









Judgemental post model adjustments

13

-

9

(17)

(8)

-

-

5

Judgemental management overlays:









- China CRE

70

-

-

-

-

-

-

70

- Other

109

-

5

22

27

7

-

143

Total judgemental adjustments

192

-

14

5

19

7

-

218

Judgemental adjustments by stage:









Stage 1

27

-

10

(11)

(1)

4

-

30

Stage 2

165

-

5

25

30

3

-

198

Stage 3

-

-

(1)

(9)

(10)

-

-

(10)

Judgemental PMAs

As at 30 June 2025, judgemental PMAs have been applied that increase ECL by a net $36 million (31 December 2024: $5 million increase). $47 million (31 December 2024: $28 million) of the increase in ECL related to multiple economic scenarios (see 'Impact of multiple economic scenarios' section). This was partly offset by a reduction of ECL of $11 million for certain WRB models, primarily to adjust for temporary factors impacting modelled outputs. These will be released when these factors normalise.



- page 38 -


 

Judgemental management overlays

China CRE

The real estate market in China has been in a downturn since late 2021 with continued over supply, developer liquidity issues and a lack of foreign investment. The government has introduced a number of monetary and fiscal stimuli during the period, including reducing down payment ratios, interest rates, mortgage rates, and taxes as well as new policies permitting local governments to purchase homes as affordable housing. However, demand still remains muted with some small improvements in prices and volumes only visible in first tier cities. Consumer confidence and continued support from the government are key to reversing the declining trend and ensuring further stabilisation in 2025.

The Group's loans and advances to China CRE clients was $1.9 billion at 30 June 2025 (31 December 2024: $1.9 billion). Heightened risk management continues to be carried out, with a focus on managing upcoming maturities through refinancing and/or repayment. No new financing transactions were entered into during the period. Clients with exposure maturing within the next 12 months have been placed on purely precautionary or non-purely precautionary early alert, where appropriate, for closer monitoring. Given the evolving nature of the risks in the China CRE sector, a management overlay of $58 million (31 December 2024: $70 million) has been taken by estimating the impact of further deterioration to exposures in this sector. The decrease from 31 December 2024 was primarily driven by repayments and utilisation due to movement to stage 3.

Other

In CIB, additional overlays of $93 million (31 December 2024: $109 million) have been taken, $35 million (31 December 2024: $58 million) of which is in Hong Kong, with the remainder relating to Bangladesh and an immaterial amount for climate risks. The overlay in Hong Kong reflects subdued economic activity and increasing commercial property vacancy rates, which contributes to an uncertain outlook that are not yet fully reflected in the credit grades and modelled ECL. The risk of further impairment remains as a result of subdued economic activity in the property sector and the related liquidity constraints faced by counterparties as a result. The overlays reduction since 31 December 2024 was due to risks being partially manifested in the portfolio modelled ECL. The overlay in Bangladesh reflects the political situation that has contributed to an increasing level of uncertainty in the macroeconomic outlook. The overlays for Hong Kong and Bangladesh have been determined by estimating the impact of a deterioration to certain exposures in these countries.

In WRB, overlays of $19 million (31 December 2024: $27 million) includes $14 million (31 December 2024: $21 million) in Korea to cover the risks relating to the failure of two e-commerce payment platforms in 2024, and an immaterial adjustment for climate risks and other items. The overlays reduction since 31 December 2024 was due to risks being partially manifested in the portfolio modelled ECL, and overlay releases for bankruptcy trends in certain markets previously held at 31 December 2024 are now covered by a separate judgemental PMA.

Further details on the adjustment for Climate Risk are set out in Note 1 of the 'Notes to the financial statements' section in the 2024 Annual Report.

Stage 3 assets

Credit-impaired assets managed by Stressed Asset Group (SAG) incorporate forward-looking economic assumptions in respect of the recovery outcomes identified and are assigned individual probability weightings per IFRS 9. These assumptions are not based on a Monte Carlo simulation but are informed by the Base Forecast.

Sensitivity of ECL calculation to macroeconomic variables

The ECL calculation relies on multiple variables and is inherently non-linear and portfolio-dependent, which implies that no single analysis can fully demonstrate the sensitivity of the ECL to changes in the macroeconomic variables. The Group has conducted a series of analyses with the aim of identifying the macroeconomic variables which might have the greatest impact on the overall ECL. These encompassed single variable and multi-variable exercises, using simple up/down variation and extracts from actual calculation data, as well as bespoke scenario design assessments.

The primary conclusion of these exercises is that no individual macroeconomic variable is materially influential. The Group believes this is plausible as the number of variables used in the ECL calculation is large. This does not mean that macroeconomic variables are uninfluential; rather, that the Group believes that consideration of macroeconomics should involve whole scenarios, as this aligns with the multi-variable nature of the calculation.



- page 39 -


 

The Group faces downside risks in the operating environment related to the uncertainties surrounding the macroeconomic outlook. To explore this, a sensitivity analysis of ECL was undertaken to explore the effect of slower economic recoveries across the Group's footprint markets. Two downside scenarios were considered in particular to explore the current uncertainties over commodity prices. The 'Moderate Global Trade and Geopolitical Tensions' (Moderate GTGT) scenario is a moderate downside scenario characterised by an escalating trade war between the US and China and other economies. The second Bank of England's 'Bank Capital Stress Test' (BCST) scenario is characterized by a severe but plausible global aggregate supply shock leading to deep recessions globally. It also features higher commodity prices, inflation and interest rates.


Baseline

Moderate GTGT

BCST

Five year average

Peak/Trough

Five year average

Peak/Trough

Five year average

Peak/Trough

China GDP

3.9

6.4/2.1

2.9

4.4/0.2

2.7

4.2/(1.7)

China unemployment

3.4

3.5/3.3

4.1

4.4/3.6

4.3

5.0/3.7

China property prices

(0.4)

2.6/(4.7)

0.4

6.5/(11.4)

(3.8)

11.1/(11.4)

Hong Kong GDP

2.2

2.6/1.5

0.6

1.5/(3.2)

0.1

2.7/(6.6)

Hong Kong unemployment

3.3

3.3/3.2

4.8

5.3/3.6

6.1

7.6/3.7

Hong Kong property prices

4.4

8.0/2.2

1.7

13.4/(12.8)

(3.2)

7.9/(10.5)

US GDP

1.9

2.2/1.5

1.0

2.0/(0.3)

0.2

1.4/(3.5)

Singapore GDP

2.2

2.9/(0.7)

0.9

2.8/(2.9)

0.6

3.8/(6.7)

India GDP

6.4

7.1/6.0

5.5

6.6/3.8

4.8

6.3/0.8

Crude oil

70.4

74.5/66.1

62.5

70.1/55.4

110.4

146.2/74.5

Period covered from Q3 2025 to Q2 2030.


Base (GDP, YoY%)

Moderate GTGT (GDP, YoY%)

Difference from Base

2025

2026

2027

2028

2029

2025

2026

2027

2028

2029

2025

2026

2027

2028

2029

China

3.5

5.4

3.2

3.9

3.8

1.8

2.4

2.7

3.9

3.8

(1.6)

(3.0)

(0.6)

(0.0)

0.0

Hong Kong

2.3

2.5

2.4

2.0

1.6

(2.2)

0.7

1.5

1.5

1.4

(4.5)

(1.9)

(0.9)

(0.5)

(0.2)

US

1.7

2.1

1.8

1.9

1.8

0.6

(0.1)

1.1

1.7

1.9

(1.1)

(2.2)

(0.8)

(0.1)

0.1

Singapore

0.4

2.4

2.6

2.7

2.8

(2.2)

(0.4)

1.9

2.6

2.4

(2.6)

(2.8)

(0.7)

(0.1)

(0.4)

India

6.4

6.6

6.5

6.4

6.3

5.1

4.4

5.8

6.1

6.2

(1.3)

(2.2)

(0.7)

(0.3)

(0.1)

Each year is from Q3 to Q2. For example 2025 is from Q3 2025 to Q2 2026.


Base (GDP, YoY%)

BCST (GDP, YoY%)

Difference from Base

2025

2026

2027

2028

2029

2025

2026

2027

2028

2029

2025

2026

2027

2028

2029

China

3.5

5.4

3.2

3.9

3.8

0.6

0.6

4.0

4.1

3.9

(2.8)

(4.7)

0.8

0.2

0.1

Hong Kong

2.3

2.5

2.4

2.0

1.6

(3.2)

(3.3)

2.5

2.4

2.4

(5.5)

(5.9)

0.0

0.4

0.8

US

1.7

2.1

1.8

1.9

1.8

(1.0)

(1.9)

1.1

1.3

1.3

(2.8)

(4.0)

(0.7)

(0.5)

(0.6)

Singapore

0.4

2.4

2.6

2.7

2.8

(4.7)

(3.1)

3.6

3.6

3.6

(5.1)

(5.5)

1.0

0.8

0.7

India

6.4

6.6

6.5

6.4

6.3

3.4

2.1

6.1

6.2

6.2

(3.0)

(4.5)

(0.4)

(0.2)

(0.1)

Each year is from Q3 to Q2. For example 2025 is from Q3 2025 to Q2 2026.

The total modelled stage 1 and 2 ECL provisions (including both on and off-balance sheet instruments) would be approximately $107 million higher under the 'Moderate GTGT' scenario, and $268 million higher under the 'BCST' scenario than the baseline ECL provisions (which excluded the impact of multiple economic scenarios and judgemental management adjustments which may already capture some of the risks in these scenarios). Stage 2 exposures as a proportion of stage 1 and 2 exposures would increase from 2.9 per cent in the base case to 3.3 per cent and 3.8 per cent respectively under the 'Moderate GTGT' and 'BCST' scenarios. This includes the impact of exposures transferring to stage 2 from stage 1 but does not consider an increase in stage 3 defaults.

Under both scenarios, the majority of the increase in ECL in CIB came from the main CRE, Project Finance and Corporate portfolios. For the main corporate portfolios, ECL would increase by $29 million and $14 million in the 'Moderate GTGT' and 'BCST' scenarios respectively, and the proportion of stage 2 exposures would increase from 4.6 per cent in the base case to 5.1 per cent and 5.7 per cent respectively. Although the 'BCST' is a more severe scenario, the impact on the main corporate portfolio is moderated compared to the 'Moderate GTGT' scenario as the scenario includes an increase in commodity prices, which some of the models view positively.



- page 40 -


 

For WRB, most of the increase in ECL came from the unsecured retail portfolios, particularly from the credit cards portfolios in Hong Kong and Singapore. Under the 'Moderate GTGT' and 'BCST' scenarios, credit card ECL would increase by $13 million and $47 million respectively and the proportion of stage 2 credit card exposures would increase from 2.5 per cent in the base scenario to 3.1 per cent and 4.3 per cent under 'Moderate GTGT' and 'BCST' respectively. Additionally, under the 'BCST' scenario, Korea personal loans, Private Bank, and retail mortgages ECL would increase by $11 million, $86 million, and 27 million respectively. The proportion of stage 2 mortgages would increase from 1.2 per cent in the base case to 1.4 per cent and 2.4 per cent respectively, with the Hong Kong, Singapore, and Korea portfolios most impacted.

There was no material change in modelled stage 3 provisions as these primarily relate to unsecured WRB exposures for which the LGD is not sensitive to changes in the macroeconomic forecasts. There is also no material change for non-modelled stage 3 exposures as these are more sensitive to client-specific factors than to alternative macroeconomic scenarios.

The actual outcome of any scenario may be materially different due to, among other factors, the effect of management actions to mitigate potential increases in risk and changes in the underlying portfolio.


Gross as reported1
$million

ECL as reported2
$million

ECL Base case
$million

ECL Moderate GTGT
$million

ECL BCST
$million

Stage 1 modelled






Corporate & Investment Banking

389,444

151

136

152

155

Wealth & Retail Banking

186,055

395

379

388

428

Ventures

11,179

33

33

33

33

Central & other items

174,458

30

29

30

32

Total excluding management judgements

761,136

609

577

603

648

Stage 2 modelled






Corporate & Investment Banking

17,297

215

187

249

291

Wealth & Retail Banking

2,224

132

115

134

208

Ventures

54

20

20

20

20

Central & other items

1,081

8

8

8

8

Total excluding management judgements

20,656

375

330

411

527

Total Stage 1 and 2 modelled






Corporate & Investment Banking

406,741

366

323

401

446

Wealth & Retail Banking

188,279

527

494

522

636

Ventures

11,233

53

53

53

53

Central & other items

175,539

38

37

38

40

Total excluding management judgements

781,792

984

907

1,014

1,175







Stage 3 exposures excluding management judgements

6,952

4,179




Other financial assets3

128,832

61




ECL from management judgements


207




Total financial assets reported at 30 June 2025

917,576

5,431




1   Gross balances includes both on- and off-balance sheet instruments; allocation between stage 1 and 2 will differ by scenario

2   Includes ECL for both on- and off-balance sheet instruments

3   Includes cash and balances at central banks, accrued income, other financial assets, and assets held for sale



- page 41 -


 

Traded Risk

Market Risk (reviewed)

Market Risk is the potential for fair value loss due to adverse moves in financial markets. The Group's exposure to Market Risk arises predominantly from the following sources:

Trading book:

-  The Group provides clients with access to markets, facilitation of which entails the Group taking moderate Market Risk positions. All trading teams support client activity. There are no proprietary trading teams. Hence, income earned from Market Risk-related activities is primarily driven by the volume of client activity.

Non-trading book:

-  Treasury is required to hold a liquid assets buffer, much of which is held in high-quality marketable debt securities.

-  The Group underwrites and sells down loans, and invests in select investment grade debt securities with no trading intent.

-  The Group has capital invested and related income streams denominated in currencies other than US dollars. To the extent that these income streams are not hedged, the Group is subject to Structural Foreign Exchange Risk, which is reflected in reserves.

A summary of our current policies and practices regarding Market Risk management is provided in the 'Principal Risks' section of the 2024 Annual Report (page 201).

The primary categories of Market Risk for the Group are:

Interest Rate Risk: arising from changes in yield curves and implied volatilities.

Foreign Exchange Risk: arising from changes in currency exchange rates and implied volatilities.

Commodity Risk: arising from changes in commodity prices and implied volatilities.

Credit Spread Risk: arising from changes in the price of debt instruments and credit-linked derivatives and driven by factors other than the level of risk-free interest rates.

Equity Risk: arising from changes in the prices of equities and implied volatilities.

Market Risk movements

Value at Risk (VaR) allows the Group to manage Market Risk across the trading book and most of the fair valued non-trading books.

There have been a number of market events in H1 2025 that led to increased market volatility. Q1 2025 was dominated by fears over US tariffs, with the S&P 500 exhibiting its worst underperformance versus emerging markets since 2017. US yields fell over the quarter on recession concerns, while yields in other major bond markets increased, notably Germany on unprecedented fiscal stimulus, driven by security fears associated with US isolationism. This uncertainty drove gold prices higher and risk assets lower, especially US high-yield credit. Despite recession concerns, oil prices remained supported by tension in the Middle East. In Q2 2025, market volatility increased driven by the imposition of tariffs on Liberation Day and then subsequent suspensions and re-impositions. Additional volatility was driven by military hostilities in India-Pakistan and within the Middle East, and subsequent ceasefires. The market consequences included the worst H1 2025 performance of the US dollar against foreign exchanges since 2002, while the S&P 500 rose in Q2 2025, closing near its all-time high. The price of crude oil, having spiked in June 2025 on fears over potential closure of the Strait of Hormuz, closed lower in Q2 2025 on global trade uncertainty; in contrast, gold continued to rise over the quarter.

Trading VaR

The average level of trading VaR in H1 2025 was $27.9 million, 35 per cent higher than H2 2024 ($20.7 million) and 30 per cent higher than H1 2024 ($21.5 million). The increase in trading average VaR was driven by an increase in market volatility combined with a VaR model enhancement to make the model more responsive to such an upturn in market volatility.



 

- page 42 -


 

Daily Value at Risk (VaR at 97.5%, one day) (reviewed)

 

Trading1

6 months ended 30.06.25

6 months ended 31.12.24

6 months ended 30.06.24

Average
$million

High
$million

Low
$million

Half Year
$million

Average
$million

High
$million

Low
$million

Half Year
$million

Average
$million

High
$million

Low
$million

Half Year
$million

Interest Rate Risk

13.9

18.3

9.8

13.0

12.1

17.2

7.0

12.0

13.2

22.0

9.1

10.6

Credit Spread Risk

8.9

13.0

5.4

12.2

6.1

7.4

5.1

5.4

7.2

9.6

4.8

6.0

Foreign Exchange Risk

7.5

12.3

4.9

6.5

9.7

15.0

5.0

7.4

8.9

14.5

5.2

9.1

Commodity Risk

13.0

21.7

2.9

5.1

4.5

7.6

2.7

4.3

5.2

10.0

2.4

5.7

Equity Risk

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

Diversification effect2

(15.4)

NA

NA

(13.8)

(11.7)

NA

NA

(8.3)

(13.0)

NA

NA

(15.9)

Total2

27.9

34.9

18.9

23.0

20.7

30.3

13.2

20.8

21.5

33.1

13.0

15.5

1   The trading book for Market Risk is defined in the 'Trading Book Capital Requirements Regulation (CRR)' part of the PRA Handbook which transposes the requirements of CRR Part 3 Title I Chapter 3 as onshored in the UK. This restricts the positions permitted in the trading book.

2   The total VaR is non-additive across risk types due to diversification effects, which is measured as the difference between the sum of the VaR by individual risk type or business and the combined total VaR. As the maximum and minimum occur on different days for different risk types or businesses, it is not meaningful to calculate a portfolio diversification benefit for these measures

Risks not in VaR

In H1 2025, the main market risks not reflected in VaR were:

Basis risks for which the historical market price data is limited and is therefore proxied, giving rise to potential proxy basis risk that is not captured in VaR

Potential depeg risk from currencies currently pegged or managed, where the historical one-year VaR observation period may not reflect the possibility of a change in the currency regime or a sudden depegging

Additional capital is set aside to cover such 'risks not in VaR'.

Backtesting

In H1 2025, there were no regulatory backtesting negative exceptions at Group level. In the one-year period to 30 June 2025, there have been no Group-level backtesting exceptions.

An enhancement to the VaR model was implemented from January 2025 to increase the model's responsiveness to abrupt upturns in market volatility.

Counterparty Credit Risk

Counterparty Credit Risk is the potential for loss in the event of the default of a derivative counterparty, after taking into account the value of eligible collaterals and risk mitigation techniques. The Group's counterparty credit exposures are included in the Credit Risk section.

Derivative financial instruments Credit Risk mitigation

The Group enters into master netting agreements, which in the event of default result in a single amount owed by or to the counterparty through netting the sum of the positive and negative mark-to-market values of applicable derivative transactions.

In addition, the Group enters into credit support annexes (CSAs) with counterparties where collateral is deemed a necessary or desirable mitigant to the exposure. Cash collateral includes collateral called under a variation margin process from counterparties if total uncollateralised mark-to-market exposure exceeds the threshold and minimum transfer amount specified in the CSA. With certain counterparties, the CSA is reciprocal and requires us to post collateral if the overall mark-to- market values of positions are in the counterparty's favour and exceed an agreed threshold.

Liquidity and Funding Risk

Liquidity and Funding Risk is the risk that the Group may not have sufficient stable or diverse sources of funding to meet its obligations as they fall due.

The Group's Liquidity and Funding Risk framework requires each country to ensure that it operates within predefined liquidity limits and remains in compliance with Group liquidity policies and practices, as well as local regulatory requirements.

The Group achieves this through a combination of setting Risk Appetite and associated limits, policy formation, risk measurement and monitoring, prudential and internal stress testing, governance and review.

- page 43 -


 

Throughout 2025, the Group retained a robust liquidity position across key metrics. The Group continues to focus on improving the quality and diversification of its funding mix and remains committed to supporting its clients.

Liquidity and Funding Risk metrics

The Group continually monitors key liquidity metrics, both on a country basis and consolidated across the Group.

The following liquidity and funding Board Risk Appetite metrics define the maximum amount and type of risk that the Group is willing to assume in pursuit of its strategy: liquidity coverage ratio (LCR), internal liquidity stress, recovery capacity and net stable funding ratio (NSFR). In addition to the Board Risk Appetite, there are further limits that apply at Group and country level such as external wholesale borrowing (WBE) and cross-currency limits.

Liquidity coverage ratio (LCR)

The LCR is a regulatory requirement set to ensure the Group has sufficient unencumbered high-quality liquid assets to meet its liquidity needs in a 30-calendar-day liquidity stress scenario.

The Group monitors and reports its liquidity positions under the Liquidity Coverage Ratio per PRA rulebook and has maintained its LCR above the prudential requirement. The Group maintained robust liquidity ratios throughout 2025.

At the reporting date, the Group LCR was 146 per cent (31 December 2024: 138 per cent), with a surplus to both Board-approved Risk Appetite and regulatory requirements.

Adequate liquidity was held across our footprint to meet all local prudential LCR requirements where applicable.

The Liquidity buffer reported is after deductions made to reflect the impact of limitations in the transferability of entity liquidity around the Group. This resulted in a deduction of $55 billion to the liquidity buffer (LCR HQLA) as at 30 June 2025.


30.06.25
$million

31.12.24
$million

Liquidity buffer

187,496

170,306

Total net cash outflows

128,151

123,226

Liquidity coverage ratio

146%

138%

 

Stressed coverage

The Group intends to maintain a prudent and sustainable funding and liquidity position, in all countries and currencies, such that it can withstand a severe but plausible liquidity stress.

Our approach to managing liquidity and funding is reflected in the Board-level Risk Appetite Statement which includes the following:

"The Group should have sufficient stable and diverse sources of funding to meet its contractual and contingent obligations as they fall due."

The Group's Internal Liquidity Adequacy Assessment Process ('ILAAP') stress testing framework covers the following stress scenarios:

Standard Chartered-specific - captures the liquidity impact from an idiosyncratic event affecting Standard Chartered only with the rest of the market assumed to be operating normally.

Market-wide - captures the liquidity impact from a market-wide crisis affecting all participants in a country, region or globally.

Combined - assumes both Standard Chartered-specific and market-wide events affect the Group simultaneously and hence is the most severe scenario.

All scenarios include, but are not limited to, modelled outflows for retail and wholesale funding, off-balance sheet funding risk, cross-currency funding risk, intraday risk, franchise risk and risks associated with a deterioration of a firm's credit rating. Concentration risk approach captures single name and industry concentration. Internal stress testing results show that, as at 30 June 2025, Group and all countries were able to survive for a period of time with positive surpluses as defined under each scenario. The results take into account currency convertibility and portability constraints while calculating the liquidity surplus at Group level. Standard Chartered Bank's credit ratings as at 30 June 2025 were A+ with stable outlook (Fitch), A+ with stable outlook (S&P) and A1 with positive outlook (Moody's). As of 30 June 2025, the estimated contractual outflow of a three-notch long-term ratings downgrade is $0.8 billion.

- page 44 -

Advances-to-deposits ratio

This is defined as the ratio of total loans and advances to customers relative to total customer deposits. An advances-to-deposits ratio below 100 per cent demonstrates that customer deposits exceed customer loans as a result of the emphasis placed on generating a high level of funding from customers. The Group's advances-to-deposits ratio has improved by 2.3 per cent as customer deposit growth exceeds growth in customer loans and advances. Deposits from customers as at 30 June 2025 are $542,348 million (31 December 2024: $486,261 million).


30.06.25
$million

31.12.24
$million

Total loans and advances to customers1,2

276,422

259,269

Total customer accounts3

542,348

486,261

Advances-to-deposits ratio

51.0%

53.3%

1   Excludes reverse repurchase agreement and other similar secured lending of $4,189 million (31 December 2024:$9,660 million) and includes loans and advances to customers held at fair value through profit and loss of $8,119 million (31 December 2024: $7,084 million)

2   Loans and advances to customers for the purpose of the advances-to-deposits ratio excludes $14,239 million (31 December 2024: $19,187 million) of approved balances held with central banks, confirmed as repayable at the point of stress

3   Includes customer accounts held at fair value through profit or loss of $24,958 million (31 December 2024: $21,772 million)

Net stable funding ratio (NSFR)

The NSFR is a PRA regulatory requirement that stipulates institutions to maintain a stable funding profile in relation to an assumed duration of their assets and off-balance sheet activities over a one-year horizon. It is the ratio between the amount of available stable funding (ASF) and the amount of required stable funding (RSF). ASF factors are applied to balance sheet liabilities and capital, based on their perceived stability and the amount of stable funding they provide. Likewise, RSF factors are applied to assets and off-balance sheet exposures according to the amount of stable funding they require. The regulatory requirements for NSFR are to maintain a ratio of at least 100 per cent. The average ratio for the past four quarters is 137 per cent.

Liquidity pool

The liquidity value of the Group's LCR eligible liquidity pool at the reporting date was $187 billion. The figures in the table below account for haircuts, currency convertibility and portability constraints per PRA rules for transfer restrictions (amounting to $55 billion as at 30 June 2025), and therefore are not directly comparable with the consolidated balance sheet. A liquidity pool is held to offset stress outflows as defined in the LCR per PRA rulebook.


30.06.25
$million

31.12.24
$million

Level 1 securities



Cash and balances at central banks

86,388

76,094

Central banks, governments/public sector entities

89,238

74,182

Multilateral development banks and international organisations

7,191

14,386

Other

460

343

Total Level 1 securities

183,277

165,005

Level 2 A securities

3,703

4,367

Level 2 B securities

516

934

Total LCR eligible assets

187,496

170,306

Liquidity analysis of the Group's balance sheet

Contractual maturity of assets and liabilities

The following table presents assets and liabilities by maturity groupings based on the remaining period to the contractual maturity date as at the balance sheet date on a discounted basis. Contractual maturities do not necessarily reflect actual repayments or cashflows. Within the tables below, cash and balances with central banks, interbank placements and investment securities that are fair valued through other comprehensive income are used by the Group principally for liquidity management purposes. As at the reporting date, assets remain predominantly short-dated, with 58 per cent maturing in less than one year.

- page 45 -


30.06.25

One month
or less
$million

Between one month and three months
$million

Between three months and
six months
$million

Between six months and nine months
$million

Between nine months and one year
$million

Between
one year and two years
$million

Between
two years and five years
$million

More than
five years
and undated
$million

Total
$million

Assets










Cash and balances at
central banks

69,253

-

-

-

-

-

-

10,912

80,165

Derivative financial instruments

15,694

10,181

9,599

6,638

3,475

5,548

7,647

5,443

64,225

Loans and advances to banks1,2

19,868

17,585

11,524

7,348

8,116

8,993

4,115

1,795

79,344

Loans and advances to customers1,2

84,528

37,657

25,261

15,231

15,646

39,059

32,349

100,887

350,618

Investment securities1

16,805

26,083

18,853

22,846

15,126

37,676

48,352

73,525

259,266

Other assets1

20,454

46,949

1,359

416

806

39

66

10,229

80,318

Total assets

226,602

138,455

66,596

52,479

43,169

91,315

92,529

202,791

913,936











Liabilities










Deposits by banks1,3

30,337

2,304

1,404

192

1,179

4,322

2,548

2

42,288

Customer accounts1,4

423,214

38,415

30,685

15,380

12,331

8,893

49,889

3,326

582,133

Derivative financial instruments

17,450

14,035

10,334

7,033

3,562

5,165

7,512

4,787

69,878

Senior debt5

820

2,267

1,401

1,211

2,096

6,630

20,185

20,737

55,347

Other debt securities in issue1

2,438

5,181

9,051

5,469

2,962

1,090

769

778

27,738

Other liabilities

16,290

42,430

2,222

849

1,960

1,859

1,636

5,858

73,104

Subordinated liabilities and other borrowed funds

-

63

9

144

45

1,422

736

6,359

8,778

Total liabilities

490,549

104,695

55,106

30,278

24,135

29,381

83,275

41,847

859,266

Net liquidity gap

(263,947)

33,760

11,490

22,201

19,034

61,934

9,254

160,944

54,670

 


31.12.24

Assets










Cash and balances at
central banks

55,646

-

-

-

-

-

-

7,801

63,447

Derivative financial instruments

22,939

15,556

12,217

7,265

4,328

7,067

7,448

4,652

81,472

Loans and advances to banks1,2

22,381

21,722

10,588

6,771

4,986

8,407

3,715

1,990

80,560

Loans and advances to customers1,2

65,688

58,765

25,739

15,479

16,192

31,240

31,766

94,688

339,557

Investment securities1

13,016

25,886

21,546

14,789

14,688

32,815

41,423

62,418

226,581

Other assets1

12,601

32,130

1,333

381

931

71

64

10,560

58,071

Total assets

192,271

154,059

71,423

44,685

41,125

79,600

84,416

182,109

849,688











Liabilities










Deposits by banks1,3

24,293

2,345

1,621

848

571

4,342

1,939

3

35,962

Customer accounts1,4

379,926

37,502

25,863

10,152

10,123

9,695

47,367

2,635

523,263

Derivative financial instruments

21,680

17,115

11,773

7,018

4,353

6,660

8,144

5,321

82,064

Senior debt5

609

1,755

4,074

2,132

932

7,926

18,784

17,886

54,098

Other debt securities in issue1

2,734

2,663

6,550

4,535

5,015

851

1,206

688

24,242

Other liabilities

12,173

43,574

3,020

1,441

155

4,494

682

2,854

68,393

Subordinated liabilities and other borrowed funds

-

64

23

180

13

359

1,978

7,765

10,382

Total liabilities

441,415

105,018

52,924

26,306

21,162

34,327

80,100

37,152

798,404

Net liquidity gap

(249,144)

49,041

18,499

18,379

19,963

45,273

4,316

144,957

51,284

1   Loans and advances, investment securities, deposits by banks, customer accounts and debt securities in issue include financial instruments held at fair value through profit or loss, see Note 13 Financial instruments

2   Loans and advances include reverse repurchase agreements and other similar secured lending of $98.8 billion (31 December 2024: $98.8 billion)

3   Deposits by banks include repurchase agreements and other similar secured borrowing of $9.4 billion (31 December 2024: $8.7 billion)

4   Customer accounts include repurchase agreements and other similar secured borrowing of $39.8 billion (31 December 2024: $37.0 billion)

5   Senior debt maturity profiles are based upon contractual maturity, which may be later than call options over the debt held by the Group

- page 46 -


 

Behavioural maturity of financial assets and liabilities

The cashflows presented in the previous section reflect the cashflows that will be contractually payable over the residual maturity of the instruments. However, contractual maturities do not necessarily reflect the timing of actual repayments or cashflow. In practice, certain assets and liabilities behave differently from their contractual terms, especially for short-term customer accounts, credit card balances and overdrafts, which extend to a longer period than their contractual maturity.

On the other hand, mortgage balances tend to have a shorter repayment period than their contractual maturity date. Expected customer behaviour is assessed and managed on a country basis using qualitative and quantitative techniques, including analysis of observed customer behaviour over time.

Maturity of financial liabilities on an undiscounted basis

The following table analyses the contractual cashflows payable for the Group's financial liabilities by remaining contractual maturities on an undiscounted basis. The financial liability balances in the table below will not agree with the balances reported in the consolidated balance sheet as the table incorporates all contractual cashflows, on an undiscounted basis, relating to both principal and interest payments. Derivatives not treated as hedging derivatives are included in the 'On demand' time bucket and not by contractual maturity.

Within the 'More than five years and undated' maturity band are undated financial liabilities, the majority of which relate to subordinated debt, on which interest payments are not included as this information would not be meaningful, given the instruments are undated. Interest payments on these instruments are included within the relevant maturities up to five years.


30.06.25

One month
or less
$million

Between one month and three months
$million

Between
three months and six months
$million

Between six months and nine months
$million

Between nine months and one year
$million

Between
one year and two years
$million

Between
two years and five years
$million

More than
five years
and undated
$million

Total
$million

Deposits by banks

30,417

2,320

1,422

197

1,202

4,341

2,603

2

42,504

Customer accounts

423,779

38,700

31,103

15,716

12,640

9,353

51,116

4,824

587,231

Derivative financial instruments1

68,339

51

114

74

51

195

389

665

69,878

Debt securities in issue

3,620

7,712

10,810

7,204

5,520

9,351

24,852

24,614

93,683

Subordinated liabilities and other borrowed funds

19

131

12

150

51

1,536

976

12,141

15,016

Other liabilities

15,572

42,796

2,129

813

1,934

1,813

1,630

7,830

74,517

Total liabilities

541,746

91,710

45,590

24,154

21,398

26,589

81,566

50,076

882,829

 


31.12.24

Deposits by banks

24,303

2,360

1,660

862

589

4,347

1,939

4

36,064

Customer accounts

380,377

37,790

26,277

10,384

10,438

9,937

47,642

3,396

526,241

Derivative financial instruments1

80,055

13

12

10

3

216

592

1,163

82,064

Debt securities in issue

3,622

4,551

11,007

7,056

6,319

10,261

23,184

21,337

87,337

Subordinated liabilities and other borrowed funds

19

134

46

206

14

392

2,345

13,800

16,956

Other liabilities

10,421

44,933

2,894

1,408

152

4,433

682

4,802

69,725

Total liabilities

498,797

89,781

41,896

19,926

17,515

29,586

76,384

44,502

818,387

1   Derivatives are on a discounted basis

Interest Rate Risk in the Banking Book

The following table provides the estimated impact to a hypothetical base case projection of the Group's earnings under the following scenarios:

A 50 basis point parallel interest rate shock (up and down) to the current market-implied path of rates, across all yield curves

A 100 basis point parallel interest rate shock (up and down) to the current market-implied path of rates, across all yield curves

These interest rate shock scenarios assume all other economic variables remain constant. The sensitivities shown represent the estimated change to a hypothetical base case projected net interest income (NII), plus the change in interest rate implied income and expense from FX swaps used to manage banking book currency positions, under the different interest rate shock scenarios.

- page 47 -

The base case projected NII is based on the current market-implied path of rates and forward rate expectations. The NII sensitivities below stress this base case by a further 50 or 100bps. Actual observed interest rate changes will likely differ from market expectation. Accordingly, the shocked NII sensitivity does not represent a forecast of the Group's net interest income.

The interest rate sensitivities are indicative stress tests and based on simplified scenarios, estimating the aggregate impact of an unanticipated, instantaneous parallel shock across all yield curves over a one-year horizon. The assessment assumes that the size and mix of the balance sheet remain constant and that there are no specific management actions in response to the change in rates. No assumptions are made in relation to the impact on credit spreads in a changing rate environment.

Significant modelling and behavioural assumptions are made regarding scenario simplification, market competition, pass-through rates, asset and liability re-pricing tenors, and price flooring. In particular, the assumption that interest rates of all currencies and maturities shift by the same amount concurrently, and that no actions are taken to mitigate the impacts arising from this are considered unlikely. Reported sensitivities will vary over time due to a number of factors including changes in balance sheet composition, market conditions, customer behaviour and risk management strategy. Therefore, while the NII sensitivities are a relevant measure of the Group's interest rate exposure, they should not be considered an income or profit forecast.

Estimated one-year impact to earnings from a parallel shift in yield curves at the beginning of the period of:

30.06.25

USD bloc
$million

HKD bloc
$million

SGD bloc
$million

GBP bloc
$million

CNY bloc2
$million

INR bloc
$million

EUR bloc2
$million

Other
currency bloc
1
$million

Total
$million

+ 50 basis points

30

40

20

20

-

20

-

40

170

- 50 basis points

(40)

(60)

(30)

(20)

(20)

(20)

(10)

(70)

(270)











+ 100 basis points

50

70

30

30

10

40

10

80

320

- 100 basis points

(100)

(130)

(60)

(40)

(40)

(40)

(20)

(140)

(570)

 


31.12.24

+ 50 basis points

20

30

10

10

20

30

10

80

210

- 50 basis points

(40)

(30)

(20)

(10)

(30)

(30)

(20)

(90)

(270)











+ 100 basis points

30

60

20

20

30

40

30

160

390

- 100 basis points

(90)

(50)

(40)

(30)

(50)

(40)

(40)

(210)

(550)

1   The largest exposures within the Other currency bloc are JPY and TWD

2   The +50bps CNY and EUR sensitivities are positive, but round to zero

As at 30 June 2025, the Group estimates the one-year impact of an instantaneous, parallel increase across all yield curves of 50 basis points to increase projected NII by $170 million. The equivalent impact from a parallel decrease of 50 basis points would result in a reduction in projected NII of $270 million. The Group estimates the one-year impact of an instantaneous, parallel increase across all yield curves of 100 basis points to increase projected NII by $320 million. The equivalent impact from a parallel decrease of 100 basis points would result in a reduction in projected NII of $570 million.

The benefit from rising interest rates is primarily from reinvesting at higher yields and from assets re-pricing faster and to a greater extent than deposits. NII sensitivity in falling rate scenarios has increased versus 31 December 2024, due to an increase in balance sheet size, with assets repricing faster than liabilities, and due to lower HIBOR rates. This impact was partially offset by an increase in programmatic hedging.

Over the course of H1 2025 the notional of interest rate swaps and HTC-accounted bond portfolios used to reduce NII sensitivity through the cycle increased from $64 billion to $75 billion. As at June 2025, the portfolios had a weighted average maturity of 2.7 years, which reflects the behaviouralised lives of the rate-insensitive deposit and equity balances that they hedge, and a yield of 3.6 per cent. In addition, $18 billion of fixed rate commercial assets provide structural offset to the structural liabilities.

Non-Trading VaR

The average level of non-trading VaR in H1 2025 was $47.3 million, 37 per cent higher than H2 2024 ($34.5

million) and 40 per cent higher than H1 2024 ($33.9 million). The increase in  non-trading average VaR was driven by an increase in market volatility combined with a VaR model enhancement to make the model more responsive to such an upturn in market volatility, an increase in the interest rate risk of the Treasury portfolio and larger US agency bonds inventory in the CIB non-trading portfolio.

- page 48 -

Daily Value at Risk (VaR at 97.5%, one day) (reviewed)

Non-trading1

6 months ended 30.06.25

6 months ended 31.12.24

6 months ended 30.06.24

Average
$million

High
$million

Low
$million

Half Year
$million

Average
$million

High
$million

Low
$million

Half Year
$million

Average
$million

High
$million

Low
$million

Half Year
$million

Interest Rate Risk

40.7

64.6

23.8

56.6

25.3

32.9

17.4

32.5

30.8

35.5

26.4

32.4

Credit Spread Risk

20.8

29.0

13.9

24.5

16.8

17.7

13.8

15.7

17.7

24.8

10.0

17.8

Foreign Exchange Risk

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

Commodity Risk

2.2

4.8

0.8

1.1

1.3

1.6

0.8

0.8

1.3

1.8

0.6

1.5

Equity Risk

-

-

-

-

0.4

0.8

-

-

0.4

0.9

-

0.1

Diversification effect2

(16.4)

NA

NA

(19.8)

(9.3)

NA

NA

(10.2)

(16.3)

NA

NA

(11.0)

Total2

47.3

66.6

32.3

62.3

34.5

41.0

28.6

38.8

33.9

44.1

29.2

40.8

1   The non-trading book VaR does not include the loan underwriting business

2  The total VaR is non-additive across risk types due to diversification effects, which is measured as the difference between the sum of the VaR by individual risk type or

business and the combined total VaR. As the maximum and minimum occur on different days for different risk types or businesses, it is not meaningful to calculate a portfolio diversification benefit for these measures

Operational and Technology Risk

Operational and Technology Risk profile

Operational and Technology risks remain elevated in areas such as Change Mismanagement Risk, Operational Resilience and Third-Party Risk Management, which are being addressed through ongoing control enhancement programmes. The Group also prioritises management of Systems Health/Technology risk, Transaction Processing and Regulatory Compliance risks.

Additionally, the Group continues to monitor and manage Operational and Technology risks associated with external factors such as geopolitical issues, cyber-attacks threats and the misuse of Artificial Intelligence. This enables the Group to keep pace with new business developments, whilst ensuring that its risk and control frameworks evolve accordingly. The Group continues to enhance its risk management capabilities to understand the full spectrum of risks in the operating environment, strengthen its defences and improve its overall resilience.

Other principal risks

The losses arising from operational failures for other principal and integrated risks are reported as operational losses. Operational losses do not include operational risk-related credit impairments.

- page 49 -


 

Capital review

The Capital review provides an analysis of the Group's capital and leverage position, and requirements.

Capital summary

The Group's capital, leverage and minimum requirements for own funds and eligible liabilities (MREL) position is managed within the Board-approved risk appetite. The Group is well capitalised with low leverage and high levels of loss-absorbing capacity.


30.06.25

31.12.24

CET1 capital

14.3%

14.2%

Tier 1 capital

16.9%

16.9%

Total capital

20.5%

21.5%

Leverage ratio

4.7%

4.8%

MREL ratio

33.3%

34.2%

Risk-weighted assets (RWA) $million

259,684

247,065

The Group's capital, leverage and MREL positions were all above current requirements and Board-approved risk appetite. The Group's CET1 capital increased 11 basis points to 14.3 percent of RWA since FY2024. Profits, movements in FVOCI, FX translation reserves and decrease in regulatory deductions were partly offset by RWA growth and distributions (including ordinary share buybacks of $1.5 billion during the period).

As at 30 June 2025 the Group's Pillar 2A was 3.7 percent of RWA, of which at least 2.1 per cent must be held in CET1 capital. The Group's minimum CET1 capital requirement was 10.5 per cent at 30 June 2025.

The Group CET1 capital ratio at 30 June 2025 reflects the share buybacks of $1.5 billion announced during the period. The CET1 capital ratio also includes an accrual for the FY 2025 dividend. The Board has recommended an interim dividend for H1 2025 of $288 million or 12.3 cents per share representing a third of the total 2024 dividend. In addition, the Board has announced a further share buyback of $1.3 billion, the impact of this will reduce the Group's CET1 capital by around 50 basis points in the third quarter of 2025.

The Group expects to manage CET1 capital dynamically within our 13-14 per cent target range, in support of our aim of delivering future sustainable shareholder distributions.

The Group's MREL leverage requirement as at H1 2025 was equivalent 28.1 per cent of RWA. This is composed of a minimum requirement of 24.3 per cent of RWA and the Group's combined buffer (comprising the capital conservation buffer, the G-SII buffer and the countercyclical buffer). The Group's MREL ratio was 33.3 per cent of RWA and 9.3 per cent of leverage exposure at H1 2025.

During the period, the Group successfully raised $6.5 billion of MREL eligible securities from its holding company, Standard Chartered PLC. Issuance include $1.0 billion of Additional Tier 1 and $5.5 billion of callable senior debt.

The Group is a G-SII, with a 1.0 per cent G-SII CET1 capital buffer. The Standard Chartered PLC G-SII disclosure is published at: sc.com/en/investors/financial-results.



- page 50 -


 

Capital base1 (reviewed)


30.06.25
$million

31.12.24
$million

CET1 capital instruments and reserves



Capital instruments and the related share premium accounts

5,154

5,201

Of which: share premium accounts

3,989

3,989

Retained earnings

26,692

24,950

Accumulated other comprehensive income (and other reserves)

10,099

8,724

Non-controlling interests (amount allowed in consolidated CET1)

234

235

Independently reviewed interim and year-end profits

3,341

4,072

Foreseeable dividends

(570)

(923)

CET1 capital before regulatory adjustments

44,950

42,259

CET1 regulatory adjustments



Additional value adjustments (prudential valuation adjustments)

(660)

(624)

Intangible assets (net of related tax liability)

(5,995)

(5,696)

Deferred tax assets that rely on future profitability (excludes those arising from temporary differences)

(18)

(31)

Fair value reserves related to net losses on cash flow hedges

(378)

(4)

Deduction of amounts resulting from the calculation of excess expected loss

(617)

(702)

Net gains on liabilities at fair value resulting from changes in own credit risk

275

278

Defined-benefit pension fund assets

(159)

(149)

Fair value gains arising from the institution's own credit risk related to derivative liabilities

(103)

(97)

Exposure amounts which could qualify for risk weighting of 1250%

(35)

(44)

Total regulatory adjustments to CET1

(7,690)

(7,069)

CET1 capital

37,260

35,190

Additional Tier 1 capital (AT1) instruments

6,537

6,502

AT1 regulatory adjustments

(20)

(20)

Tier 1 capital

43,777

41,672




Tier 2 capital instruments

9,534

11,449

Tier 2 regulatory adjustments

(30)

(30)

Tier 2 capital

9,504

11,419

Total capital

53,281

53,091

Total risk-weighted assets (unreviewed)

259,684

247,065

1   Capital base is prepared on the regulatory scope of consolidation



- page 51 -


 

Movement in total capital (reviewed)


6 months
 ended
30.06.25
$million

6 months
 ended
31.12.24
$million

CET1 at 1 January/1 July

35,190

35,418

Ordinary shares issued in the period and share premium

-

-

Share buyback

(1,500)

(1,500)

Profit for the period/year

3,341

1,663

Foreseeable dividends deducted from CET1

(570)

(445)

Difference between dividends paid and foreseeable dividends

9

(477)

Movement in goodwill and other intangible assets

(299)

310

Foreign currency translation differences

753

(15)

Non-controlling interests

(1)

(1)

Movement in eligible other comprehensive income

307

268

Deferred tax assets that rely on future profitability

13

13

Decrease/(increase) in excess expected loss

85

(49)

Additional value adjustments (prudential valuation adjustment)

(36)

54

IFRS 9 transitional impact on regulatory reserves including day one

-

2

Exposure amounts which could qualify for risk weighting

9

(5)

Fair value gains arising from the institution's own Credit Risk related to derivative liabilities

(6)

(7)

Others

(35)

(39)

CET1 at 30 June/31 December

37,260

35,190




AT1 at 1 January/1 July

6,482

6,484

Net issuances

30

23

Foreign currency translation difference

5

(25)

AT1 at 30 June/31 December

6,517

6,482




Tier 2 capital at 1 January/1 July

11,419

11,667

Regulatory amortisation

(124)

367

Net (redemptions)

(2,175)

(517)

Foreign currency translation difference

365

(100)

Tier 2 ineligible minority interest

11

(1)

Others

8

3

Tier 2 capital at 30 June/31 December

9,504

11,419

Total capital at 30 June/31 December

53,281

53,091

The main movements in capital in the period were:

CET1 capital increased by $2.0 billion as retained profits of $3.3 billion, movement in FVOCI of $0.2 billion, foreign currency translation impact of $0.8 billion which were partly offset by share buybacks of $1.5 billion, distributions paid and foreseeable of $0.6 billion and an increase in regulatory deductions and other movements of $0.2 billion.

AT1 capital remained constant as the issuance of $1.0 billion securities is offset by the redemption of another $1.0 billion securities.

Tier 2 capital decreased by $1.9 billion due to the redemption of $2.2 billion of Tier 2 during the year and regulatory amortisation partly offset by foreign currency translation impact.



- page 52 -


 

Risk-weighted assets by business


30.06.25

Credit risk
$million

Operational risk
$million

Market risk
$million

Total risk
$million

Corporate & Investment Banking

128,605

22,555

30,969

182,129

Wealth & Retail Banking

47,027

10,583

-

57,610

Ventures

3,031

239

18

3,288

Central & other items

12,685

(799)

4,772

16,657

Total risk-weighted assets

191,348

32,578

35,758

259,684

 


31.12.241

Credit risk
$million

Operational risk
$million

Market risk
$million

Total risk
$million

Corporate & Investment Banking

124,635

19,987

24,781

169,403

Wealth & Retail Banking

47,764

9,523

-

57,287

Ventures

2,243

142

21

2,406

Central & other items

14,661

(173)

3,481

17,969

Total risk-weighted assets

189,303

29,479

28,283

247,065

Movement in risk-weighted assets


Credit risk1

Operational risk
$million

Market risk
$million

Total risk
$million

Corporate & Investment Banking
$million

Wealth & Retail Banking
$million

Ventures
$million

Central & other items
$million

Total
$million

116,621

50,771

1,885

22,146

191,423

27,861

24,867

244,151

Assets growth & mix

5,580

(2,449)

96

(3,855)

(629)

-

-

(629)

Asset quality

(2,031)

(155)

-

(488)

(2,674)

-

-

(2,674)

Risk-weighted assets efficiencies

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

Model Updates

462

818

-

-

1,280

-

-

1,280

Methodology and policy changes

-

-

-

-

-

-

(1,300)

(1,300)

Acquisitions and disposals

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

Foreign currency translation

(1,727)

(1,067)

-

(367)

(3,162)

-

-

(3,162)

Other, Including non-credit risk movements

-

-

-

(1,234)

(1,234)

1,618

3,876

4,260

118,905

47,917

1,981

16,201

185,004

29,479

27,443

241,926

Assets growth & mix

6,037

1,959

262

(1,321)

6,937

-

-

6,937

Asset quality

(441)

(161)

-

104

(498)

-

-

(498)

Risk-weighted assets efficiencies

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

Model Updates

1,158

(819)

-

-

339

-

(400)

(61)

Methodology and policy changes

38

39

-

-

77

-

-

77

Acquisitions and disposals

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

Foreign currency translation

(1,061)

(330)

-

(324)

(1,715)

-

-

(1,715)

Other, Including non-credit risk movements

-

(841)

-

-

(841)

-

1,240

399

At 31 December 20241

124,635

47,764

2,243

14,661

189,303

29,479

28,283

247,065

Assets growth & mix

847

(2,424)

788

(2,897)

(3,686)

-

-

(3,686)

Asset quality

1,776

(96)

-

556

2,236

-

-

2,236

Risk-weighted assets efficiencies

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

Model Updates

(1,655)

232

-

-

(1,423)

-

51

(1,372)

Methodology and policy changes

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

Acquisitions and disposals

(14)

(92)

-

(12)

(118)

-

-

(118)

Foreign currency translation

3,016

1,643

-

377

5,036

-

-

5,036

Other, Including non-credit risk movements

-

-

-

-

-

3,099

7,424

10,523

At 30 June 2025

128,605

47,027

3,031

12,685

191,348

32,578

35,758

259,684

1   RWA balances are now presented to reflect the RNS on Presentation of Financial Information issued on 2 April 2025. Prior periods have been re-presented and there is no change in total RWA



- page 53 -


 

Movements in risk-weighted assets

RWA increased by $12.6 billion, or 5.1 per cent from 31 December 2024 to $259.7 billion. This was due to increase in Credit Risk RWA of $2.0 billion, Market Risk RWA of $7.5 billion and Operational Risk RWA of $3.1 billion.

Corporate & Investment Banking

Credit Risk RWA increased by $3.9 billion, or 3.2 per cent from 31 December 2024 to $128.6 billion due to:

$3.0 billion increase from foreign currency translation

$1.8 billion increase mainly due to deterioration in asset quality from sovereign downgrades and other client grade moves

$0.8 billion increase from changes in asset growth and mix, of which:

-  $5.3 billion increase from asset growth

-  $4.5 billion decrease from optimisation actions

$1.7 billion decrease from industry-wide regulatory changes to align IRB model performance and from alpha factor used in the Internal Model Method (IMM)

Wealth & Retail Banking

Credit Risk RWA decreased by $0.7 billion, or 1.5 per cent from 31 December 2024 to $47.0 billion mainly due to:

$2.4 billion decrease from changes in asset growth & mix

$0.1 billion decrease mainly due to improvement in asset quality, mainly in Asia

$0.1 billion decrease from exit of business in Gambia

$1.6 billion increase from foreign currency translation

$0.2 billion increase from industry-wide regulatory changes to align IRB model performance.

Ventures

Ventures is comprised of Mox Bank Limited, Trust Bank and SC Ventures. Credit Risk RWA increased by $0.8 billion, or 35.1 per cent from 31 December 2024 to $3.0 billion from asset balance growth, mainly from SC Ventures.

Central & other items

Central & other items RWA mainly relate to the Treasury Market's liquidity portfolio, equity investments and current and deferred tax assets. Credit Risk RWA decreased by $2.0 billion, or 13.5 per cent from 31 December 2024 to $12.7 billion mainly due to:

$2.9 billion decrease from changes in asset growth & mix

$0.6 billion increase due to deterioration in asset quality, mainly from sovereign downgrades and other client grade moves

$0.4 billion increase from foreign currency translation

Market Risk

Total Market Risk RWA increased by $7.5 billion, or 26.4 per cent from 31 December 2024 to $35.8 billion due to:

$2.6 billion increase in Standardised Approach (SA) Specific Interest Rate Risk RWA primarily due to increase in the Trading Book government bond portfolio

$2.7 billion increase in Internal Models Approach (IMA) stressed VaR RWA due to increased IMA positions attributable mainly to interest rate exposures

$1.3 billion RWA increase from Structural FX risk

$0.9 billion RWA increase from IMA add-ons for risks not in VaR

Operational Risk

Operational Risk RWA increased by $3.1 billion, or 10.5 per cent from 31 December 2024 to $32.6 billion, mainly due to an increase in average income as measured over a rolling three-year time horizon.



- page 54 -


 

Leverage ratio

The Group's leverage ratio, which excludes qualifying claims on central banks, was 4.7 per cent at H1 2025, which was above the current minimum requirement of 3.7 per cent. The leverage ratio was 11 basis points lower than FY2024. Leverage exposure increased by $64.9 billion from an increase in Other Assets of $78.6 billion, an increase in Derivatives including cash collateral of $3.2 billion, Off-balance sheet items of $2.3 billion, securities financing transaction add-on of $1.8 billion partly offset by an increase in claims on central banks of $19.2 billion, regulatory consolidation adjustments and unsettled regular way trades of $1.0 billion, and an increase in asset amounts deducted in determining Tier 1 capital (Leverage) of $0.8 billion. Tier 1 capital increased by $2.1 billion as CET1 capital increased by $2.0 billion following profits for the period of $3.3 billion, partly offset by the announcement of a share buyback of $1.5 billion, and an AT1 issuance of $1.0 billion offset by a call announcement of $1.0 billion AT1 securities.

Leverage ratio


30.06.25
$million

31.12.24
$million

Tier 1 capital (end point)

43,777

41,672

Derivative financial instruments

64,225

81,472

Derivative cash collateral

13,895

11,046

Securities financing transactions (SFTs)

98,772

98,801

Loans and advances and other assets

737,044

658,369

Total on-balance sheet assets

913,936

849,688

Regulatory consolidation adjustments1

(96,465)

(76,197)

Derivatives adjustments



Derivatives netting

(48,236)

(63,934)

Adjustments to cash collateral

(12,032)

(10,169)

Net written credit protection

2,757

2,075

Potential future exposure on derivatives

54,443

51,323

Total derivatives adjustments

(3,068)

(20,705)

Counterparty risk leverage exposure measure for SFTs

5,959

4,198

Off-balance sheet items

120,878

118,607

Regulatory deductions from Tier 1 capital

(8,006)

(7,247)

Total exposure measure excluding claims on central banks

933,234

868,344

Leverage ratio excluding claims on central banks (%)

4.7

4.8

Average leverage exposure measure excluding claims on central banks

946,944

894,296

Average leverage ratio excluding claims on central banks (%)

4.6

4.7

Countercyclical leverage ratio buffer (%)

0.1

0.1

G-SII additional leverage ratio buffer (%)

0.4

0.4

1   Includes adjustment for qualifying central bank claims and unsettled regular way trades



- page 55 -


 

Statement of directors' responsibilities

We confirm that to the best of our knowledge:

The condensed consolidated interim financial statements have been prepared in accordance with UK-adopted IAS 34 Interim Financial Reporting and IAS 34 as adopted by the EU.

The interim management report includes a fair review of the information required by:

(a) DTR 4.2.7R of the Disclosure Guidance and Transparency Rules, being an indication of important events that have occurred during the six months ended 30 June 2025 and their impact on the condensed consolidated interim financial statements; and a description of the principal risks and uncertainties for the remaining six months of the year.

(b) DTR 4.2.8R of the Disclosure Guidance and Transparency Rules, being related party transactions that have taken place during the six months ended 30 June 2025 that have materially affected the financial position or performance of the entity during that period; and any changes in the related party transactions described in the last annual report that could have materially affected the financial position or performance of the entity during that period.

 

By order of the Board

 

Diego De Giorgi

Group Chief Financial Officer

31 July 2025

 

Standard Chartered PLC Board of Directors

Group Chair                                          Executive Directors                                             Non-Executive Directors

Maria Ramos                                       Bill Winters                                                           Shirish Apte
                                                                Diego De Giorgi                                                    Jackie Hunt
                                                                                                                                                Diane Jurgens

Robin Lawther

Lincoln Leong

Phil Rivett

David Tang

Linda Yueh

- page 56 -


 

Independent review report to Standard Chartered PLC

Conclusion

We have been engaged by Standard Chartered PLC (the 'Company' or, together with its subsidiaries, the 'Group') to review the condensed set of financial statements in the half-yearly financial report for the six months ended 30 June 2025 which comprises the condensed consolidated interim income statement, the condensed consolidated interim statement of comprehensive income, the condensed consolidated interim balance sheet, the condensed consolidated interim statement of changes in equity, the condensed consolidated interim cash flow statement, the related notes 1 to 30, and the risk and capital disclosures marked as 'reviewed' (together the 'condensed consolidated interim financial statements'). We have read the other information contained in the half yearly financial report and considered whether it contains any apparent misstatements or material inconsistencies with the information in the condensed set of financial statements.

Based on our review, nothing has come to our attention that causes us to believe that the condensed consolidated interim financial statements in the half-yearly financial report for the six months ended 30 June 2025 are not prepared, in all material respects, in accordance with United Kingdom (UK) adopted International Accounting Standard 34 (IAS 34), IAS 34 as adopted by the European Union (EU), and the Disclosure Guidance and Transparency Rules (DTR) of the UK's Financial Conduct Authority (FCA).

Basis for Conclusion

We conducted our review in accordance with International Standard on Review Engagements 2410 (UK) 'Review of Interim Financial Information Performed by the Independent Auditor of the Entity' (ISRE) issued by the Financial Reporting Council (FRC). A review of interim financial information consists of making enquiries, primarily of persons responsible for financial and accounting matters, and applying analytical and other review procedures. A review is substantially less in scope than an audit conducted in accordance with International Standards on Auditing (UK) and consequently does not enable us to obtain assurance that we would become aware of all significant matters that might be identified in an audit. Accordingly, we do not express an audit opinion.

As disclosed in note 1, the annual financial statements of the Group are prepared in accordance with UK adopted international accounting standards and international financial reporting standard as adopted by the EU. The condensed set of financial statements included in this half-yearly financial report has been prepared in accordance with UK adopted IAS 34 and IAS 34 as adopted by the EU, and the DTR of the UK's FCA.

Conclusions Relating to Going Concern

Based on our review procedures, which are less extensive than those performed in an audit as described in the Basis of Conclusion section of this report, nothing has come to our attention to suggest that management have inappropriately adopted the going concern basis of accounting or that management have identified material uncertainties relating to going concern that are not appropriately disclosed.

This conclusion is based on the review procedures performed in accordance with this ISRE, however future events or conditions may cause the entity to cease to continue as a going concern.

Responsibilities of the directors

The directors are responsible for preparing the half-yearly financial report in accordance with UK adopted IAS 34 and IAS 34 as adopted by the EU, and the DTR of the UK's FCA.

In preparing the half-yearly financial report, the directors are responsible for assessing the company's ability to continue as a going concern, disclosing, as applicable, matters related to going concern and using the going concern basis of accounting unless the directors either intend to liquidate the company or to cease operations, or have no realistic alternative but to do so.

Auditor's Responsibilities for the review of the financial information

In reviewing the half-yearly report, we are responsible for expressing to the Company a conclusion on the condensed set of financial statements in the half-yearly financial report. Our conclusion, including our Conclusions Relating to Going Concern, are based on procedures that are less extensive than audit procedures, as described in the Basis for Conclusion paragraph of this report.



- page 57 -


 

Use of our report

This report is made solely to the company in accordance with guidance contained in ISRE 2410 (UK) 'Review of Interim Financial Information Performed by the Independent Auditor of the Entity' issued by the FRC. To the fullest extent permitted by law, we do not accept or assume responsibility to anyone other than the Company, for our work, for this report, or for the conclusions we have formed.

 

Ernst & Young LLP

London

31 July 2025



- page 58 -


 

Condensed consolidated interim income statement

For the six months ended 30 June 2025


Notes

6 months ended 30.06.25
$million

6 months ended 30.06.24
$million

Interest income


12,485

14,194

Interest expense


(9,441)

(11,019)

Net interest income

3

3,044

3,175

Fees and commission income


2,627

2,363

Fees and commission expense


(495)

(442)

Net fee and commission income

4

2,132

1,921

Net trading income

5

5,438

4,749

Other operating income

6

292

(54)

Operating income


10,906

9,791

Staff costs


(4,393)

(4,336)

Premises costs


(175)

(177)

General administrative expenses


(1,135)

(1,027)

Depreciation and amortisation


(544)

(516)

Operating expenses

7

(6,247)

(6,056)

Operating profit before impairment losses and taxation


4,659

3,735

Credit impairment

8

(336)

(240)

Goodwill, property, plant and equipment and other impairment

9

(19)

(147)

Profit from associates and joint ventures

19

79

144

Profit before taxation


4,383

3,492

Taxation

10

(1,057)

(1,123)

Profit for the period


3,326

2,369





Profit attributable to:




Non-controlling interests


17

(9)

Parent company shareholders


3,309

2,378

Profit for the period


3,326

2,369

 

 


cents

cents

Earnings per share:




Basic earnings per ordinary share

12

129.1

83.3

Diluted earnings per ordinary share

12

125.5

81.3

The notes form an integral part of these financial statements.



- page 59 -


 

Condensed consolidated interim statement of comprehensive income

For the six months ended 30 June 2025


Notes

6 months ended 30.06.25
$million

6 months ended 30.06.24
$million

Profit for the period


3,326

2,369

Other comprehensive income/(loss)




Items that will not be reclassified to income statement:


124

(265)

Own credit losses on financial liabilities designated at fair value through profit or loss


(7)

(410)

Equity instruments at fair value through other comprehensive income/(loss)


122

(25)

Actuarial gains on retirement benefit obligations


5

31

Revaluation (deficit)/surplus1


(3)

15

Taxation relating to components of other comprehensive income


7

124

Items that may be reclassified subsequently to income statement:


1,293

(649)

Exchange differences on translation of foreign operations:




Net gains/(losses) taken to equity


824

(1,017)

Net (losses)/gains on net investment hedges


(76)

377

Share of other comprehensive (loss)/income from associates and joint ventures


(30)

9

Debt instruments at fair value through other comprehensive income:




Net valuation gains taken to equity


245

56

Reclassified to income statement


(9)

90

Net impact of expected credit gains/(losses)


9

(19)

Cash flow hedges:




Net movements in cash flow hedge reserve


451

(171)

Taxation relating to components of other comprehensive income/(loss)


(121)

26

Other comprehensive income/(loss) for the period, net of taxation


1,417

(914)

Total comprehensive income for the period


4,743

1,455





Total comprehensive income attributable to:




Non-controlling interests


42

(16)

Parent company shareholders


4,701

1,471

Total comprehensive income for the period


4,743

1,455

1   Revaluation (deficit)/surplus on reclassification of building to investment property measured at fair value



- page 60 -


 

Condensed consolidated interim balance sheet

As at 30 June 2025


Notes

30.06.25
$million

31.12.24
$million

Assets




Cash and balances at central banks


80,165

63,447

Financial assets held at fair value through profit or loss

13

201,523

177,517

Derivative financial instruments

13,14

64,225

81,472

Loans and advances to banks

13

42,386

43,593

Loans and advances to customers

13

286,731

281,032

Investment securities

13

158,588

144,556

Other assets

18

65,429

43,468

Current tax assets


572

663

Prepayments and accrued income


3,070

3,207

Interests in associates and joint ventures

19

1,405

1,020

Goodwill and intangible assets

16

6,091

5,791

Property, plant and equipment

17

2,506

2,425

Deferred tax assets

10

399

414

Retirement benefit schemes in surplus


165

151

Assets classified as held for sale

20

681

932

Total assets


913,936

849,688





Liabilities




Deposits by banks

13

30,883

25,400

Customer accounts

13

517,390

464,489

Repurchase agreements and other similar secured borrowing

13,15

5,250

12,132

Financial liabilities held at fair value through profit or loss

13

99,551

85,462

Derivative financial instruments

13,14

69,878

82,064

Debt securities in issue

13

70,088

64,609

Other liabilities

21

48,638

44,681

Current tax liabilities


967

726

Accruals and deferred income


6,286

6,896

Subordinated liabilities and other borrowed funds

13,24

8,778

10,382

Deferred tax liabilities

10

715

567

Provisions for liabilities and charges


345

349

Retirement benefit schemes in deficit


282

266

Liabilities included in disposal groups held for sale

20

215

381

Total liabilities


859,266

798,404





Equity




Share capital and share premium account

25

6,648

6,695

Other reserves


10,099

8,724

Retained earnings


29,983

28,969

Total parent company shareholders' equity


46,730

44,388

Other equity instruments

25

7,500

6,502

Total equity excluding non-controlling interests


54,230

50,890

Non-controlling interests


440

394

Total equity


54,670

51,284

Total equity and liabilities


913,936

849,688

The notes form an integral part of these financial statements.

These financial statements were approved by the Board of Directors and authorised for issue on 31 July 2025 and signed on its behalf by:

 

Diego De Giorgi

Group Chief Financial Officer

- page 61 -


 

Condensed consolidated interim statement of changes in equity

For the six months ended 30 June 2025

 

 

Ordinary share capital and share premium account
$million

Preference share capital and share premium account
$million

Capital and merger reserves1
$million

Own credit adjustment reserve
$million

Fair value through other compre-hensive income reserve - debt
$million

Fair value through other compre-hensive income reserve - equity
$million

Cash flow hedge reserve
$million

Translation reserve
$million

Retained earnings
$million

Parent company share-holders' equity
$million

Other equity instru-ments
$million

Non-controlling interests
$million

Total
$million

As at 1 January 2024

5,321

1,494

17,453

100

(690)

330

91

(8,113)

28,459

44,445

5,512

396

50,353

Profit for the period

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

2,378

2,378

-

(9)

2,369

Other comprehensive (loss)/income7

-

-

-

(360)

137

(81)¹¹

(147)

(644)

1882,12

(907)

-

(7)

(914)

Distributions

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

(25)

(25)

Other equity instruments issued, net of expenses

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

9928

-

992

Treasury shares net movement

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

29

29

-

-

29

Share option expense, net of taxation

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

148

148

-

-

148

Dividends on ordinary shares

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

(551)

(551)

-

-

(551)

Dividends on preference shares and
AT1 securities

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

(209)

(209)

-

-

(209)

Share buyback3

(57)

-

57

-

-

-

-

-

(1,000)

(1,000)

-

-

(1,000)

Other movements

-

-

-

-

7

-

-

134⁴

(61)⁹

80

-

555

135

As at 30 June 2024

5,264

1,494

17,510

(260)

(546)

249

(56)

(8,623)

29,381

44,413

6,504

410

51,327

Profit for the period

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

1,672

1,672

-

1

1,673

Other comprehensive (loss)/income7

-

-

-

(17)

305

5513

60

(91)

392,14

351

-

(7)

344

Distributions

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

(18)

(18)

Other equity instruments issued,
net of expenses

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

5768

-

576

Redemption of other equity instruments

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

(553)10

-

(553)

Treasury shares net movement

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

(197)

(197)

-

-

(197)

Share option expense, net of taxation

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

121

121

-

-

121

Dividends on ordinary shares

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

(229)

(229)

-

-

(229)

Dividends on preference shares and
AT1 securities

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

(248)

(248)

-

-

(248)

Share buyback6

(63)

-

63

-

-

-

-

-

(1,500)

(1,500)

-

-

(1,500)

Other movements

-

-

-

(1)

-

-

-

764

(70)⁹

5

(25)10

85

(12)

As at 31 December 2024

5,201

1,494

17,573

(278)

(241)

304

4

(8,638)

28,969

44,388

6,502

394

51,284

1   First half year ended 30 June 2024 includes capital reserve of $5 million, capital redemption reserve of $394 million and merger reserve of $17,111 million. Further movement of $63 million in capital redemption reserve during  half year ended 31 December 2024

2   Comprises actuarial gain, net of taxation on Group defined benefit schemes

3   On 23 February 2024, the Group announced the buyback programme for a share buyback of its ordinary shares of $0.50 each. Nominal value of share purchases was $57 million, the total consideration paid was $1,000 million and the buyback completed on 25 June 2024. The total number of shares purchased was 113,266,516, representing 4.25 per cent of the ordinary shares in issue at the beginning of the programme. The nominal value of the shares was transferred from the share capital to the capital redemption reserve account

4   2024 movement includes realisation of translation adjustment loss from sale of SCB Zimbabwe Limited ($190 million), SCB Angola S.A. ($31 million), SCB Sierra Leone Limited ($25 million) transferred to other operating income

5   Movements during first half year ended 30 June 2024 includes non-controlling interest pertaining to Mox Bank Limited ($8 million) and Trust Bank Singapore Limited ($47 million). Further movement in non-controlling interest from Mox Bank Limited ($6 million) and Trust Bank Singapore Limited ($8 million) partly offset by SCB Angola S.A. ($6 million) during half year ended 31 December 2024

6   On 30 July 2024, the Group announced the buyback programme for a $1,500 million share buyback of its ordinary shares of $0.50 each. As at December 2024, nominal value of share purchases was $63 million with the total number of shares purchased of 126,262,414 and the total consideration was $1,355 million. The buyback programme was completed on 30 January 2025 with a further 11,300,128 shares purchased in 2025, representing 0.44 per cent of shares in issue at the beginning of the programme. The nominal value of the shares was transferred from the share capital to the capital redemption reserve account

7   All the amounts are net of tax

8   Includes $992 million and $576 million (SGD 750 million) fixed rate resetting perpetual subordinated contingent convertible AT1 securities issued by Standard Chartered PLC (refer note 25)

9   Movement in 2024 mainly includes movements related to Ghana hyperinflation

10     Relates to redemption of AT1 securities of SGD 750 million ($553 million) and realised translation loss ($25 million) reported in other movements

11     Includes $147 million gain on sale of equity investment transferred to retained earnings partly offset by $76 million reversal of deferred tax liability

12     Includes $147 million gain on sale of equity investment in other comprehensive income reserve transferred to retained earnings partly offset by $13 million capital gain tax

13     Includes $72 million mark-to-market gain on equity instrument partly offset by $27 million gain on sale of equity investment transferred to retained earnings

14     Includes $27 million gain on sale of equity investment in other comprehensive income reserve transferred to retained earnings

 



- page 62 -


 

Condensed consolidated interim statement of changes in equity

For the six months ended 30 June 2025 continued


Ordinary share capital and share premium account
$million

Preference share capital and share premium account
$million

Capital and merger reserves15
$million

Own credit adjustment reserve
$million

Fair value through other compre-hensive income reserve - debt
$million

Fair value through other compre-hensive income reserve - equity
$million

Cash flow hedge reserve
$million

Translation reserve
$million

Retained earnings
$million

Parent company share-holders' equity
$million

Other equity instru-ments
$million

Non-controlling interests
$million

Total
$million

As at 1 January 2025

5,201

1,494

17,573

(278)

(241)

304

4

(8,638)

28,969

44,388

6,502

394

51,284

Profit for the period

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

3,309

3,309

-

17

3,326

Other comprehensive income7

-

-

-

3

171

5220

374

718

742,20

1,392

-

25

1,417

Distributions

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

(35)

(35)

Other equity instruments issued,
net of expenses

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

99419

-

994

Treasury shares net movement

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

(76)

(76)

-

-

(76)

Share option expense, net of taxation

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

139

139

-

-

139

Dividends on ordinary shares

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

(670)

(670)

-

-

(670)

Dividends on preference shares and
AT1 securities

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

(244)

(244)

-

-

(244)

Share buyback6,16

(47)

-

47

-

-

-

-

-

(1,500)

(1,500)

-

-

(1,500)

Other movements

-

-

-

-

(25)

-

-

3517

(18)9

(8)

4

3918

35

As at 30 June 2025

5,154

1,494

17,620

(275)

(95)

356

378

(7,885)

29,983

46,730

7,500

440

54,670

15     Includes capital reserve of $5 million, capital redemption reserve of $504 million and merger reserve of $17,111 million

16     On 21 February 2025, the Group announced the buyback programme for a $1,500 million share buyback of its ordinary shares of $0.50 each. As at 30 June 2025, the total number of shares purchased of 82,248,452 representing 3.41 per cent of the ordinary shares in issue at the beginning of the programme, for total consideration of $1,222 million, out of which $72 million was paid in July 2025, and a further $278 million relating to irrevocable obligation to buy back shares under the buyback programme has been recognised. The nominal value of the shares was transferred from the share capital to the capital redemption reserve account

17     Includes realisation of translation adjustment loss from sale of Standard Chartered Bank Gambia Limited ($8 million) and Standard Chartered Research and Technology India Private Limited ($3 million) transferred to other operating income

18     Movement primarily from non-controlling interest pertaining to Mox Bank Limited ($12 million), Trust Bank Singapore Limited ($7 million), Furaha Holdings Limited ($3 million), Standard Chartered Research and Technology India Private Limited ($12 million), Century Leader Limited ($6 million) offset by Standard Chartered Bank Gambia Limited ($1 million)

19     Includes $994 million fixed rate resetting perpetual subordinated contingent convertible AT1 securities issued by Standard Chartered PLC (refer note 25)

20     Includes $68 million gain on sale of equity investment in other comprehensive income reserve transferred to retained earnings

Note 25 includes a description of each reserve.

The notes form an integral part of these financial statements.



- page 63 -


 

Condensed consolidated interim cash flow statement

For the six months ended 30 June 2025


Notes

6 months ended 30.06.25
$million

6 months ended 30.06.24
$million

Cash flows from operating activities:




Profit before taxation


4,383

3,492

Adjustments for non-cash items and other adjustments included within income statement

30

689

1,730

Change in operating assets

30

(28,293)

(41,582)

Change in operating liabilities

30

50,180

20,466

Contributions to defined benefit schemes


(28)

(19)

UK and overseas taxes paid


(700)

(793)

Net cash from/(used in) operating activities


26,231

(16,706)

Cash flows from investing activities:




Internally generated capitalised software

16

(451)

(474)

Disposal of internally generated capitalised software

16

11

5

Purchase of property, plant and equipment


(125)

(76)

Disposal of property, plant and equipment


9

31

Acquisition of investment associates, and joint ventures, net of cash acquired


(97)

(4)

Disposal of investment in subsidiaries, associates and joint ventures, net of cash acquired


15

41

Dividends received from associates and joint ventures

19

45

-

Purchase of investment securities


(106,044)

(120,307)

Disposal and maturity of investment securities


97,706

125,925

Net cash (used in)/from investing activities


(8,931)

5,141

Cash flows from financing activities:




Treasury share purchase


(123)

-

Treasury share sale


47

29

Cancellation of shares through share buyback


(1,150)

(1,000)

Premises and equipment lease liability principal payment


(107)

(105)

Issue of Additional Tier 1 capital, net of expenses


994

992

Interest paid on subordinated liabilities

30

(247)

(252)

Repayment of subordinated liabilities

30

(2,175)

(1,000)

Proceeds from issue of senior debts

30

7,953

7,698

Repayment of senior debts

30

(7,040)

(7,191)

Interest paid on senior debts

30

(1,678)

(548)

Net cash inflow from Non-controlling interest


24

47

Distributions and dividends paid to non-controlling interests, preference shareholders and
AT1 securities


(279)

(234)

Dividends paid to ordinary shareholders


(670)

(551)

Net cash used in financing activities


(4,451)

(2,115)

Net increase/(decrease) in cash and cash equivalents


12,849

(13,680)

Cash and cash equivalents at beginning of the period


89,928

107,635

Effect of exchange rate movements on cash and cash equivalents


2,474

(1,740)

Cash and cash equivalents at end of the period1


105,251

92,215

1   Comprises cash and balances at central banks $80,165 million (30 June 2024: $64,086 million), treasury bills and other eligible bills $9,005 million (30 June 2024: $3,873 million), loans and advances to banks $8,518 million (30 June 2024: $12,691 million), loans and advances to customers $15,447 million (30 June 2024 $20,611 million) investments $3,028 million (30 June 2024: $824 million) less restricted balances $10,912 million (30 June 2024: $9,870 million)

Interest received was $12,082 million (30 June 2024: $14,575 million), interest paid was $9,574 million (30 June 2024: $10,948 million).



- page 64 -


 

Contents - Notes to the financial statements

Section

Note


Basis of preparation

1

Accounting policies

Performance/return

2

Segmental information


3

Net interest income


4

Net fees and commission


5

Net trading income


6

Other operating income


7

Operating expenses


8

Credit impairment


9

Goodwill, property, plant and equipment and other impairment


10

Taxation


11

Dividends


12

Earnings per ordinary share

Assets and liabilities held at fair value

13

Financial instruments


14

Derivative financial instruments

Financial instruments held at amortised cost

15

Reverse repurchase and repurchase agreements including other similar lending and borrowing

Other assets and investments

16

Goodwill and intangible assets


17

Property, plant and equipment


18

Other assets


19

Investments in associates and joint ventures


20

Assets held for sale and associated liabilities

Funding, accruals, provisions, contingent liabilities and legal proceedings

21

Other liabilities

22

Contingent liabilities and commitments

23

Legal and regulatory matters

Capital instruments, equity and reserves

24

Subordinated liabilities and other borrowed funds


25

Share capital, other equity instruments and reserves

Other disclosure matters

26

Related party transactions


27

Post balance sheet events


28

Corporate governance


29

Statutory accounts


30

Cash flow statement

 



- page 65 -


 

Notes to the financial statements

1. Accounting policies

Statement of compliance

The Group's condensed consolidated interim financial statements consolidate those of Standard Chartered PLC (the Company) and its subsidiaries (together referred to as the Group) and equity account the Group's interests in associates and jointly controlled entities.

These interim financial statements have been prepared in accordance with the Disclosure Guidance and Transparency Rules of the United Kingdom's Financial Conduct Authority (FCA) and with UK-adopted International Accounting Standard 34 (IAS 34 Interim Financial Reporting) and IAS 34 as adopted by the European Union (EU), as there are no applicable differences for the periods presented. They should be read in conjunction with the 2024 Annual Report, which was prepared in accordance with the requirements of the Companies Act 2006, UK-adopted international accounting standards, and International Financial Reporting Standards (IFRS) (Accounting Standards) as adopted by the European Union (EU IFRS). The Group's Annual Report 2025 will continue to be prepared in accordance with these frameworks.

The following parts of the Risk review and Capital review form part of these financial statements:

a) Risk review: Disclosures marked as 'reviewed' from the start of the Credit Risk section to the end of Other principal risks in the same section.

b) Capital review: Tables marked as 'reviewed' from the start of 'CRD Capital base' to the end of 'Movement in total capital', excluding 'Total risk-weighted assets'.

There were no new accounting standards or interpretations that had a material effect on these Condensed consolidated interim financial statements.

Basis of preparation

The condensed consolidated financial statements have been prepared on a going concern basis and under the historical cost convention, as modified by the revaluation of cash-settled share-based payments, fair value through other comprehensive income, and financial assets and liabilities (including derivatives) at fair value through profit or loss.

The condensed consolidated financial statements are presented in United States dollars ($), being the presentation and functional currency of the Group, and all values are rounded to the nearest million dollars, except when otherwise indicated. The accounting policies that we applied for these interim condensed consolidated financial statements are consistent with those described on pages 295 to 380 of the 2024 Annual Report, as are the methods of computation, except for the accounting policy change summarised below.

Re-presentation of segmental information

During the period there has been a change in respect to the classification of income attributable to geographic markets which have been re-presented to ensure recognition is in line with transfer pricing principles for services performed including origination, structuring, booking, and risk management. This is necessary to align the presentation of the disclosure of geographic markets' operating income with client segments in line with the Regulatory News Service (RNS) filing on Re-Presentation of Financial Information issued on 2 April 2025.

Prior period amounts have been re-presented in line with the current year basis of preparation to align with the information reviewed by the Chief Operating Decision Maker (CODM). Where the re-representation has impacted disclosure, it is included within the footnotes in the following sections and tables:

Statement of results table

Group Chief Financial Officer's review, Summary of financial performance table

Financial review tables including the following: Operating income by product, profit before tax by client segment, Adjusted net interest income and margin, and Restructuring, DVA, FFG and other items

Supplementary financial information tables including the following: Underlying performance by client segment, Corporate & Investment Banking, Wealth & Retail Banking, Ventures, Central & other items, Underlying performance by key market, and Quarterly underlying operating income by product



 

Underlying versus reported results reconciliations, Net interest income and Non NII table

- page 66 -


 

Movement in risk-weighted assets

Risk review: Movement tables for Corporate & Investment Banking (reviewed) , Wealth & Retail Banking (reviewed) and Wealth & Retail Banking - Secured (reviewed)

Risk review: Credit impairment charge (reviewed)

Notes to the financial statements: Note 2 Segmental information and Note 4 Net fees and commission. 

Change in accounting policy

Prior period amounts for certain Credit risk tables (required by IFRS 7 - Financial Instruments: Disclosure) within the Risk review were also represented for a change in accounting policy for the presentation of the Group's geographic disclosures to align to information reported to key management personnel. These disclosures changed from being based on a management view, which was principally the location from which a client relationship is managed, to being based on a financial view reflecting the location in which exposures are financially booked. This change provides more reliable and relevant information because it more closely reflects the Group's exposure to risk presented to key management personnel. The change impacted the following tables: Loans and advances analysis by client segment, credit quality and key geography, Forborne and other modified loans by key geography, and Industry and Retail Products analysis of loans and advances by key geography - Corporate & Investment Banking and Central & other items. The most significant impact of this change was in net loans and advances to customers in the UK, which increased by $14.4 billion. This amount was reclassified from a number of geographic locations. There has been no impact to Earnings Per Share or Diluted Earnings per Share from this change.

Significant accounting estimates and judgements

In determining the carrying amounts of certain assets and liabilities, the Group makes assumptions of the effects of uncertain future events on those assets and liabilities at the balance sheet date. The Group's estimates and assumptions are based on historical experience and expectation of future events and are reviewed periodically. The significant judgements made by management in applying the Group's accounting policies and key sources of uncertainty were the same as those applied to the consolidated financial statements as at, and for, the year ended 31 December 2024.

IFRS and Hong Kong accounting requirements

As required by the Hong Kong Listing Rules, an explanation of the differences in accounting practices between UK-adopted IFRS and Hong Kong Financial Reporting Standards is required to be disclosed. There would be no significant differences had these accounts been prepared in accordance with Hong Kong Financial Reporting Standards.

Going concern

These financial statements were approved by the Board of Directors on 31 July 2025. The directors have made an assessment of the Group's ability to continue as a going concern. This assessment has been made having considered the current macroeconomic and geopolitical headwinds, including:

Review of the Group Strategy and Corporate Plan, including the annual budget

An assessment of the actual performance to date, loan book quality, credit impairment, legal and regulatory matters, compliance matters, recent regulatory developments

Consideration of stress testing performed, including the Group Recovery Plan (RP) which includes the application of stressed scenarios. Under the tests and through the range of scenarios, the results of these exercises and the RP demonstrate that the Group has sufficient capital and liquidity to continue as a going concern and meet minimum regulatory capital and liquidity requirements

Analysis of the capital position of the Group, including the capital and leverage ratios, and ICAAP which summarises the Group's capital and risk assessment processes, assesses its capital requirements and the adequacy of resources to meet them

Analysis of the funding and liquidity position of the Group, including the Internal Liquidity Adequacy Assessment Process (ILAAP), which considers the Group's liquidity position, its framework and whether sufficient liquidity resources are being maintained to meet liabilities as they fall due, was also reviewed. Further, funding and liquidity was considered in the context of the risk appetite metrics, including the LCR ratio

The level of debt in issue, including redemptions and issuances during the year, debt falling due for repayment in the next 12 months and further planned debt issuances, including the appetite in the market for the Group's debt

The Group's portfolio of debt securities held at amortised cost



 

A detailed review of all principal risks as well as topical and emerging risks.

- page 67 -


Based on the analysis performed, the directors confirm they are satisfied that the Group has adequate resources to continue in business for a period of at least 12 months from 31 July 2025.

For this reason, the Group continues to adopt the going concern basis of accounting for preparing the financial statements.

2. Segmental information

Basis of preparation

The analysis reflects how the client segments and markets are managed internally to drive better decision-making, resource allocation and return outcomes. Underlying segment and market performance is based on arms-length transfer pricing and reflects the underlying profitability including related capital and infrastructure costs. Income attribution to segment and markets is based on their contribution to the revenue generated across the network, considering factors such as booking location, trader and sales effort. Treasury outcomes such as MREL, FTP, Structural Hedges and Liquidity Pool which segments can directly benefit, influence, and optimise are allocated to individual business segments.

Disclosures have been re-presented as explained in Note 1 Re-presentation of segmental information. The effect of the change has impacted the classification of cost and income across client segments.

Client segments

The Group's segmental reporting is in accordance with IFRS 8 - Operating Segments and is reported consistently with the internal performance framework and as presented to the Group's Management Team.

Restructuring and other items excluded from underlying results

The Group's reported IFRS performance is adjusted for certain items to arrive at alternative performance measures (APMs). These items include profits or losses of a capital nature, amounts consequent to investment transactions driven by strategic intent, other infrequent and/or exceptional transactions that are significant or material in the context of the Group's normal business earnings for the period and items which management and investors would ordinarily identify separately when assessing consistent performance period by period. The APMs are not within the scope of IFRS and are not a substitute for IFRS measures. These adjustments are set out below.

Restructuring loss of $137 million includes ongoing charges related to portfolio and businesses being exited and optimising the Group's office space and property footprint. Fit for Growth (FFG) costs of $160 million, primarily severance costs, costs of staff working on FFG initiatives and legal and professional fees, reflect the impact of actions to transform the organisation to improve productivity, primarily additional redundancy charges, simplifying technology platforms.

Reconciliations between underlying and reported results are set out in the tables below:


6 months ended 30.06.25

Underlying $million

Restructuring
$million

FFG
$million

DVA
$million

Net gain/ loss on businesses disposed of/
held for sale
$million

Other items
$million

Reported
$million

Operating income

10,899

7

-

5

(5)

-

10,906

Operating expenses

(5,965)

(129)

(153)

-

-

-

(6,247)

Operating profit/(loss) before impairment losses and taxation

4,934

(122)

(153)

5

(5)

-

4,659

Credit impairment

(336)

-

-

-

-

-

(336)

Other impairment

(9)

(3)

(7)

-

-

-

(19)

Profit from associates and joint ventures

91

(12)

-

-

-

-

79

Profit/(loss) before taxation

4,680

(137)

(160)

5

(5)

-

4,383

 

- page 68 -




 


6 months ended 30.06.24

Underlying
$million

Restructuring2
$million

FFG2
$million

DVA
$million

Net loss on businesses disposed of/
held for sale¹
$million

Other items3
$million

Reported
$million

Operating income

9,958

48

-

(26)

(189)

-

9,791

Operating expenses

(5,673)

(197)

(86)

-

-

(100)

(6,056)

Operating profit/(loss) before impairment losses and taxation

4,285

(149)

(86)

(26)

(189)

(100)

3,735

Credit impairment

(249)

9

-

-

-

-

(240)

Other impairment

(143)

(4)

-

-

-

-

(147)

Profit from associates and joint ventures

64

80

-

-

-

-

144

Profit/(loss) before taxation

3,957

(64)

(86)

(26)

(189)

(100)

3,492

1   Net loss on businesses disposal includes loss of $174 million relating to Zimbabwe exit

2   FFG charge previously reported within Restructuring has been re-presented as a separate item

3   Other items include $100 million charge relating to Korea equity-linked securities (ELS) portfolio

Underlying performance by client segment


6 months ended 30.06.25

6 months ended 30.06.24

Corporate & Investment Banking
$million

Wealth & Retail Banking
$million

Ventures
$million

Central & other items
$million

Total
$million

Corporate & Investment Banking3
$million

Wealth & Retail Banking3
$million

Ventures3
$million

Central & other items3
$million

Total
$million

Operating income

6,583

4,162

320

(166)

10,899

6,194

3,884

80

(200)

9,958

External

6,317

1,834

321

2,427

10,899

5,221

1,761

80

2,896

9,958

Inter-segment

266

2,328

(1)

(2,593)

-

973

2,123

-

(3,096)

-

Operating expenses

(3,155)

(2,429)

(239)

(142)

(5,965)

(3,045)

(2,254)

(228)

(146)

(5,673)

Operating profit/(loss) before impairment losses and taxation

3,428

1,733

81

(308)

4,934

3,149

1,630

(148)

(346)

4,285

Credit impairment

14

(332)

(24)

6

(336)

54

(267)

(43)

7

(249)

Other impairment

-

(3)

-

(6)

(9)

(105)

(27)

-

(11)

(143)

Profit from associates and joint ventures

-

-

(11)

102

91

-

-

(6)

70

64

Underlying profit/(loss) before taxation

3,442

1,398

46

(206)

4,680

3,098

1,336

(197)

(280)

3,957

Restructuring and other items2

(146)

(130)

(1)

(20)

(297)

(77)

(195)

(1)

(192)

(465)

Reported profit/(loss) before taxation

3,296

1,268

45

(226)

4,383

3,021

1,141

(198)

(472)

3,492

Total assets

512,928

129,591

7,534

263,883

913,936

443,567

122,625

5,115

264,120

835,427

Of which: loans and advances
to customers

204,812

126,712

1,555

17,539

350,618

190,474

120,258

1,110

23,865

335,707

loans and advances to customers

140,930

126,707

1,555

17,539

286,731

130,672

120,249

1,110

23,865

275,896

loans held at fair value through profit or loss (FVTPL)

63,882

5

-

-

63,887

59,802

9

-

-

59,811

Total liabilities

507,646

244,591

6,010

101,019

859,266

469,158

208,419

4,347

102,176

784,100

Of which: customer accounts1

332,952

240,612

5,718

2,851

582,133

316,543

204,221

4,046

7,452

532,262

1   Customer accounts includes FVTPL and repurchase agreements

2   Other items 2024 include $100 million charge relating to Korea equity linked securities (ELS) portfolio, $174 million primarily relating to recycling of FX translation losses from reserves into P&L on the sale of Zimbabwe

3   Segment results have been re-presented in line with the RNS on Re-Presentation of Financial Information issued on 2 April 2025



- page 69 -


 

Operating income by client segment


6 months ended 30.06.25

6 months ended 30.06.24

Corporate & Investment Banking
$million

Wealth & Retail Banking
$million

Ventures
$million

Central & other items
$million

Total
$million

Corporate & Investment Banking2
$million

Wealth & Retail Banking2
$million

Ventures
$million

Central & other items2
$million

Total
$million

Underlying versus reported:











Underlying operating income

6,583

4,162

320

(166)

10,899

6,194

3,884

80

(200)

9,958

Restructuring

17

(13)

-

3

7

26

16

-

6

48

DVA

5

-

-

-

5

(26)

-

-

-

(26)

Other items1

-

-

-

(5)

(5)

-

-

-

(189)

(189)

Reported operating income

6,605

4,149

320

(168)

10,906

6,194

3,900

80

(383)

9,791












Additional income by account:











Net interest income

705

2,515

50

(226)

3,044

1,272

2,539

45

(681)

3,175

Net fees and commission income

1,088

1,074

30

(60)

2,132

993

955

19

(46)

1,921

Net trading and other income1

4,812

560

240

118

5,730

3,929

406

16

344

4,695

Reported operating income

6,605

4,149

320

(168)

10,906

6,194

3,900

80

(383)

9,791

1   Other items in H1 2024 include loss of $174 million relating to the Zimbabwe exit

2   Segment results have been re-presented in line with the RNS on Re-Presentation of Financial Information issued on 2 April 2025

3. Net interest income


6 months ended 30.06.25
$million

6 months ended 30.06.24
$million

Balances at central banks

1,036

1,360

Loans and advances to banks

1,109

1,052

Loans and advances to customers

7,221

8,190

Debt securities

2,443

2,716

Other eligible bills

621

807

Accrued on impaired assets (discount unwind)

55

69

Interest income

12,485

14,194

Of which: financial instruments held at fair value through other comprehensive income

1,825

1,707




Deposits by banks

326

441

Customer accounts

7,053

8,361

Debt securities in issue

1,727

1,794

Subordinated liabilities and other borrowed funds

302

394

Interest expense on IFRS 16 lease liabilities

33

29

Interest expense

9,441

11,019

Net interest income

3,044

3,175

4. Net fees and commission


6 months ended 30.06.25
$million

6 months ended 30.06.24
$million

Fees and commissions income

2,627

2,363

Of which:



Financial instruments that are not fair valued through profit or loss

763

722

Trust and other fiduciary activities

358

305




Fees and commissions expense

(495)

(442)

Of which:



Financial instruments that are not fair valued through profit or loss

(171)

(125)

Trust and other fiduciary activities

(31)

(25)




Net fees and commission

2,132

1,921

 

- page 70 -




 


6 months ended 30.06.25

6 months ended 30.06.24

Corporate & Investment Banking
$million

Wealth & Retail Banking
$million

Ventures
$million

Central & other items
$million

Total
$million

Corporate & Investment Banking
$million

Wealth & Retail Banking1
$million

Ventures1
$million

Central & other items1
$million

Total
$million

Transaction Services

781

-

-

-

781

 704

 -

 -

 -

 704

Payments & Liquidity

315

-

-

-

315

 290

 -

 -

 -

 290

Securities Services

166

-

-

-

166

 127

 -

 -

 -

 127

Trade & Working Capital

300

-

-

-

300

 287

 -

 -

 -

 287

Global Banking

551

-

-

-

551

 504

 -

 -

 -

 504

Lending & Financial Solutions

323

-

-

-

323

 336

 -

 -

 -

 336

Capital Market & Advisory

228

-

-

-

228

 168

 -

 -

 -

 168

Global Markets

23

-

-

-

23

 24

 -

 -

 -

 24

Macro Trading

-

-

-

-

-

 7

 -

 -

 -

 7

Credit Trading

22

-

-

-

22

 17

 -

 -

 -

 17

Valuation & Other Adjustments

1

-

-

-

1

 -

 -

 -

 -

-

Wealth solutions

-

967

-

-

967

 -

 822

 -

 -

 822

Investment Products

-

548

-

-

548

 -

 456

 -

 -

 456

Bancassurance

-

419

-

-

419

 -

 366

 -

 -

 366

Deposits & Mortgages

-

104

-

-

104

 -

 121

 -

 -

 121

CCPL & Other Unsecured Lending

-

149

-

-

149

 -

 161

 -

 -

 161

Ventures

-

-

43

-

43

 -

 -

 30

 -

 30

Digital Banks

-

-

26

-

26

 -

 -

 18

 -

 18

SC Ventures

-

-

17

-

17

 -

 -

 12

 -

 12

Treasury & Other

-

13

-

(4)

9

 -

 13

 -

 (16)

 (3)

Fees and commission income

1,355

1,233

43

(4)

2,627

 1,232

 1,117

 30

 (16)

 2,363

Fees and commission expense

(267)

(159)

(13)

(56)

(495)

 (239)

 (162)

 (11)

 (30)

 (442)

Net fees and commission

1,088

1,074

30

(60)

2,132

 993

 955

 19

 (46)

 1,921

1   Products have been re-presented in line with the RNS on Re-Presentation of Financial Information issued on 2 April 2025 with no change in total income

Upfront bancassurance consideration amounts are amortised on a straight-line basis over the contractual period to which the consideration relates. Deferred income on the balance sheet in respect of these activities is $392 million (30 June 2024: $448 million), which will be earned evenly over the remaining life of the contract until June 2032. For the six months ended 30 June 2025, $28 million of fee income was released from deferred income (30 June 2024: $28 million).

For the bancassurance contract with the annual performance bonus, based on progress so far and expectation of meeting the performance targets by year-end with a high probability, a pro-rata portion of the total performance fee, equal to $119 million (30 June 2024: $116 million) of the fee has been recognised as fee income in the period.

5. Net trading income


6 months ended 30.06.25
$million

6 months ended 30.06.24
$million

Net trading income

5,438

4,749

Significant items within net trading income include:



Gains on instruments held for trading1

4,353

3,717

Gains on financial assets mandatorily at fair value through profit or loss

2,710

2,499

Losses on financial assets designated at fair value through profit or loss

(3)

(1)

Losses on financial liabilities designated at fair value through profit or loss

(1,626)

(1,595)

1   Includes $207 million loss (30 June 2024: $110 million gain) from the translation of foreign currency monetary assets and liabilities



- page 71 -


 

6. Other operating income


6 months ended 30.06.25
$million

6 months ended 30.06.24
$million

Other operating income includes:



Rental income from operating lease assets

16

20

Net gain/(loss) on disposal of fair value through other comprehensive income debt instruments

9

(90)

Net (loss)/gain on amortised cost financial assets

(7)

4

Net gain/(loss) on sale of businesses

2423

(169)¹

Dividend income

6

4

Other

26

177²

Other operating income

292

(54)

1   Includes loss of $174 million from sale of subsidiary (SCB Zimbabwe Limited) of which $190 million relates to CTA loss. loss of $15 million on disposal of aviation business, offset by gain of $17 million on disposal of Shoal and Autumn Life Pte (subsidiary)

2   Includes IAS 29 adjustment Ghana hyperinflationary impact ($106 million)

3   Includes gain of $239 million from disposal of Standard Chartered Research of which $3 million relates to currency translation adjustment loss, and gain of $9 million from the sale of the WRB business in Tanzania, partly offset by $5 million loss from the sale of Standard Chartered Bank Gambia Limited of which $8 million relates to Currency Translation Adjudgment loss

On 26 June 2025, the Group disposed of its entire interest in Standard Chartered Research and Technology India Private Limited (SCRTIPL) a wholly owned subsidiary as part of a combined share swap and primary investment transaction (the Solv India transaction or the transaction). The transaction has resulted in the Group recognising Jumbotail Technologies Private Limited as an associate.

The carrying amount of the net assets of SCRTIPL at the date of the Solv India transaction was $16 million. The Group recognised a gain on the transaction of $238 million. The consideration received in the combined share swap was $344 million, including a primary cash investment of $80 million. Disposal costs were approximately $9 million.

The gain on disposal arose because the carrying value of the subsidiary's net assets was exceeded by the consideration received. No impairment of OCI balances was required. The disposal has resulted in the recycling of $3 million of Currency Translation Adjustments to profit and loss.

The Group elected to apply the 12-month measurement exemption to finalise the purchase price allocation. The allocation is incomplete at half year as additional analysis is required to finalise the nature and value of intangible assets.

7. Operating expenses


6 months ended 30.06.25
$million

6 months ended 30.06.24
$million

Staff costs:



Wages and salaries

3,367

3,288

Social security costs

143

129

Other pension costs

215

223

Share-based payment costs

206

172

Other staff costs

462

524


4,393

4,336

Premises and equipment expenses

175

177

General administrative expenses

1,135

1,027

Depreciation and amortisation



Property, plant and equipment:



Premises

153

148

Equipment

66

39




Intangibles:



Software

325

329


544

516

Total operating expenses

6,247

6,056

Other staff costs include redundancy expenses of $62 million (30 June 2024: $115 million). Further costs in this category include training, travel costs and other staff-related costs.

Operating expenses include research expenditure of $500 million (30 June 2024: $480 million), which was recognised as an expense during the period.

- page 72 -


 

8. Credit impairment


6 months ended 30.06.25
$million

6 months ended 30.06.24
$million

Net credit impairment on loans and advances to banks and customers

332

256

Net credit impairment on debt securities¹

12

(41)

Net credit impairment relating to financial guarantees and loan commitments

(16)

24

Net credit impairment relating to other financial assets

8

1

Credit impairment charge1

336

240

1   Includes impairment charge of $6 million (30 June 2024: $14 million release) on originated credit-impaired debt securities

9. Goodwill, property, plant and equipment and other impairment


6 months ended 30.06.25
$million

6 months ended 30.06.24
$million

Impairment of other intangible assets (Note 16)

18

148

Other

1

(1)

Goodwill, property, plant and equipment and other impairment

19

147

10. Taxation

The following table provides analysis of taxation charge in the period:


6 months ended 30.06.25
$million

6 months ended 30.06.24
$million

The charge for taxation based upon the profit for the period comprises:



Current tax:



United Kingdom corporation tax at 25 per cent (2024: 25 per cent):



Current tax charge on income for the period

5

10

Adjustments in respect of prior periods (including double tax relief)

8

2

Foreign tax:



Current tax charge on income for the period

1,000

993

Adjustments in respect of prior periods (including double tax relief)

(9)

27


1,004

1,032

Deferred tax:



Origination/reversal of temporary differences

109

89

Adjustments in respect of prior periods (including double tax relief)

(56)

2


53

91

Tax on profits on ordinary activities

1,057

1,123

Effective tax rate

24.1%

32.2%

The tax charge for the period has been calculated by applying the effective rate of tax which is expected to apply for the year ending 31 December 2025 using rates substantively enacted at 30 June 2025. The rate has been calculated by estimating and applying an average annual effective income tax rate to each tax jurisdiction individually.

The tax charge for the period of $1,057 million (30 June 2024: $1,123 million) on a profit before tax of $4,383 million (30 June 2024: $3,492 million) reflects the impact of non-creditable withholding taxes and other taxes, tax losses for which no deferred tax assets are recognised and non-deductible expenses offset by countries with tax rates lower than the UK, the most significant of which includes Hong Kong and Singapore and tax exempt income.

Foreign tax includes current tax of $196 million (30 June 2024: $131 million) on the profits assessable in Hong Kong. Deferred tax includes origination or reversal of temporary differences of $9 million (30 June 2024: $27 million) provided at a rate of 16.5 per cent (30 June 2024: 16.5 per cent) on the profits assessable in Hong Kong.

The Group falls within the Pillar Two global minimum tax rules which apply in the UK from 1 January 2024. The IAS 12 exception to recognise and disclose information about deferred tax assets and liabilities related to Pillar Two income taxes has been applied. The current tax charge for the period ended 30 June 2025 includes $10 million in respect of Pillar Two income taxes (30 June 2024: $10 million).



- page 73 -


 

Deferred tax comprises assets and liabilities as follows:


30.06.25

31.12.24

Total
$million

Asset
$million

Liability
$million

Total
$million

Asset
$million

Liability
$million

Deferred tax comprises:







Accelerated tax depreciation

(377)

37

(414)

(380)

19

(399)

Impairment provisions on loans and advances

202

196

6

190

139

51

Tax losses carried forward

87

17

70

74

51

23

Equity Instruments at Fair value through other comprehensive income

(74)

(2)

(72)

(62)

(12)

(50)

Debt Instruments at Fair value through other comprehensive income

(60)

1

(61)

(30)

(14)

(16)

Cash flow hedges

(89)

(17)

(72)

(9)

-

(9)

Own credit adjustment

17

1

16

4

4

-

Retirement benefit obligations

(5)

12

(17)

(7)

16

(23)

Share-based payments

51

11

40

54

12

42

Other temporary differences

(68)

143

(211)

13

199

(186)


(316)

399

(715)

(153)

414

(567)

11. Dividends

Ordinary equity shares


6 months ended 30.06.25

6 months ended 30.06.24

Cents per share

$million

Cents per share

$million

2023 final dividend declared and paid during the period

-

-

21

551

2024 final dividend declared and paid during the period

28

670

-

-

The 2024 final dividend per share of 28 cents per ordinary share ($670 million) was paid to eligible shareholders on 19 May 2025, and is recognised in these interim accounts.

Interim dividends on ordinary equity shares are recorded in the period in which they are declared and, in respect of the final dividend, have been approved by the shareholders.

2025 recommended interim ordinary share dividend

The 2025 interim dividend of 12.3 cents per ordinary share will be paid in pounds sterling, Hong Kong dollars or US dollars on 30 September 2025 to shareholders on the UK register of members at the close of business in the UK on 8 August 2025.

Preference shares and Additional Tier 1 (AT1) securities

Dividends on these preference shares and securities classified as equity are recorded in the period in which they are declared.


6 months ended 30.06.25
$million

6 months ended 30.06.24
$million

Non-cumulative redeemable preference shares:



7.014 per cent preference shares of $5 each

26

26

Floating rate preference shares of $5 each¹

24

27


50

53

AT1 securities: fixed rate resetting perpetual subordinated contingent convertible securities

194

156


244

209

1   Floating rate is based on Secured Overnight Financing Rate (SOFR), average rate paid for floating preference shares is 6.28 per cent (30 June 2024: 7.24 per cent)



- page 74 -


 

12. Earnings per ordinary share


6 months ended 30.06.25
$million

6 months ended 30.06.24
$million

Profit for the period attributable to equity holders

3,326

2,369

Non-controlling interest

(17)

9

Dividend payable on preference shares and AT1 classified as equity

(244)

(209)

Profit for the period attributable to ordinary shareholders

3,065

2,169




Items normalised:1



Restructuring

137

64

FFG

160

86

DVA

(5)

26

Net loss on sale of business

5

189

Other items

-

100

Tax on normalised items

(55)

(67)

Underlying profit for the period attributable to ordinary shareholders

3,307

2,567




Basic - weighted average number of shares (millions)

2,375

2,605

Diluted - weighted average number of shares (millions)

2,443

2,669




Basic earnings per ordinary share (cents)

129.1

83.3

Diluted earnings per ordinary share (cents)

125.5

81.3

Underlying basic earnings per ordinary share (cents)

139.2

98.5

Underlying diluted earnings per ordinary share (cents)

135.4

96.2

1   Refer to Note 2 segmental information for normalised items

The calculation of basic earnings per share is based on the profit attributable to equity holders of the parent and the basic weighted average number of shares excluding treasury shares held in employees benefit trust. When calculating diluted earnings per share, the weighted average number of shares in issue is adjusted for the effects of all expected dilutive potential ordinary shares held in respect of Standard Chartered PLC totalling 58 million (30 June 2024: 59 million). The total number of share options outstanding, under schemes considered to be potentially dilutive, was 10 million (30 June 2024: 5 million). These options have strike prices ranging from $5.03 to $8.36. Of the total number of employee share options and share awards at 30 June 2025, there were nil share options and awards which were anti-dilutive.

The 230 million decrease (30 June 2024: 234 million decrease) in the basic weighted average number of shares is primarily due to the impact of the share buyback programmes completed during the period.



- page 75 -


 

13. Financial instruments

Classification and measurement

Assets

Notes

Assets at fair value

Assets
held at amortised cost
$million

Total
$million

Trading
$million

Derivatives held for hedging
$million

Non-trading mandatorily at fair value through profit
or loss
$million

Designated at fair value through profit or loss
$million

Fair value
through other comprehensive income
$million

Total financial assets at
fair value
$million

Cash and balances at
central banks
1


-

-

-

-

-

-

80,165

80,165

Financial assets held at fair value through profit or loss










Loans and advances to banks2


2,393

-

-

-

-

2,393

-

2,393

Loans and advances
to customers
2


7,961

-

158

-

-

8,119

-

8,119

Reverse repurchase
agreements and other
similar secured lending

15

50

-

90,283

-

-

90,333

-

90,333

Debt securities, alternative tier one and other eligible bills


93,044

-

138

46

-

93,228

-

93,228

Equity shares


7,287

-

163

-

-

7,450

-

7,450



110,735

-

90,742

46

-

201,523

-

201,523

Derivative financial instruments

14

62,813

1,412

-

-

-

64,225

-

64,225

Loans and advances to banks2,3


-

-

-

-

-

-

42,386

42,386

of which - reverse repurchase agreements and other similar secured lending

15

-

-

-

-

-

-

4,250

4,250

Loans and advances to customers2


-

-

-

-

-

-

286,731

286,731

of which - reverse repurchase agreements and other similar secured lending

15

-

-

-

-

-

-

4,189

4,189

Investment securities










Debt securities, alternative tier one and other eligible bills


-

-

-

-

102,407

102,407

55,210

157,617

Equity shares


-

-

-

-

971

971

-

971



-

-

-

-

103,378

103,378

55,210

158,588

Other assets

18

-

-

-

-

-

-

45,372

45,372

Assets held for sale

20

1

-

-

-

-

1

622

623

Total at 30 June 2025


173,549

1,412

90,742

46

103,378

369,127

510,486

879,613

1   Comprises cash held at central banks in restricted accounts of $10,912 million, or on demand, or placements which are contractually due to mature overnight only. Other placements with central banks are reported as part of Loans and advances to customers

2   Further analysed in the Risk review and Capital review sections

3   Loans and advances to banks include amounts due on demand from banks other than central banks

- page 76 -




 

Assets

Notes

Assets at fair value

Assets
held at amortised cost
$million

Total
$million

Trading
$million

Derivatives held for hedging
$million

Non-trading mandatorily at fair value through profit
or loss
$million

Designated at fair value through profit or loss
$million

Fair value
through other comprehensive income
$million

Total financial assets at
fair value
$million

Cash and balances at
central banks
1


-

-

-

-

-

-

63,447

63,447

Financial assets held at fair value through profit or loss










Loans and advances to banks2


2,213

-

-

-

-

2,213

-

2,213

Loans and advances
to customers
2


6,912

-

172

-

-

7,084

-

7,084

Reverse repurchase
agreements and other
similar secured lending

15

336

-

85,859

-

-

86,195

-

86,195

Debt securities, alternative tier one and other eligible bills


76,329

-

140

70

-

76,539

-

76,539

Equity shares


5,285

-

201

-

-

5,486

-

5,486



91,075

-

86,372

70

-

177,517

-

177,517

Derivative financial instruments

14

78,906

2,566

-

-

-

81,472

-

81,472

Loans and advances to banks2,3


-

-

-

-

-

-

43,593

43,593

of which - reverse repurchase agreements and other similar secured lending

15

-

-

-

-

-

-

2,946

2,946

Loans and advances
to customers
2


-

-

-

-

-

-

281,032

281,032

of which - reverse repurchase agreements and other similar secured lending

15

-

-

-

-

-

-

9,660

9,660

Investment securities










Debt securities, alternative tier one and other eligible bills


-

-

-

-

88,425

88,425

55,137

143,562

Equity shares


-

-

-

-

994

994

-

994



-

-

-

-

89,419

89,419

55,137

144,556

Other assets

18

-

-

-

-

-

-

34,585

34,585

Assets held for sale

20

-

-

-

5

-

5

884

889

Total at 31 December 2024


169,981

2,566

86,372

75

89,419

348,413

478,678

827,091

1   Comprises cash held at central banks in restricted accounts of $7,799 million, or on demand, or placements which are contractually due to mature overnight only.
Other placements with central banks are reported as part of Loans and advances to customers

2   Further analysed in the Risk review and Capital review sections

3   Loans and advances to banks include amounts due on demand from banks other than central banks



- page 77 -


 

Liabilities

Notes

Liabilities at fair value

Amortised cost
$million

Total
$million

Trading
$million

Derivatives held for hedging
$million

Designated at fair value through
profit or loss
$million

Total financial liabilities at
fair value
$million

Financial liabilities held at fair value through profit or loss








Deposits by banks


-

-

1,994

1,994

-

1,994

Customer accounts


71

-

24,887

24,958

-

24,958

Repurchase agreements and other similar secured borrowing

15

-

-

43,946

43,946

-

43,946

Debt securities in issue


-

-

12,997

12,997

-

12,997

Short positions


15,656

-

-

15,656

-

15,656



15,727

-

83,824

99,551

-

99,551

Derivative financial instruments

14

67,886

1,992

-

69,878

-

69,878

Deposits by banks


-

-

-

-

30,883

30,883

Customer accounts


-

-

-

-

517,390

517,390

Repurchase agreements and other similar secured borrowing

15

-

-

-

-

5,250

5,250

Debt securities in issue


-

-

-

-

70,088

70,088

Other liabilities

21

-

-

-

-

47,921

47,921

Subordinated liabilities and other borrowed funds

24

-

-

-

-

8,778

8,778

Liabilities included in disposal groups held for sale

20

-

-

-

-

194

194

Total at 30 June 2025


83,613

1,992

83,824

169,429

680,504

849,933

Financial liabilities held at fair value through profit or loss








Deposits by banks

 

-

-

1,893

1,893

-

1,893

Customer accounts

 

-

-

21,772

21,772

-

21,772

Repurchase agreements and other similar secured borrowing

15

925

-

32,614

33,539

-

33,539

Debt securities in issue

 

1

-

13,730

13,731

-

13,731

Short positions

 

14,527

-

-

14,527

-

14,527


 

15,453

-

70,009

85,462

-

85,462

Derivative financial instruments

14

80,037

2,027

-

82,064

-

82,064

Deposits by banks

 

-

-

-

-

25,400

25,400

Customer accounts

 

-

-

-

-

464,489

464,489

Repurchase agreements and other similar secured borrowing

15

-

-

-

-

12,132

12,132

Debt securities in issue

 

-

-

-

-

64,609

64,609

Other liabilities

21

-

-

-

-

44,047

44,047

Subordinated liabilities and other borrowed funds

24

-

-

-

-

10,382

10,382

Liabilities included in disposal groups held for sale

20

-

-

-

-

360

360

Total at 31 December 2024

 

95,490

2,027

70,009

167,526

621,419

788,945

Financial liabilities designated at fair value through profit or loss


30.06.25
$million

31.12.24
$million

Carrying balance aggregate fair value

83,824

70,009

Amount contractually obliged to repay at maturity

83,728

70,166

Difference between aggregate fair value and contractually obliged to repay at maturity

96

(157)

Cumulative change in Fair Value accredited to Credit Risk difference

(286)

(276)

The net fair value loss on financial liabilities designated at fair value through profit or loss was $1,626 million for the period (31 December 2024: net loss of $3,252 million).

Further details of the Group's own credit adjustment (OCA) valuation technique is described later in this Note.



- page 78 -


 

Valuation of financial instruments

The Valuation Methodology function is responsible for independent price verification, oversight of fair value and appropriate value adjustments and escalation of valuation issues. Independent price verification is the process of determining that the valuations incorporated into the financial statements are validated independent of the business area responsible for the product. The Valuation Methodology function has oversight of the fair value adjustments to ensure the financial instruments are priced to exit.

These are key controls in ensuring the material accuracy of the valuations incorporated in the financial statements. The market data used for price verification (PV) may include data sourced from recent trade data involving external counterparties or third parties such as Bloomberg, Reuters, brokers and consensus pricing providers. The Valuation Methodology function performs an ongoing review of the market data sources that are used as part of the PV and fair value processes which are formally documented on a semi-annual basis detailing the suitability of the market data used for price testing.

Price verification uses independently sourced data that is deemed most representative of the market the instruments trade in. To determine the quality of the market data inputs, factors such as independence, relevance, reliability, availability of multiple data sources and methodology employed by the pricing provider are taken into consideration.

The Valuation and Benchmarks Committee is the valuation governance forum consisting of representatives from Group Market Risk, Product Control, Valuation Methodology and the business, which meets monthly to discuss and approve the independent valuations of the inventory. For Principal Finance, the Investment Committee meeting is held on a quarterly basis to review investments and valuations.

Significant accounting estimates and judgements

The Group evaluates the significance of financial instruments and material accuracy of the valuations incorporated in the financial statements as they involve a high degree of judgement and estimation uncertainty in determining the carrying values of financial assets and liabilities at the balance sheet date.

Fair value of financial instruments is determined using valuation techniques and estimates (see below) which, to the extent possible, use market observable inputs, but in some cases use non-market observable inputs. Changes in the observability of significant valuation inputs can materially affect the fair values of financial instruments

When establishing the exit price of a financial instrument using a valuation technique, the Group estimates valuation adjustments in determining the fair value.

In determining the valuation of financial instruments, the Group makes judgements on the amounts reserved to cater for model and valuation risks, which cover both Level 2 and Level 3 assets, and the significant valuation judgements in respect of Level 3 instruments.

Where the estimated measurement of fair value is more judgemental in respect of Level 3 assets, these are valued based on models that use a significant degree of non-market-based unobservable inputs.

Valuation techniques

Refer to the fair value hierarchy explanation - Level 1, 2 and 3.

Financial instruments held at fair value

Debt securities - asset-backed securities: Asset-backed securities are valued based on external prices obtained from consensus pricing providers, broker quotes, recent trades, arrangers' quotes, etc. Where an observable price is available for a given security, it is classified as Level 2. In instances where third-party prices are not available or reliable, the security is classified as Level 3. The fair value of Level 3 securities is estimated using market standard cash flow models with input parameter assumptions which include prepayment speeds, default rates, discount margins derived from comparable securities with similar vintage, collateral type, and credit ratings.

Debt securities in issue: These debt securities relate to structured notes issued by the Group. Where independent market data is available through pricing vendors and broker sources, these positions are classified as Level 2. Where such liquid external prices are not available, valuations of these debt securities are implied using input parameters such as bond spreads and credit spreads, and are classified as Level 3. These input parameters are determined with reference to the same issuer (if available) or proxies from comparable issuers or assets.



- page 79 -


 

Derivatives: Derivative products are classified as Level 2 if the valuation of the product is based upon input parameters which are observable from independent and reliable market data sources. Derivative products are classified as Level 3 if there are significant valuation input parameters which are unobservable in the market, such as products where the performance is linked to more than one underlying variable. Examples are foreign exchange basket options, equity options based on the performance of two or more underlying indices, and interest rate products with quanto payouts. In most cases these unobservable correlation parameters cannot be implied from the market, and methods such as historical analysis and comparison with historical levels or other benchmark data must be employed.

Equity shares - unlisted equity investments: The majority of unlisted equity investments are valued based on market multiples, including Price to Book (P/B), Price-to-Earnings (P/E) or enterprise value to earnings before income tax, depreciation and amortisation (EV/EBITDA) ratios of comparable listed companies. The primary inputs for the valuation of these investments are the actual financials or forecasted earnings of the investee companies and market multiples obtained from the comparable listed companies. To ensure comparability between these unquoted investments and the comparable listed companies, appropriate adjustments are also applied (for example, liquidity and size) in the valuation. In circumstances where an investment does not have direct comparables or where the multiples for the comparable companies cannot be sourced from reliable external sources, alternative valuation techniques (for example, discounted cash flow model or net asset value ("NAV") or option pricing model), which use predominantly unobservable inputs or Level 3 inputs, may be applied. Even though market multiples for the comparable listed companies can be sourced from third-party sources (for example, Bloomberg), and those inputs can be deemed Level 2 inputs, all unlisted investments (excluding those where observable inputs are available, for example, over-the-counter (OTC) prices) are classified as Level 3 on the basis that the valuation methods involve judgements ranging from determining comparable companies to discount rates where the discounted cash flow method is applied.

Loans and advances: These primarily include loans in the FM Bond and Loan Syndication business which were not fully syndicated as of the balance sheet date and other financing transactions within Financial Markets, and loans and advances including reverse repurchase agreements that do not have SPPI cashflows or are managed on a fair value basis. Where available, their loan valuation is based on observable clean sales transactions prices or market observable spreads. If observable credit spreads are not available, proxy spreads based on comparables with similar credit grade, sector and region, are used. Where observable transaction prices, credit spreads and market standard proxy methods are available, these loans are classified as Level 2. Where there are no recent transactions or comparables, these loans are classified as Level 3.

Other debt securities: These debt securities include convertible bonds, corporate bonds, credit and structured notes. Where quoted prices are available through pricing vendors, brokers or observable trading activities from liquid markets, these are classified as Level 2 and valued using such quotes. Where there are significant valuation inputs which are unobservable in the market, due to illiquid trading or the complexity of the product, these are classified as Level 3. The valuations of these debt securities are implied using input parameters such as bond spreads and credit spreads. These input parameters are determined with reference to the same issuer (if available) or proxied from comparable issuers or assets

Financial instruments held at amortised cost

The following sets out the Group's basis for establishing fair values of amortised cost financial instruments and their classification between Levels 1, 2 and 3. As certain categories of financial instruments are not actively traded, there is a significant level of management judgement involved in calculating the fair values:

Cash and balances at central banks: The fair value of cash and balances at central banks is their carrying amounts.

Debt securities in issue, subordinated liabilities and other borrowed funds: The aggregate fair values are calculated based on quoted market prices. For those notes where quoted market prices are not available, a discounted cash flow model is used based on a current market-related yield curve appropriate for the remaining term to maturity.



 

Deposits and borrowings: The estimated fair value of deposits with no stated maturity is the amount repayable on demand. The estimated fair value of fixed interest-bearing deposits and other borrowings without quoted market prices is based on discounted cash flows using the prevailing market rates for debts with a similar Credit Risk and remaining maturity.

- page 80 -


 

Investment securities: For investment securities that do not have directly observable market values, the Group utilises a number of valuation techniques to determine fair value. Where available, securities are valued using input proxies from the same or closely related underlying (for example, bond spreads from the same or closely related issuer) or input proxies from a different underlying (for example, a similar bond but using spreads for a particular sector and rating). Certain instruments cannot be proxies as set out above, and in such cases the positions are valued using non-market observable inputs. This includes those instruments held at amortised cost and predominantly relates to asset-backed securities. The fair value for such instruments is usually proxies from internal assessments of the underlying cash flows.

Loans and advances to banks and customers: For loans and advances to banks, the fair value of floating rate placements and overnight deposits is their carrying amounts. The estimated fair value of fixed interest-bearing deposits is based on discounted cash flows using the prevailing money market rates for debts with a similar Credit Risk and remaining maturity.

-  The Group's loans and advances to customers' portfolio is well diversified by geography and industry. Approximately a quarter of the portfolio reprices within one month, and approximately half reprices within 12 months. Loans and advances are presented net of provisions for impairment.

-  The fair value of loans and advances to customers with a residual maturity of less than one year generally approximates the carrying value. The estimated fair value of loans and advances with a residual maturity of more than one year represents the discounted amount of future cash flows expected to be received, including assumptions relating to prepayment rates and Credit Risk.

-  Expected cash flows are discounted at current market rates to determine fair value. The Group has a wide range of individual instruments within its loans and advances portfolio and, as a result, providing quantification of the key assumptions used to value such instruments is impractical.

Other assets: Other assets comprise primarily of cash collateral and trades pending settlement. The carrying amount of these financial instruments is considered to be a reasonable approximation of fair value as they are either short-term in nature or reprice to current market rates frequently.

Fair value adjustments

When establishing the exit price of a financial instrument using a valuation technique, the Group considers adjustments to the modelled price which market participants would make when pricing that instrument. The main valuation adjustments (described further below) in determining fair value for financial assets and financial liabilities are as follows:


01.01.25
$million

Movement
during the year
$million

30.06.25
$million

01.01.24
$million

Movement
during the year
$million

31.12.24
$million

Bid-offer valuation adjustment

117

6

123

115

2

117

Credit valuation adjustment

134

5

139

119

15

134

Debit valuation adjustment

(105)

(8)

(113)

(129)

24

(105)

Model valuation adjustment

5

1

6

4

1

5

Funding valuation adjustment

41

(9)

32

33

8

41

Other fair value adjustments

26

19

45

25

1

26

Total

218

14

232

167

51

218








Income deferrals







Day 1 and other deferrals

138

(11)

127

109

29

138

Total

138

(11)

127

109

29

138

Note: Amounts shown in brackets represent an asset and credit to the income statement

Bid-offer valuation adjustment: Generally, market parameters are marked on a mid-market basis in the revaluation systems, and a bid-offer valuation adjustment is required to quantify the expected cost of neutralising the business' positions through dealing away in the market, thereby bringing long positions to bid and short positions to offer. The methodology to calculate the bid-offer adjustment for a derivative portfolio involves netting between long and short positions and the grouping of risk by strike and tenor based on the hedging strategy where long positions are marked to bid and short positions marked to offer in the systems.



- page 81 -


 

Credit valuation adjustment (CVA): The Group accounts for CVA against the fair value of derivative products. CVA is an adjustment to the fair value of the transactions to reflect the possibility that our counterparties may default and we may not receive the full market value of the outstanding transactions. It represents an estimate of the adjustment a market participant would include when deriving a purchase price to acquire our exposures. CVA is calculated for each subsidiary, and within each entity for each counterparty to which the entity has exposure and takes account of any collateral we may hold. The Group calculates the CVA by using estimates of future positive exposure, market-implied probability of default (PD) and recovery rates. Where market-implied data is not readily available, we use market-based proxies to estimate the PD. Wrong-way risk occurs when the exposure to a counterparty is adversely correlated with the credit quality of that counterparty, and the Group has implemented a model to capture this impact for key wrong-way exposures. The Group also captures the uncertainties associated with wrong-way risk in the Group's Prudential Valuation Adjustments framework.

Debit valuation adjustment (DVA): The Group calculates DVA adjustments on its derivative liabilities to reflect changes in its own credit standing. The Group's DVA adjustments will increase if its credit standing worsens and conversely, decrease if its credit standing improves. For derivative liabilities, a DVA adjustment is determined by applying the Group's probability of default to the Group's negative expected exposure against the counterparty. The Group's probability of default and loss expected in the event of default is derived based on bond and CDS spreads associated with the Group's issuances and market standard recovery levels. The expected exposure is modelled based on the simulation of the underlying risk factors over the expected life of the deal. This simulation methodology incorporates the collateral posted by the Group and the effects of master netting agreements.

Model valuation adjustment: Valuation models may have pricing deficiencies or limitations that require a valuation adjustment. These pricing deficiencies or limitations arise due to the choice, implementation and calibration of the pricing model.

Funding valuation adjustment (FVA): The Group makes FVA adjustments against derivative products, including embedded derivatives. FVA reflects an estimate of the adjustment to its fair value that a market participant would make to incorporate funding costs or benefits that could arise in relation to the exposure. FVA is calculated by determining the net expected exposure at a counterparty level and then applying a funding rate to those exposures that reflect the market cost of funding. The FVA for uncollateralised (including partially collateralised) derivatives incorporates the estimated present value of the market funding cost or benefit associated with funding these transactions.

Other fair value adjustments: For certain products, the prices cannot be replicated by usual models or the choice of model inputs can be more subjective. In these circumstances, an adjustment may be necessary to reflect the prices available in the market.

Day one and other deferrals: In certain circumstances the initial fair value is based on a valuation technique which differs to the transaction price at the time of initial recognition. However, these gains can only be recognised when the valuation technique used is based primarily on observable market data. In those cases where the initially recognised fair value is based on a valuation model that uses inputs which are not observable in the market, the difference between the transaction price and the valuation model is not recognised immediately in the income statement. The difference is amortised to the income statement until the inputs become observable, or the transaction matures or is terminated. Other deferrals primarily represent adjustments taken to reflect the specific terms and conditions of certain derivative contracts which affect the termination value at the measurement date.

In addition, the Group calculates own credit adjustment (OCA) on its issued debt designated at fair value, including structured notes, in order to reflect changes in its own credit standing. Issued debt is discounted utilising the spread at which similar instruments would be issued or bought back at the measurement date as this reflects the value from the perspective of a market participant who holds the identical item as an asset. OCA measures the difference between the fair value of issued debt as of reporting date and theoretical fair values of issued debt adjusted up or down for changes in own credit spreads from inception date to the measurement date. Under IFRS 9 the change in the OCA component is reported under other comprehensive income. The Group's OCA reserve will increase if its credit standing worsens in comparison to the inception of the trade and, conversely, decrease if its credit standing improves. The Group's OCA reserve will reverse over time as its liabilities mature.



- page 82 -


 

Fair value hierarchy - financial instruments held at fair value

The fair values of quoted financial assets and liabilities in active markets are based on current prices. A market is regarded as active if transactions for the asset or liability take place with sufficient frequency and volume to provide pricing information on an ongoing basis. Wherever possible, fair values have been calculated using unadjusted quoted market prices in active markets for identical instruments held by the Group. Where quoted market prices are not available, or are unreliable because of poor liquidity, fair values have been determined using valuation techniques which, to the extent possible, use market observable inputs, but in some cases use unobservable inputs. Valuation techniques used include discounted cash flow analysis and pricing models and, where appropriate, comparison with instruments that have characteristics similar to those of the instruments held by the Group.

Assets and liabilities carried at fair value or for which fair values are disclosed have been classified into three levels according to the observability of the significant inputs used to determine the fair values. Changes in the observability of significant valuation inputs during the reporting period may result in a transfer of assets and liabilities within the fair value hierarchy. The Group recognises transfers between levels of the fair value hierarchy when there is a significant change in either its principal market or the level of observability of the inputs to the valuation techniques as at the end of the reporting period.

Level 1: Fair value measurements are those derived from unadjusted quoted prices in active markets for identical assets or liabilities.

Level 2: Fair value measurements are those with quoted prices for similar instruments in active markets or quoted prices for identical or similar instruments in inactive markets and financial instruments valued using models where all significant inputs are observable.

Level 3: Fair value measurements are those where inputs which could have a significant effect on the instrument's valuation are not based on observable market data.



- page 83 -


 

The following tables show the classification of financial instruments held at fair value into the valuation hierarchy:

Assets

30.06.25

31.12.24

Level 1
$million

Level 2
$million

Level 3
$million

Total
$million

Level 1
$million

Level 2
$million

Level 3
$million

Total
$million

Financial instruments held at fair value through profit or loss









Loans and advances to banks

-

2,122

271

2,393

-

2,213

-

2,213

Loans and advances to customers

-

5,781

2,338

8,119

-

5,147

1,937

7,084

Reverse repurchase agreements and other similar secured lending

-

86,941

3,392

90,333

19

82,937

3,239

86,195

Debt securities and other eligible bills

40,762

50,584

1,882

93,228

32,331

42,615

1,593

76,539

Of which:









Issued by central banks and governments1

37,273

18,183

4

55,460

30,278

13,355

9

43,642

Issued by corporates other than financial institutions1

14

6,227

235

6,476

7

4,860

399

5,266

Issued by financial institutions1

3,475

26,174

1,643

31,292

2,046

24,400

1,185

27,631










Equity shares

7,132

-

318

7,450

5,287

8

191

5,486

Derivative financial instruments

770

63,351

104

64,225

386

80,958

128

81,472

Of which:









Foreign exchange

158

55,876

26

56,060

140

72,870

37

73,047

Interest rate

23

5,845

55

5,923

27

6,296

80

6,403

Credit

-

274

18

292

-

388

9

397

Equity and stock index options

-

184

5

189

-

349

2

351

Commodity

589

1,172

-

1,761

219

1,055

-

1,274










Investment securities









Debt securities and other eligible bills

59,414

42,993

-

102,407

50,249

38,176

-

88,425

Of which:









Issued by central banks and governments1

47,073

23,000

-

70,073

41,395

16,916

-

58,311

Issued by corporates other than financial institutions1

-

431

-

431

-

490

-

490

Issued by financial institutions1

12,341

19,562

-

31,903

8,854

20,770

-

29,624










Equity shares

30

7

934

971

27

2

965

994










Total assets2

108,108

251,779

9,239

369,126

88,299

252,056

8,053

348,408

Liabilities









Financial instruments held at fair value through profit or loss









Deposits by banks

-

1,664

330

1,994

-

1,522

371

1,893

Customer accounts

-

20,672

4,286

24,958

-

19,058

2,714

21,772

Repurchase agreements and other similar secured borrowing

-

43,946

-

43,946

-

33,539

-

33,539

Debt securities in issue

-

11,649

1,348

12,997

-

12,317

1,414

13,731

Short positions

8,359

7,209

88

15,656

8,789

5,558

180

14,527










Derivative financial instruments

446

69,208

224

69,878

419

81,387

258

82,064

Of which:









Foreign exchange

137

57,419

19

57,575

183

69,684

8

69,875

Interest rate

30

7,285

21

7,336

14

8,586

23

8,623

Credit

-

2,672

132

2,804

-

2,131

189

2,320

Equity and stock index options

-

350

52

402

-

157

37

194

Commodity

279

1,482

-

1,761

222

829

1

1,052










Total liabilities

8,805

154,348

6,276

169,429

9,208

153,381

4,937

167,526

1   Includes covered bonds of $3,231 million (31 December 2024: $3,727 million), securities issued by Multilateral Development Banks/International Organisations of $15,928 million (31 December 2024: $10,679 million), and State-owned agencies and development banks of $25,561 million (31 December 2024: $16,759 million)

2   The table above does not include held for sale assets of $1 million (31 December 2024: $5 million) .These are reported in Note 20 together with their fair value hierarchy



- page 84 -


 

The fair value of financial assets and financial liabilities classified as Level 2 in the fair value hierarchy that are subject to complex modelling techniques is $286 million (31 December 2024: $739 million) and $350 million (31 December 2024: $320 million) respectively.

There were no significant changes to valuation or levelling approaches during the period ending 30 June 2025.

There were no significant transfers of financial assets and liabilities measured at fair value between Level 1 and Level 2 during the period ended 30 June 2025.

Fair value hierarchy - financial instruments measured at amortised cost

The following table shows the carrying amounts and incorporates the Group's estimate of fair values of those financial assets and liabilities not presented on the Group's balance sheet at fair value. These fair values may be different from the actual amount that will be received or paid on the settlement or maturity of the financial instrument. For certain instruments, the fair value may be determined using assumptions for which no observable prices are available.


30.06.25

31.12.24

Carrying value
$million

Fair value

Carrying value
$million

Fair value

Level 1
$million

Level 2
$million

Level 3
$million

Total
$million

Level 1
$million

Level 2
$million

Level 3
$million

Total
$million

Assets











Cash and balances at central banks¹

80,165

-

80,165

-

80,165

63,447

-

63,447

-

63,447

Loans and advances to banks

42,386

-

42,363

48

42,411

43,593

-

43,430

165

43,595

of which - reverse repurchase agreements and other similar secured lending

4,250

-

4,254

-

4,254

2,946

-

2,948

-

2,948

Loans and advances to customers

286,731

-

29,641

257,678

287,319

281,032

-

40,582

238,986

279,568

of which - reverse repurchase agreements and other similar secured lending

4,189

-

4,178

11

4,189

9,660

-

9,618

42

9,660

Investment securities2

55,210

-

53,756

-

53,756

55,137

-

53,050

24

53,074

Other assets¹

45,372

-

45,372

-

45,372

34,585

-

34,585

-

34,585

Assets held for sale

622

15

491

116

622

884

58

353

473

884

Total assets

510,486

15

251,788

257,842

509,645

478,678

58

235,447

239,648

475,153

Liabilities











Deposits by banks

30,883

-

30,883

-

30,883

25,400

-

25,238

-

25,238

Customer accounts

517,390

-

513,906

-

513,906

464,489

-

461,549

-

461,549

Repurchase agreements and other similar secured borrowing

5,250

-

5,249

-

5,249

12,132

-

12,133

-

12,133

Debt securities in issue

70,088

34,121

35,757

-

69,878

64,609

32,209

32,181

-

64,390

Subordinated liabilities and other borrowed funds

8,778

7,904

559

-

8,463

10,382

9,599

429

-

10,028

Other liabilities¹

47,921

-

47,921

-

47,921

44,047

-

44,047

-

44,047

Liabilities held for sale

194

-

194

-

194

360

89

271

-

360

Total liabilities

680,504

42,025

634,469

-

676,494

621,419

41,897

575,848

-

617,745

1   The carrying amount of these financial instruments is considered to be a reasonable approximation of fair value as they are short-term in nature or reprice to current market rates frequently

2   Includes Government bonds and treasury bills of $25,525 million at 30 June 2025 (31 December 2024: $23,150 million)



- page 85 -


 

Fair value of financial instruments

Level 3 Summary and significant unobservable inputs

The following table presents the Group's primary Level 3 financial instruments which are held at fair value. The table also presents the valuation techniques used to measure the fair value of those financial instruments, the significant unobservable inputs, the range of values for those inputs and the weighted average of those inputs:

Instrument

Value at
30 June 2025

Principal valuation technique

Significant unobservable inputs

Range1

Weighted average2

Assets
$million

Liabilities
$million

Loans and advances to banks

271

-

Discounted cash flows

Price/yield

4.5% - 4.9%

4.6%

Loans and advances to customers

2,338

-

Discounted cash flows

Price/yield

0.7% - 100%

27.5%




Recovery rate

94.7% - 96.3%

96.0%

Reverse repurchase agreements and other similar secured lending

3,392

-

Discounted cash flows

Repo curve

1.7% - 8.5%

6.1%




Price/yield

4.9% - 18.1%

6.9%

Debt securities, alternative tier one and other eligible securities

1,878

-

Discounted cash flows

Price/yield

0.7% - 19.4%

6.7%




Recovery rate

0.01% - 15.0%

5.7%

Government bonds and treasury bills

4

-

Discounted cash flows

Price/yield

8.6% - 8.6%

8.6%

Equity shares (includes private equity investments)

1,252

 -

Comparable pricing/yield

EV/Revenue multiples

7.1x - 10.0x

7.6x




P/E multiples

15.5x - 31.7x

20.0x




P/B multiples

0.4x - 3.4x

1.3x




P/S multiples

1.3x - 1.3x

1.3x




Liquidity discount

18.9% - 30.2%

19.7%



Discounted cash flows

Discount rates

7.1% - 19.8%

13.8%



Option pricing model

Equity value based on EV/Revenue multiples

6.3x - 19.0x

13.3x




Equity value based on EV/EBITDA multiples

3.9x - 3.9x

3.9x




Equity value based on volatility

40.0% - 105.0%

101.5%

Derivative financial instruments
of which:







Foreign exchange

26

19

Option pricing model

Foreign exchange option implied volatility

39.4% - 42.5%

41.8%



Discounted cash flows

Interest rate curves

1.9% - 11.6%

3.9%




Foreign exchange curves

1.7% - 27.6%

12.1%

Interest rate

55

21

Discounted cash flows

Interest rate curves

3.6% - 28.2%

4.7%



Option pricing model

Bond option implied volatility

0.1% - 1.1%

0.8%

Credit

18

132

Discounted cash flows

Price/yield

2.8% - 5.8%

5.0%




Interest rate curves

3.6% - 4.5%

4.0%




Option pricing model

Credit spreads

0.1% - 2.2%

0.8%





Bond option implied volatility

15.0% - 15.0%

15.0%

Equity and stock index

5

52

Internal pricing model

Equity-Equity correlation

28.1% - 100%

77.2%




Equity-FX correlation

(40.0)% - 46.2%

4.5%

Deposits by banks

-

330

Discounted cash flows

Price/yield

4.5% - 5.8%

5.2%

Customer accounts

-

4,286

Internal pricing model

Equity-Equity correlation

28.1% - 100%

77.2%




Equity-FX correlation

(40.0)% - 46.2%

4.5%



Discounted cash flows

Interest rate curves

5.1% - 11.6%

9.3%




Price/yield

0.7% - 19.4%

10.0%




Option pricing model

Foreign exchange option implied volatility

5.5% - 6.8%

5.7%

Debt securities in issue

-

1,348

Discounted cash flows

Price/yield

0.7% - 16.3%

4.9%




Foreign exchange curves

4.4% - 13.1%

9.1%



Internal pricing model

Equity-Equity correlation

28.1% - 100%

77.2%




Equity-FX correlation

(40.0)% - 46.2%

4.7%



Option pricing model

Bond option implied volatility

0.1% - 15%

14.9%

Short positions

-

88

Discounted cash flows

Price/yield

5.4% - 6.1%

5.4%

Total

9,239

6,276





1   The ranges of values shown in the above table represent the highest and lowest levels used in the valuation of the Group's Level 3 financial instruments at 30 June 2025. The ranges of values used are reflective of the underlying characteristics of these Level 3 financial instruments based on the market conditions at the balance sheet date. However, these ranges of values may not represent the uncertainty in fair value measurements of the Group's Level 3 financial instruments

2   Weighted average for non-derivative financial instruments has been calculated by weighting inputs by the relative fair value. Weighted average for derivatives has been provided by weighting inputs by the risk relevant to that variable. N/A has been entered for the cases where weighted average is not a meaningful indicator



- page 86 -


 

Instrument

Value at
31 December 2024

Principal valuation technique

Significant unobservable inputs

Range1

Weighted average2

Assets
$million

Liabilities
$million

Loans and advances to customers

1,937

-

Discounted cash flows

Price/yield

1.0% - 100%

20.8%





Recovery rate

93.2% - 95.6%

95.1%

Reverse repurchase agreements and other similar secured lending

3,239

-

Discounted cash flows

Repo curve

2.0% - 7.6%

6.2%




Price/yield

2.3% - 10.5%

6.4%

Debt securities, alternative tier one and other eligible securities

1,584

-

Discounted cash flows

Price/yield

0.7% - 15.3%

6.9%




Recovery rate

0.01% - 16.3%

9.2%

Government bonds and treasury bills

9

-

Discounted cash flows

Price/yield

23.5% - 23.5%

23.5%

Equity shares (includes private equity investments)

1,156

-

Comparable pricing/yield

EV/EBITDA multiples

5.3x - 18.1x

14.8x




EV/Revenue multiples

8.5x - 12.9x

9.0x




P/E multiples

17.9x - 48.3x

46.9x




P/B multiples

0.3x - 3.2x

1.3x




P/S multiples

0.2x - 1.3x

0.2x




Liquidity discount

10.0% - 30.0%

16.8%



Discounted cash flows

Discount rates

8.3% - 20.4%

10.1%



Option pricing model

Equity value based on EV/Revenue multiples

5.7x - 23.6x

16.2x




Equity value based on EV/EBITDA multiples

10.1x - 10.1x

10.1x




Equity value based on volatility

30.2% - 50.0%

30.5%

Derivative financial instruments
of which:







Foreign exchange

37

8

Option pricing model

Foreign exchange option implied volatility

10.2% - 46.2%

42.0%





Interest rate curves

3.5% - 9.0%

4.2%





Foreign exchange curves

(0.03)% - 34.3%

6.1%

Commodity

-

1

Discounted cash flows

Commodity prices

$383.0 - $391.0

$387.0





CM-CM correlation

73.7% - 97.9%

86.0%

Interest rate

80

23

Discounted cash flows

Interest rate curves

3.5% - 43.9%

5.1%




Option pricing model

Bond option implied volatility

2.3% - 4.7%

3.5%

Credit

9

189

Discounted cash flows

Credit spreads

0.1% - 1.9%

0.9%





Price/yield

4.8% - 6.6%

5.5%

Equity and stock index

2

37

Internal pricing model

Equity-Equity correlation

44.9% - 100%

80.0%





Equity-FX correlation

(36.4)% - 48.9%

5.0%

Deposits by banks

-

371

Discounted cash flows

Credit spreads

0.2% - 3.5%

1.5%

Customer accounts

-

2,714

Internal pricing model

Equity-Equity correlation

44.9% - 100%

80.0%





Equity-FX correlation

(36.4)% - 48.9%

5.0%




Discounted cash flows

Interest rate curves

1.4% - 4.4%

4.0%





Price/yield

0.7% - 13.0%

8.5%

Debt securities in issue

-

1,414

Discounted cash flows

Credit spreads

0.05% - 2.0%

0.8%





Price/yield

6.2% - 14.8%

12.7%





Interest rate curves

3.5% - 4.4%

4.1%




Internal pricing model

Equity-Equity correlation

44.9% - 100%

80.0%





Equity-FX correlation

(36.4)% - 48.9%

5.0%




Option pricing model

Bond option implied volatility

4.0% - 15%

12.5%

Short positions

-

180

Discounted cash flows

Price/yield

5.9% - 12.7%

6.3%

Total

8,053

4,937





1   The ranges of values shown in the above table represent the highest and lowest levels used in the valuation of the Group's Level 3 financial instruments at 31 December 2024. The ranges of values used are reflective of the underlying characteristics of these Level 3 financial instruments based on the market conditions at the balance sheet date. However, these ranges of values may not represent the uncertainty in fair value measurements of the Group's Level 3 financial instruments

2   Weighted average for non-derivative financial instruments has been calculated by weighting inputs by the relative fair value. Weighted average for derivatives has been provided by weighting inputs by the risk relevant to that variable. N/A has been entered for the cases where weighted average is not a meaningful indicator



- page 87 -


 

The following section describes the significant unobservable inputs identified in the valuation technique table:

Comparable price/yield is a valuation methodology in which the price of a comparable instrument is used to estimate the fair value where there are no direct observable prices. Yield is the interest rate that is used to discount the future cash flows in a discounted cash flow model. Valuation using comparable instruments can be done by calculating an implied yield (or spread over a liquid benchmark) from the price of a comparable instrument, then adjusting that yield (or spread) to derive a value for the instrument. The adjustment should account for relevant differences in the financial instruments such as maturity and/or credit quality. Alternatively, a price-to-price basis can be assumed between the comparable instrument and the instrument being valued in order to establish the value of the instrument (for example, deriving a fair value for a junior unsecured bond from the price of a senior secured bond). An increase in price, in isolation, would result in a favourable movement in the fair value of the asset. An increase in yield, in isolation, would result in an unfavourable movement in the fair value of the asset.

Correlation is the measure of how movement in one variable influences the movement in another variable. An equity correlation is the correlation between two equity instruments while an interest rate correlation refers to the correlation between two swap rates, and commodity correlation is correlation between two commodity underlying prices.

Commodity price curves is the term structure for forward rates over a specified period.

Credit spread represents the additional yield that a market participant would demand for taking exposure to the Credit Risk of an instrument.

Discount rate refers to the rate of return used to convert expected cash flows into present value.

Equity-FX correlation is the correlation between equity instrument and foreign exchange instrument.

EV/EBITDA multiple is the ratio of Enterprise Value (EV) to Earnings Before Interest, Taxes, Depreciation and Amortisation (EBITDA). EV is the aggregate market capitalisation and debt minus the cash and cash equivalents. An increase in EV/EBITDA multiple will result in a favourable movement in the fair value of the unlisted firm.

EV/Revenue multiple is the ratio of Enterprise Value (EV) to Revenue. An increase in EV/Revenue multiple will result in a favourable movement in the fair value of the unlisted firm.

Foreign exchange curves is the term structure for forward rates and swap rates between currency pairs over a specified period.

Net asset value (NAV) is the value of an entity's assets after deducting any liabilities.

Interest rate curves is the term structure of interest rates and measures of future interest rates at a particular point in time.

Liquidity discounts in the valuation of unlisted investments are primarily applied to the valuation of unlisted firms' investments to reflect the fact that these stocks are not actively traded. An increase in liquidity discount will result in an unfavourable movement in the fair value of the unlisted firm.

Price-Earnings (P/E) multiple is the ratio of the market value of the equity to the net income after tax. An increase in P/E multiple will result in a favourable movement in the fair value of the unlisted firm.

Price-Book (P/B) multiple is the ratio of the market value of equity to the book value of equity. An increase in P/B multiple will result in a favourable movement in the fair value of the unlisted firm.

Price-Sales (P/S) multiple is the ratio of the market value of equity to sales. An increase in P/S multiple will result in a favourable movement in the fair value of the unlisted firm.

Recovery rate is the expectation of the rate of return resulting from the liquidation of a particular loan. As the probability of default increases for a given instrument, the valuation of that instrument will increasingly reflect its expected recovery level assuming default. An increase in the recovery rate, in isolation, would result in a favourable movement in the fair value of the loan.

Repo curve is the term structure of repo rates on repos and reverse repos at a particular point in time.

Volatility represents an estimate of how much a particular instrument, parameter or index will change in value over time. Generally, the higher the volatility, the more expensive the option will be.



- page 88 -


 

Level 3 movement tables - financial assets

The table below analyses movements in Level 3 financial assets carried at fair value.

Assets

Held at fair value through profit or loss

Investment securities

Loans and advances
to banks
$million

Loans and advances
to customers
$million

Reverse repurchase agreements and other similar secured lending
$million

Debt securities, alternative tier one and other eligible bills
$million

Equity
shares
$million

Other
Assets
$million

Derivative financial instruments
$million

Debt securities, alternative tier one and other eligible bills
$million

Equity
shares
$million

Total
$million

At 1 January 2025

-

1,937

3,239

1,593

191

-

128

-

965

8,053

Total (losses)/gains recognised in income statement

(2)

24

(66)

(3)

(18)

-

(9)

-

-

(74)

Net trading income

(2)

24

(66)

53

(18)

-

(9)

-

-

(18)

Other operating income

-

-

-

(56)

-

-

-

-

-

(56)

Total (losses)/gains recognised in other comprehensive income (OCI)

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

107

107

Fair value through OCI reserve

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

91

91

Exchange difference

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

16

16

Purchases

278

1,069

5,476

747

164

-

59

-

11

7,804

Sales

-

(668)

(5,172)

(651)

(12)

-

(33)

-

(151)

(6,687)

Settlements

(5)

(78)

(85)

(6)

-

-

(24)

-

-

(198)

Transfers out1

-

(269)

-

(32)

(7)

-

(17)

-

(4)

(329)

Transfers in2

-

323

-

234

-

-

-

-

6

563

At 30 June 2025

271

2,338

3,392

1,882

318

-

104

-

934

9,239

Recognised in the income statement3

-

(8)

(8)

1

(18)

-

3

-

-

(30)

At 1 January 2024

-

1,960

2,363

1,262

184

6

80

72

787

6,714

Total (losses)/gains recognised in income statement

-

(18)

(85)

25

(1)

(1)

(36)

-

-

(116)

Net trading income

-

(18)

(85)

(6)

2

-

(36)

-

-

(143)

Other operating income

-

-

-

31

(3)

(1)

-

-

-

27

Total (losses)/gains recognised in other comprehensive income (OCI)

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

(13)

(31)

(44)

Fair value through OCI reserve

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

(18)

(18)

Exchange difference

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

(13)

(13)

(26)

Purchases

18

2,538

2,725

468

3

-

166

13

37

5,968

Sales

(2)

(2,631)

(2,199)

(668)

(3)

(4)

(114)

-

(18)

(5,639)

Settlements

(7)

(14)

(329)

-

-

-

(15)

-

-

(365)

Transfers out

(13)

(155)

(5)

-

-

-

(2)

(72)

(1)

(248)

Transfers in

40

255

140

-

6

-

38

-

1

480

At 30 June 2024

36

1,935

2,610

1,087

189

1

117

-

775

6,750

Recognised in the income statement3

-

1

1

11

12

-

(10)

-

-

15

1   Transfers out includes loans and advances, debt securities, alternative tier one and other eligible bills, equity shares and derivative financial instruments where the valuation parameters became observable during the period and were transferred to Level 1 and Level 2

2   Transfers in primarily relate to loans and advances, debt securities, alternative tier one and other eligible bills and equity shares where the valuation parameters become unobservable during the period

3   Represents total unrealised (losses)/gains recognised in the income statement, within net trading income, relating to change in fair value of asset



- page 89 -


 

Level 3 movement tables - financial liabilities


Deposits by banks
$million

Customer accounts
$million

Debt securities
in issue
$million

Derivative financial instruments
$million

Short
positions
$million

Other
liabilities
$million

Total
$million

At 1 January 2025

371

2,714

1,414

258

180

-

4,937

Total losses/(gains) recognised in income statement -
net trading income

65

10

56

8

(2)

-

137

Issues

157

3,067

1,022

350

-

-

4,596

Settlements

(263)

(1,316)

(1,109)

(387)

(90)

-

(3,165)

Transfers out1

-

(230)

(39)

(10)

-

-

(279)

Transfers in2

-

41

4

5

-

-

50

At 30 June 2025

330

4,286

1,348

224

88

-

6,276

Recognised in the income statement3

1

3

5

2

-

-

11

At 1 January 2024

334

1,278

1,041

196

103

8

2,960

Total losses/(gains) recognised in income statement -
net trading income

37

(4)

16

(12)

-

(7)

30

Issues

218

1,427

2,334

240

-

-

4,219

Settlements

(190)

(990)

(1,127)

(217)

-

-

(2,524)

Transfers out

-

(20)

(162)

(7)

(103)

-

(292)

Transfers in

-

38

37

9

-

-

84

At 30 June 2024

399

1,729

2,139

209

-

1

4,477

Recognised in the income statement3

24

3

5

(4)

-

-

28

1   Transfers out during the period primarily relate to customer accounts, debt securities in issue and derivative financial instruments where the valuation parameters became observable during the period and were transferred to Level 2 financial liabilities

2   Transfers in during the period primarily relate to customer accounts, debt securities in issue and derivative financial instruments where the valuation parameters become unobservable during the period

3   Represents total unrealised losses/(gains) recognised in the income statement, within net trading income, relating to change in fair value of liabilities

Sensitivities in respect of the fair values of Level 3 assets and liabilities

Sensitivity analysis is performed on products with significant unobservable inputs. The Group applies a 10 per cent increase or decrease on the values of these unobservable inputs, to generate a range of reasonably possible alternative valuations. The percentage shift is determined by statistical analysis performed on a set of reference prices based on the composition of the Group's Level 3 inventory as the measurement date.

Favourable and unfavourable changes (which show the balance adjusted for input change) are determined on the basis of changes in the value of the instrument as a result of varying the levels of the unobservable parameters. The Level 3 sensitivity analysis assumes a one-way market move and does not consider offsets for hedges.

- page 90 -




 


Held at fair value through profit or loss

Fair value through other comprehensive income

Net exposure
$million

Favourable
changes
$million

Unfavourable changes
$million

Net exposure
$million

Favourable
changes
$million

Unfavourable changes
$million

Financial instruments held at fair value







Loans and advances

2,609

2,651

2,533

-

-

 -

Reverse repurchase agreements and other similar secured lending

3,392

3,491

3,300

 -

-

 -

Debt securities, alternative tier one and other eligible bills

1,882

1,943

1,822

 -

 -

 -

Equity shares

318

349

287

 934

 1,027

 841

Derivative financial instruments

(120)

(105)

(135)

 -

 -

 -

Customer accounts

(4,286)

(3,999)

(4,556)

 -

 -

 -

Deposits by banks

(330)

(326)

(334)

 -

 -

 -

Short positions

(88)

(87)

(89)

 -

 -

 -

Debt securities in issue

(1,348)

(1,262)

(1,435)

 -

 -

 -

At 30 June 2025

2,029

2,655

1,393

 934

 1,027

 841

Financial instruments held at fair value







Loans and advances

1,937

1,985

1,862

-

-

-

Reverse repurchase agreements and other similar secured lending

3,239

3,339

3,138

-

-

-

Debt securities, alternative tier one and other eligible bills

1,593

1,643

1,542

-

-

-

Equity shares

191

210

172

965

1,032

888

Derivative financial instruments

(130)

(115)

(147)

-

-

-

Customer accounts

(2,714)

(2,540)

(2,883)

-

-

-

Deposits by banks

(371)

(371)

(371)

-

-

-

Short positions

(180)

(178)

(182)

-

-

-

Debt securities in issue

(1,414)

(1,352)

(1,476)

-

-

-

At 31 December 2024

2,151

2,621

1,655

965

1,032

888

The reasonably possible alternatives could have increased or decreased the fair values of financial instruments held at fair value through profit or loss and those classified as fair value through other comprehensive income by the amounts disclosed below.

Financial instruments

Fair value changes

Possible increase

Possible decrease

30.06.25
$million

31.12.24
$million

30.06.25
$million

31.12.24
$million

Held at fair value through profit or loss

626

470

(636)

(496)

Fair value through other comprehensive income

93

67

(93)

(77)

 

- page 91 -




 

14. Derivative financial instruments

The tables below analyse the notional principal amounts and the positive and negative fair values of derivative financial instruments. Notional principal amounts are the amounts of principal underlying the contract at the reporting date.

Derivatives

30.06.25

31.12.24

Notional principal amounts
$million

Assets
$million

Liabilities
$million

Notional principal amounts
$million

Assets
$million

Liabilities
$million

Foreign exchange derivative contracts:







Forward foreign exchange contracts

5,638,429

45,632

46,062

4,923,991

54,913

51,128

Currency swaps and options

1,692,000

10,403

11,474

1,377,308

18,104

18,720


7,330,429

56,035

57,536

6,301,299

73,017

69,848

Interest rate derivative contracts:







Swaps

7,739,177

19,019

20,160

6,267,261

20,600

22,282

Forward rate agreements and options

313,474

1,166

1,081

294,705

2,233

2,771


8,052,651

20,185

21,241

6,561,966

22,833

25,053

Exchange traded futures and options

508,822

25

39

383,528

30

27

Credit derivative contracts

224,896

292

2,804

227,675

397

2,320

Equity and stock index options

15,918

189

402

10,678

351

194

Commodity derivative contracts

197,517

1,761

1,761

142,393

1,274

1,052

Gross total derivatives

16,330,233

78,487

83,783

13,627,539

97,902

98,494

Offset

-

(14,262)

(13,905)

-

(16,430)

(16,430)

Total derivatives

16,330,233

64,225

69,878

13,627,539

81,472

82,064

The Group limits exposure to credit losses in the event of default by entering into master netting agreements with certain market counterparties. As required by IAS 32, exposures are only presented net in these accounts where they are subject to legal right of offset and intended to be settled net in the ordinary course of business.

The Group applies balance sheet offsetting only in the instance where we are able to demonstrate legal enforceability of the right to offset (e.g. via legal opinion) and the ability and intention to settle on a net basis (e.g. via operational practice).

The Group may enter into economic hedges that do not qualify for IAS 39 hedge accounting treatment, including derivatives such as interest rate swaps, interest rate futures and cross currency swaps to manage interest rate and currency risks of the Group. These derivatives are measured at fair value, with fair value changes recognised in net trading income: refer to Market Risk.

Derivatives held for hedging

The Group enters into derivative contracts for the purpose of hedging interest rate, currency and structural foreign exchange risks inherent in assets, liabilities and forecast transactions. The table below summarises the notional principal amounts and carrying values of derivatives designated in hedge accounting relationships at the reporting date.

Included in the table above are derivatives held for hedging purposes as follows:


30.06.25

31.12.24

Notional principal amounts
$million

Assets
$million

Liabilities
$million

Notional principal amounts
$million

Assets
$million

Liabilities
$million

Derivatives designated as fair value hedges:







Interest rate swaps

65,172

828

1,232

63,840

763

1,679

Currency swaps

1,175

90

-

1,035

-

56


66,347

918

1,232

64,875

763

1,735

Derivatives designated as cash flow hedges:







Interest rate swaps

52,796

334

65

49,309

165

282

Forward foreign exchange contracts

3,286

30

61

9,193

609

1

Currency swaps

9,348

71

215

14,305

729

2


65,430

435

341

72,807

1,503

285

Derivatives designated as net investment hedges:







Forward foreign exchange contracts

18,558

59

419

14,137

300

7

Total derivatives held for hedging

150,335

1,412

1,992

151,819

2,566

2,027

 

- page 92 -




 

15. Reverse repurchase and repurchase agreements including other similar lending and borrowing

Reverse repurchase agreements and other similar secured lending


30.06.25
$million

31.12.24
$million

Banks

38,815

37,700

Customers

59,957

61,101


98,772

98,801

Of which:



Fair value through profit or loss

90,333

86,195

Banks

34,565

34,754

Customers

55,768

51,441

Held at amortised cost

8,439

12,606

Banks

4,250

2,946

Customers

4,189

9,660




Under reverse repurchase and securities borrowing arrangements, the Group obtains securities under usual and customary terms which permit it to repledge or resell the securities to others. Amounts on such terms are:


30.06.25
$million

31.12.24
$million

Securities and collateral received (at fair value)

101,219

103,007

Securities and collateral which can be repledged or sold (at fair value)

100,946

102,741

Amounts repledged/transferred to others for financing activities, to satisfy liabilities under sale and repurchase agreements (at fair value)

19,126

27,708

Repurchase agreements and other similar secured borrowing


30.06.25
$million

31.12.24
$million

Banks

9,411

8,669

Customers

39,785

37,002


49,196

45,671

Of which:



Fair value through profit or loss

43,946

33,539

Banks

8,617

7,759

Customers

35,329

25,780

Held at amortised cost

5,250

12,132

Banks

794

910

Customers

4,456

11,222




The tables below set out the financial assets provided as collateral for repurchase and other secured borrowing transactions:

Collateral pledged against repurchase agreements

Fair value through profit or loss
$million

Fair value
through other comprehensive income
$million

Amortised cost
$million

Off-balance sheet
$million

Total
$million

On-balance sheet






Debt securities and other eligible bills

5,559

12,118

14,062

-

31,739

Off-balance sheet






Repledged collateral received

-

-

-

19,126

19,126

At 30 June 2025

5,559

12,118

14,062

19,126

50,865

On-balance sheet






Debt securities and other eligible bills

4,698

6,366

7,592

-

18,656

Off-balance sheet






Repledged collateral received

-

-

-

27,708

27,708

At 31 December 2024

4,698

6,366

7,592

27,708

46,364

The Group applies balance sheet offsetting only in the instance where we are able to demonstrate legal enforceability of the right to offset (e.g. via legal opinion) and the ability and intention to settle on a net basis (e.g. via operational practice).



- page 93 -


 

16. Goodwill and intangible assets


30.06.25

31.12.24

Goodwill
$million

Acquired intangibles
$million

Computer software
$million

Total
$million

Goodwill
$million

Acquired intangibles
$million

Computer software
$million

Total
$million

Cost









At 1 January

2,387

252

6,301

8,940

2,429

278

6,168

8,875

Exchange translation differences

75

15

249

339

(42)

(18)

(109)

(169)

Additions

-

-

451

451

-

1

952

953

Disposals

-

-

(11)

(11)

-

-

(5)

(5)

Impairment

-

-

(49)1

(49)

-

-

(663)2

(663)

Amounts written off

-

-

(53)

(53)

-

(9)

(42)

(51)

At 30 June/31 December

2,462

267

6,888

9,617

2,387

252

6,301

8,940

Provision for amortisation









At 1 January

-

249

2,900

3,149

-

265

2,396

2,661

Exchange translation differences

-

15

125

140

-

(20)

(48)

(68)

Amortisation

-

-

325

325

-

4

695

699

Impairment charge

-

-

(31)1

(31)

-

-

(102)2

(102)

Disposal

-

-

(4)

(4)

-

-

-

-

Amounts written off

-

-

(53)

(53)

-

-

(41)

(41)

At 30 June/31 December

-

264

3,262

3,526

-

249

2,900

3,149

Net book value

2,462

3

3,626

6,091

2,387

3

3,401

5,791

1   Includes impairment of software intangibles capitalised as at 31 December 2024

2   During 2024, the Group performed a review of its computer software intangibles which were capitalised as at 31 December 2023, and impaired $483 million of the 2024 net book value due to limitations in the available evidence to support the continued capitalisation of the assets. The Group has made improvements in its processes and controls to capture the required evidence going forward. The Group has also performed its annual review of computer software intangibles to determine instances when the Group is no longer using certain applications in its ongoing business and impaired $78 million. A total of $561 million is recorded within impairment to reflect the above

At 30 June 2025, accumulated goodwill impairment losses incurred from 1 January 2005 amounted to $3,331 million (31 December 2024: $3,331 million), of which nil was recognised on 30 June 2025 (31 December 2024: $ nil).

The Group assessed the goodwill assigned to each of the Group's cash-generating units (CGUs) and determined that there are no indicators of impairment for material CGUs at 30 June 2025.

17. Property, plant and equipment


30.06.25

31.12.24

Premises $million

Equipment $million

Leased premises assets $million

Leased equipment assets $million

Total $million

Premises $million

Equipment $million

Leased premises assets $million

Leased equipment assets $million

Total $million

Cost and valuation











At 1 January 2024

1,726

936

2,026

163

4,851

1,741

810

1,864

18

4,433

Exchange translation differences

53

23

50

1

127

(41)

(31)

(38)

(4)

(114)

Additions

78

47

132

5

262

112

194

213

150

669

Disposals and fully depreciated assets written off

(7)

(12)

(27)

(1)

(47)

(61)

(37)

(13)

(1)

(112)

Transfers to assets held for sale

(17)

-

1

-

(16)


-

-

-

-

Other movements

(3)

-

-

-

(3)

(25)

-

-

-

(25)

At 30 June/31 December

1,830

994

2,182

168

5,174

1,726

936

2,026

163

4,851

Depreciation











Accumulated at 1 January

716

575

1,096

39

2,426

692

535

914

18

2,159

Exchange translation differences

21

21

19

1

62

(28)

(15)

(40)

(14)

(97)

Charge for the year

41

51

112

15

219

79

92

220

36

427

Impairment charge

(1)

-

1

-

-

2

-

9

-

11

Attributable to assets sold, transferred or written off

(4)

(12)

(18)

(1)

(35)

(29)

(37)

(7)

(1)

(74)

Transfers to assets held for sale

(4)

-

-

-

(4)

-

-

-

-

-

At 30 June/31 December

769

635

1,210

54

2,668

716

575

1,096

39

2,426

Net book value

1,061

359

972

114

2,506

1,010

361

930

124

2,425

 



- page 94 -


 

18. Other assets

Other assets include:


30.06.25
$million

31.12.24
$million

Financial assets held at amortised cost (Note 13):



Hong Kong SAR Government certificates of indebtedness (Note 21)¹

6,360

6,369

Cash collateral2

13,895

11,046

Acceptances and endorsements

4,921

5,476

Unsettled trades and other financial assets

20,196

11,694


45,372

34,585

Non-financial assets:



Commodities and emissions certificates3

19,366

8,358

Other assets

691

525


65,429

43,468

1   The Hong Kong SAR Government certificates of indebtedness are subordinated to the claims of other parties in respect of bank notes issued

2   Cash collateral are margins placed to collateralise net derivative mark-to-market positions

3   Comprises precious metals and emission certificates, being inventory that is carried at fair value less costs to sell. $16.6 billion is precious metals which are classified as Level 1, the fair value of which being derived from observable spot or short-term futures prices from relevant exchanges (31 December 2024: $5.6 billion). $2.7 billion is emissions certificates and other commodity related balances classified as Level 2 (31 December 2024: $2.7 billion)

19. Investments in associates and joint ventures

Share of profit from investment in associates and joint ventures comprises:


6 months ended 30.06.25
$million

6 months ended 30.06.24
$million

Loss from investment in joint ventures

(7)

(3)

Profit from investment in associates

86

147

Total

79

144

 

Interests in associates and joint ventures

30.06.25
$million

31.12.24
$million

At 1 January

1,020

966

Exchange translation difference

22

(40)

Additions1

361

22

Share of profits

79

108

Dividend received2

(45)

(36)

Share of fair value through other comprehensive income (FVOCI) and Other reserves

(30)

9

Other movements

(2)

(9)

At 30 June/31 December

1,405

1,020

1   Includes investment in Jumbotail Technologies Private Limited. Refer to Note 6 Other operating income

2   Includes capital distribution from Ascenta IV

The Group's principal associates are:

Associate

Nature of activities

Main areas of operation

Group interest
in associate
%

China Bohai Bank

Banking

China

16.26

Jumbotail Technologies Pvt. Ltd

E-commerce

India

46.55

Jumbotail Technologies Private Ltd (JTPL)

On acquisition through the SCRTIPL transaction (refer to Note 6), the Group acquired a 46.55 per cent shareholding in JTPL, a company incorporated in India; these shares give the Group 46.64 per cent voting rights in JTPL. The carrying value as of 30 June 2025 was $344 million. JTPL is engaged in business-to-business e-commerce. As a result of the acquisition, the Group has significant influence over the investee through its shareholding and accounts for its interest based on the application of the equity method. The Group's share of the associate's results since acquisition are immaterial.

China Bohai Bank

The Group's ownership percentage in China Bohai Bank is 16.26 per cent.

Although the Group's investment in China Bohai Bank is less than 20 per cent, it is an associate because of the significant influence the Group can exercise over its management and financial and operating policies. This influence is exercised through Board representation and the provision of technical expertise to Bohai. The Group applies the equity method of accounting for investments in associates.


- page 95 -


 

If the Group did not have significant influence over Bohai, the investment would be measured at fair value rather than the current carrying value, which is based on the application of the equity method as described in the accounting policy note.

Bohai publishes their results after the Group. As it is impracticable for Bohai to prepare financial statements sooner, the Group recognises its share of Bohai's earnings on a three-month lag basis. Therefore, the Group recognised its share of Bohai's profits and movements in other comprehensive income from 1 October 2024 through 31 March 2025 (six months of earnings) in the Group's consolidated statement of income and consolidated statement of comprehensive income for the period ended 30 June 2025, also considering any known changes or events in the subsequent period from 1  April 2025  to 30 June 2025 that would have materially affected Bohai's results.

Impairment testing

On 30 June 2025, the listed equity value of Bohai is below the carrying amount of the Group's investment in associate. As a result, the Group assessed the carrying value of its investment in Bohai for impairment and concluded that no impairment was required for the period ended 30 June 2025 ($nil for the period ended 30 June 2024; $1,459 million of accumulated impairment at 30 June 2025). The Group has not reversed any previously recognised impairments during the period (2024: $nil). The carrying amount of the Group's investment in Bohai of $834 million (2024: $738 million) is supported with the higher of the value in use (VIU) and fair value less costs of disposal, i.e. the recoverable amount. The increase to the carrying amount during 2025 reflects the Group's share of profits of $103 million, other comprehensive loss of $30 million, net of foreign exchange profits of $23 million and  dividends received of $nil. The financial forecasts used to estimate the recoverable amount, a VIU calculation, reflects Group management's best estimate of Bohai's future earnings, in line with current economic conditions and Bohai's latest reported results.

Bohai

30.06.25
$million

31.12.24
$million

VIU

834

738

Carrying amount1

834

738

Market capitalisation2

320

338

1   The Group's 16.26 per cent share in the net assets less other equity instruments which the Group does not hold

2   Number of shares held by the Group multiplied by the quoted share price at period end

Basis of recoverable amount

The impairment test was performed by comparing the recoverable amount of Bohai, determined as the higher of VIU and fair value less costs to dispose, with its carrying amount.

The VIU is calculated using a dividend discount model (DDM), which estimates the distributable future cash flows to the equity holders, after adjusting for regulatory capital requirements, for a five-year period, after which a terminal value (TV) is calculated based on the price to earnings (P/E) exit multiple. The key assumptions in the VIU are as follows:

Short-to-medium term projections are based on Group management's best estimates of future profits available to ordinary shareholders and have been determined with reference to the latest published financial results, the historical performance of Bohai and forward-looking macroeconomic variables for Mainland China.

The projections use available information and include normalised performance over the forecast period, inclusive of: (i) balance sheet growth assumptions based on the short-to-medium term GDP growth rates for Mainland China; (ii) net interest income (NII) projecting interest income (primarily the one-year Loan Prime Rate (LPR), one-year LPR, as basis) and interest expense (Shanghai Interbank Offered Rate, three-month SHIBOR, as basis) which reference to forecast third-party market interest rates plus/minus an observed historical spread to the benchmark rate; (iii) non-interest income estimated according to the latest available performance of Bohai, with consideration of the contribution of the constituent parts of the non-interest income; (iv) expected credit loss (ECL) assumptions using Bohai's historical reported ECL, based on the proportion of ECL from loans and advances to customers and financial investments measured at amortised cost and FVOCI; and (v) statutory tax rate of 25 per cent was applied to the taxable profit of Bohai, after consideration of taxable and non-taxable elements, consistent with historical reported results.



- page 96 -


 

The distributable reserves under the DDM are calculated as the difference between the capital resources and the capital requirements in each of the forecast periods. The calculation assumes a target Common Equity Tier 1 (CET 1) capital ratio and risk-weighted asset (RWA) growth consistent with total assets.

The discount rate applied to these cash flows was estimated with reference to a capital asset pricing model (CAPM), which includes a long-term risk-free rate, beta, and company risk premium assumptions for Bohai.

A long-term average P/E multiple of comparable companies is used to derive a TV after the five-year forecast period.

The VIU model was refined during 2025  to include more granular forecasting assumptions for each period. While it is impracticable for the Group to estimate the impact on future periods, the key changes to the 2025 model are summarised as follows:

The Group continues to calculate non-interest income with reference to the five components, i.e., net gains on financial investments through P/L, net gains on financial investments through OCI, net fee and commission income, net trading income, and other income. All components of non-interest income continue to be grown by the relevant GDP rate for Mainland China over the forecast period. However, the Group changed the returns forecast for the financial investments through P/L over the forecast period, by using the most recent reported returns as the starting point, normalising such returns to a long-term average over the forecast period.  Previously, the return of this component of non-interest income was normalised to the long-term average from the start of the forecast period (year 1), and then grown according to relevant GDP rate of Mainland China.  As a result of this change, the year 1  total forecast non-interest income is more aligned to the recently reported results, but due to the normalisation affect, the implied growth is negligible.

The key assumptions used for the VIU calculation:


30.06.25

31.12.24

Post-tax discount rate1

10.00%

10.50%

Total balance sheet (and risk-weighted assets) growth rate

3.53% - 4.75%

3.77% - 4.52%

P/E multiple used to calculate TV

5.6x

5.6x

Interest income2

2.94% - 3.20%

3.00%-3.56%

Interest expense2

1.65% - 2.07%

1.77%-2.01%

Non-interest income - financial investments  return

1.91%-2.98%

1.91%

Other non-interest income growth rate

3.53% - 4.75%

3.77%-4.52%

Expected credit losses as a percentage of customer loans3

0.77%

0.84%-1.36%

Expected credit losses as a percentage of financial investments measured at amortised cost and FVOCI3

0.39% 

0.48%-1.26%

Tax expense4

9.68% - 13.83%

5.4% - 14.1%

Capital maintenance ratio

8.00%

8.00%

1   Pre-tax discount rate of 15.37 per cent was used in 2025  (2024: 15.31 per cent). The difference in pre-tax discount rates relates to changes in effective tax rate

2   One-year LPR and three-month SHIBOR rate forecasts were sourced from an external third-party provider, and with a spread derived from long-term historical averages, are used to produce the interest income and interest expense forecasts

3   As 31 December 2024 the low end of the range was based on historical loss rates, and the high end of the range, applied in one of the forecast years, included adjustments for incremental judgemental management overlays. At 30 June 2025 the ECL assumption is based on historical loss rates with an adjustment for incremental judgemental management overlays, applied over the five-year forecast period

4   The tax rates disclosed are the implied effective tax rates (per cent) over the five-yr forecast period. The 30 June 2025 tax expense forecasts, calculated from the taxable profit, considered the long-term historical average of non-taxable income of 17.22 per cent ( 2024: 16.09 per cent) and non-deductible expenses of 14.43 per cent (2024: 12.53 per cent). A statutory tax rate of 25 per cent was applied to the taxable profit of Bohai, after consideration of taxable and non-taxable elements



- page 97 -


 

The table below discloses sensitivities to the key assumptions of Bohai, according to management's judgement of reasonably possible changes. Changes were applied to every cash flow year on an individual basis. The percentage change to the assumptions reflects the level at which management assesses the reasonableness of the assumptions used and their impact on the carrying amount.

Sensitivities1

basis points

Key assumption increase

Key assumption decrease

Increase/(decrease)
in VIU
$million

Increase/(decrease)
in VIU
$million

Discount rate

100

 (31)

 33

Total balance sheet (and risk-weighted asset) growth rate2

100

-

 1

P/E multiple used to calculate TV

1.0x

 110

 (109)

Net interest income - Scenario 13

10

 (10)

 10

Net interest income - Scenario 24

Various4

 356

 (229)

Non-interest income - financial investments  return

100 

242

(241)

Other non-interest income growth rate

100

27

(25)

Expected credit losses as a percentage of customer loans

10

 (138)

 138

Expected credit losses as a percentage of financial investments measured at amortised cost and FVOCI

10

 (78)

 78

Tax expense5

300

 24

 (24)

Capital maintenance ratio

50

 (86)

 86

1   For comparative information as of 31 December 2024, refer to page 365 of the Group's Annual Report 2024

2   The sensitivity reflects the net impact of changing this assumption in the VIU, which links to various elements in forecast profit and regulatory capital adjustment

3   This scenario assumes that one-year LPR and three-month SHIBOR increase or decrease by the same amount, to demonstrate the impact on the carrying amount of a similar scenario

4   An alternative scenario is that Bohai's asset yield and liability cost move in the same direction, albeit by different amounts, through the five-year forecast period including the terminal value. The key assumption increase sensitivity assumes that asset yields increase by 25 basis points and liability costs increase by 10 basis points in each period. The key assumption decrease sensitivity assumes that asset yields decrease by 25 basis points and liability costs decrease by 15 basis points in each period

5   Changes in tax expense applied only to both average percentages of non-taxable income (17.22 per cent) and non-deductible expenses (14.43 per cent). Refer to footnote 4 of the key assumptions table for more details

The following table sets out the summarised financial statements of China Bohai Bank prior to the Group's share of the associate's profit being applied:


31.03.25
$million

31.03.24
$million

Total assets

249,471

243,892

Total liabilities

233,876

227,393




Operating income1

1,865

1,862

Net profit1

496

441

Other comprehensive income1

(189)

49

1   This represents six months of earnings (1 October to 31 March)

20. Assets held for sale and associated liabilities

Assets held for sale

The financial assets reported below are classified under Level 1 $15 million (31 December 2024: $58 million), Level 2 $491 million (31 December 2024: $353 million) and Level 3 $116 million (31 December 2024: $473 million).


30.06.25
$million

31.12.24
$million

Financial assets held at fair value through profit or loss

1

5

Loans and advances to banks

-

5

Equity shares

1

-

Financial assets held at amortised cost

622

884

Cash and balances at central banks

73

109

Loans and advances to banks

19

18

Loans and advances to customers

460

6561

Debt securities held at amortised cost

70

101




Property, plant and equipment

28

15

Other assets

30

28


681

932

1   Includes $414 million unsecured personal loan business from SC Bank India which was disposed on 23 January 2025

- page 98 -




 

Liabilities held for sale

The financial liabilities reported below are classified under Level 1 Nil (31 December 2024: $89 million) and Level 2 $194 million (31 December 2024: $271 million).


30.06.25
$million

31.12.24
$million

Financial liabilities held at amortised cost

194

360

Customer accounts

194

360




Other liabilities

16

16

Provisions for liabilities and charges

5

5


215

381

21. Other liabilities


30.06.25
$million

31.12.24
$million

Financial liabilities held at amortised cost (Note 13)



Notes in circulation1

6,360

6,369

Acceptances and endorsements

4,926

5,476

Cash collateral2

12,831

15,005

Property leases

1,089

1,041

Equipment leases

110

115

Unsettled trades and other financial liabilities

22,605

16,041


47,921

44,047

Non-financial liabilities



Cash-settled share-based payments

156

131

Other liabilities

561

503


48,638

44,681

1   Hong Kong currency notes in circulation of $6,360 million (31 December 2024: $6,369 million) that are secured by the Government of Hong Kong SAR certificates of indebtedness of the same amount included in other assets (Note 18)

2   Cash collateral includes margins received against collateralise net derivative mark-to-market positions

22. Contingent liabilities and commitments

The table below shows the contract or underlying principal amounts of unmatured off-balance sheet transactions at the balance sheet date. The contract or underlying principal amounts indicate the volume of business outstanding and do not represent amounts at risk.


30.06.25
$million

31.12.24
$million

Financial guarantees and other contingent liabilities



Financial guarantees, trade and irrevocable letters of credit

103,959

90,632


103,959

90,632

Commitments



Undrawn formal standby facilities, credit lines and other commitments to lend



One year and over

84,525

76,915

Less than one year

31,187

29,249

Unconditionally cancellable

77,235

76,365


192,947

182,529

Capital commitments



Contracted capital expenditure approved by the directors but not provided for in these accounts

105

123

As set out in Note 23, the Group has contingent liabilities in respect of certain legal and regulatory matters.



- page 99 -


 

23. Legal and regulatory matters

The Group receives legal claims against it in a number of jurisdictions and is subject to regulatory and enforcement investigations and proceedings from time to time. Apart from the matters described below, the Group currently considers none of the ongoing claims, investigations or proceedings to be individually material. However, in light of the uncertainties involved in such matters, there can be no assurance that the outcome of a particular matter or matters currently not considered to be material may not ultimately be material to the Group's results in a particular reporting period depending on, among other things, the amount of the loss resulting from the matter(s) and the results otherwise reported for such period.

Since 2014, the Group has been named as a defendant in a series of lawsuits that have been filed in the United States District Courts for the Southern and Eastern Districts of New York against a number of banks on behalf of plaintiffs who are, or are relatives of, victims of attacks in Iraq, Afghanistan and Israel. The plaintiffs in each of these lawsuits have alleged that the defendant banks aided and abetted the unlawful conduct of parties with connections to terrorist organisations in breach of the United States Anti-Terrorism Act. None of these lawsuits specify the amount of damages claimed. The Group continues to defend these lawsuits.

In January 2020, a shareholder derivative complaint was filed by the City of Philadelphia in New York State Court against 45current and former directors and senior officers of the Group. It is alleged that the individuals breached their duties to the Group and caused a waste of corporate assets by permitting the conduct that gave rise to the costs and losses to the Group related to legacy conduct and control issues. In February 2022, the New York State Court ruled in favour of Standard Chartered PLC's motion to dismiss the complaint. The plaintiffs are pursuing an appeal against the February 2022 ruling. A hearing date for the plaintiffs' appeal is awaited.

Since October 2020, four lawsuits have been filed in the English High Court against Standard Chartered PLC on behalf of more than 200 shareholders in relation to alleged untrue and/or misleading statements and/or omissions in information published by Standard Chartered PLC in its rights issue prospectuses of 2008, 2010 and 2015 and/or public statements regarding the Group's historic sanctions, money laundering and financial crime compliance issues. These lawsuits have been brought under sections 90 and 90A of the Financial Services and Markets Act 2000. The trial of these lawsuits is due to start in late 2026. The claimants have alleged that their losses are in the region of £1.56 billion (excluding any pre-judgement interest that may be awarded). In addition to having denied any and all liability, Standard Chartered PLC will contest claimants' alleged losses.

Bernard Madoff's 2008 confession to running a Ponzi scheme through Bernard L. Madoff Investment Securities LLC (BMIS) gave rise to a number of lawsuits against the Group. BMIS and the Fairfield funds (which invested in BMIS) are in bankruptcy and liquidation, respectively. Between 2010 and 2012, five lawsuits were brought against the Group by the BMIS bankruptcy trustee and the Fairfield funds' liquidators, in each case seeking to recover funds paid to the Group's clients pursuant to redemption requests made prior to BMIS' bankruptcy filing. The total amount sought in these cases exceeds $300 million, excluding any pre-judgement interest that may be awarded. Three of the four lawsuits commenced by the Fairfield funds' liquidators have been dismissed and the appeals of those dismissals by the funds' liquidators are ongoing. The fourth lawsuit has been dismissed and is not the subject of any further appeal. The Group continues to defend the lawsuit brought by the BMIS bankruptcy trustee.

A number of Korean banks, including Standard Chartered Bank Korea, sold equity-linked securities (ELS) to customers, the redemption values of which are determined by the performance of various stock indices. From January 2021 to May 2023 Standard Chartered Bank Korea sold relevant ELS to its customers with a notional value of approximately $900 million. Due to the performance of the Hang Seng China Enterprise Index, several thousand Standard Chartered Bank Korea customers have redeemed their ELS at a loss. Standard Chartered Bank Korea has offered compensation to impacted customers. Standard Chartered Bank Korea may also receive a regulatory penalty. A $100 million provision had been recognised at Q1 2024 with respect to anticipated losses, $24 million of which remains recorded on the Group's balance sheet at 30 June 2025.

In June 2025, a lawsuit was filed in the Singapore High Court against Standard Chartered Bank (Singapore) Limited, by three companies now in liquidation that had misappropriated funds from 1Malaysia Development Berhad (1MDB), seeking $2.7 billion. The companies allege, among other things, that Standard Chartered Singapore knew or ought to have known that these companies were engaged in the fraud on 1MDB at the time that Standard Chartered Singapore effected transfers instructed by these companies. The companies allege that in doing so, Standard Chartered Singapore breached its mandate and applicable duties. Standard Chartered Singapore had reported the transaction activities of these companies before it closed their accounts in early 2013. Standard Chartered denies any and all liability and will defend against this lawsuit.

- page 100 -


 

With the exception of the Korea ELS matter described above and certain other legal and regulatory matters for which provisions are recorded on the condensed consolidated interim balance sheet under Provisions for liabilities and charges as at 30 June 2025, the Group has concluded that the threshold for recording provisions pursuant to IAS 37 Provisions, Contingent Liabilities and Contingent Assets is not met with respect to the above matters; however, the outcomes of these matters are inherently uncertain and difficult to predict.

24. Subordinated liabilities and other borrowed funds


30.06.25

31.12.24

USD
$million

EUR
$million

GBP
$million

NPR
$million

Total
$million

USD
$million

EUR
$million

GBP
$million

NPR
$million

Total
$million

Fixed rate subordinated debt

6,685

1,142

934

17

8,778

7,510

2,008

846

18

10,382

Redemptions and repurchases during the period 2025

Standard Chartered PLC exercised its right to redeem $1 billion 3.516 per cent fixed rate reset subordinated debt due 2030 and EUR 1 billion 2.5 per cent fixed rate reset subordinated notes due 2030.

Redemptions and repurchases during the year 2024

Standard Chartered PLC exercised its right to redeem $1 billion 5.2 per cent subordinated notes 2024 and €500 million        3.125 per cent subordinated notes 2024.

Issuance during the period 2025

There was no issuance during the period.

Issuance during the year 2024

There was no issuance during the year.

25. Share capital, other equity instruments and reserves


Number of
ordinary shares
millions

Ordinary
share capital
1
$million

Ordinary
share premium
$million

Preference share capital and share premium2
$million

Total share capital and share premium
$million

Other equity instruments
$million

At 1 January 2024

2,665

1,332

3,989

1,494

6,815

5,512

Cancellation of shares including
share buyback

(113)

(57)

-

-

(57)

-

Additional Tier 1 equity issuance

-

-

-

-

-

992

At 30 June 2024

2,552

1,275

3,989

1,494

6,758

6,504

Cancellation of shares including
share buyback

(127)

(63)

-

-

(63)

-

Additional Tier 1 equity issuance

-

-

-

-

-

576

Additional Tier 1 redemption

-

-

-

-

-

(553)

Other movements3

-

-

-

-

-

(25)

At 31 December 2024

2,425

1,212

3,989

1,494

6,695

6,502

Cancellation of shares including
share buyback

(93)

(47)

-

-

(47)

-

Additional Tier 1 equity issuance

-

-

-

-

-

994

Other movements4

-

-

-

-

-

4

At 30 June 2025

2,332

1,165

3,989

1,494

6,648

7,500

1   Issued and fully paid ordinary shares of 50 cents each

2   Includes preference share capital of $75,000

3   Relates to realised translation loss on redemption of AT1 securities of SGD 750 million

4   Includes issuance cost



- page 101 -


 

Share buybacks

On 21 February 2025, the Group announced the buyback programme for a $1,500 million share buyback of its ordinary shares of $0.50 each. At H1 2025, the total number of shares purchased of 82,248,452 representing 3.41 per cent of the ordinary shares in issue at the beginning of the programme, for total consideration of $1,222 million, and a further $278 million relating to irrevocable obligation to buy back shares under the buyback programme has been recognised. The nominal value of the shares was transferred from the share capital to the capital redemption reserve account.

The shares were purchased by Standard Chartered PLC on various exchanges not including the Hong Kong Stock Exchange.


Number of
ordinary shares

Highest
price paid
£

Lowest
price paid
£

Average
price paid
per share
£

Aggregate
price paid
£

Aggregate
price paid
$

January 2025

 11,300,128

10.870

9.704

10.4133

 117,671,362

 145,286,293

February 2025

 3,395,890

12.725

11.790

12.3236

 41,849,427

 52,884,831

March 2025

 24,636,534

12.810

11.175

11.8745

 292,546,496

 377,784,647

April 2025

 19,971,649

11.545

8.728

10.1018

 201,750,555

 264,351,775

May 2025

 18,340,963

11.755

10.385

11.2137

 205,669,905

 274,781,456

June 2025

 15,903,416

12.200

11.160

11.6973

 186,026,636

 252,365,331

Ordinary share capital

In accordance with the Companies Act 2006, the Company does not have authorised share capital. The nominal value of each ordinary share is 50 cents.

During the period nil shares were issued under employee share plans.

Preference share capital

At 30 June 2025, the Company has 15,000 $5 non-cumulative redeemable preference shares in issue, with a premium of $99,995 making a paid-up amount per preference share of $100,000. The preference shares are redeemable at the option of the Company and are classified in equity.

The available profits of the Company are distributed to the holders of the issued preference shares in priority to payments made to holders of the ordinary shares and in priority to, or pari passu with, any payments to the holders of any other class of shares in issue. On a winding up, the assets of the Company are applied to the holders of the preference shares in priority to any payment to the ordinary shareholders and in priority to, or pari passu with, the holders of any other shares in issue, for an amount equal to any dividends payable (on approval of the Board) and the nominal value of the shares together with any premium as determined by the Board. The redeemable preference shares are redeemable at the paid-up amount (which includes premium) at the option of the Company in accordance with the terms of the shares. The holders of the preference shares are not entitled to attend or vote at any general meeting, except where any relevant dividend due is not paid in full or where a resolution is proposed varying the rights of the preference shares.

Other equity instruments

The table provides details of outstanding Fixed Rate Resetting Perpetual Subordinated Contingent Convertible AT1 securities issued by Standard Chartered PLC. All issuances are made for general business purposes and to increase the regulatory capital base of the Group.

Issuance date

Nominal value

Proceeds net of
issue costs

Interest rate1

Coupon payment dates2

First reset dates3

Conversion price per ordinary share5

26 June 2020

$1,000 million

$992 million

6%

26 January, 26 July

26 January 2026

$5.331

14 January 2021

$1,250 million

$1,239 million

4.75%

14 January, 14 July

14 July 2031

$6.353

19 August 2021

$1,500 million

$1,489 million

4.30%

19 February, 19 August

19 August 2028

$6.382

15 August 2022

$1,250 million

$1,239 million

7.75%

15 February, 15 August

15 February 2028

$7.333

08 March 2024

$1,000 million

$993 million

7.875%

8 March, 8 September

8 September 2030

$8.216

19 September 2024

SGD750 million

$579 million

5.300%

19 March, 19 September

19 March 2030

SGD12.929

16 January 2025

$1,000 million

$994 million

7.625%

16 January, 16 July

16 July 2032

$12.330


Total

$7,5254 million





1   Interest rates for the period from (and including) the issue date to (but excluding) the first reset date

2   Interest payable semi-annually in arrears

3   Securities are resettable each date falling five years, or an integral multiple of five years, after the first reset date

4   Excludes realised translation loss ($25 million) on redemption of AT1 securities on 3 October 2024 (SGD 750 million)

5   Conversion price set at the time of pricing with reference to closing share price and any applicable discount


- page 102 -


 

The AT1 issuances above are primarily purchased by institutional investors.

The principal terms of the AT1 securities are described below:

The securities are perpetual and redeemable, at the option of Standard Chartered PLC in whole but not in part, on the first interest reset date and each date falling five years after the first reset date.

The securities are also redeemable for certain regulatory or tax reasons on any date at 100 per cent of their principal amount together with any accrued but unpaid interest up to (but excluding) the date fixed for redemption. Any redemption is subject to Standard Chartered PLC giving notice to the relevant regulator and the regulator granting permission to redeem.

Interest payments on these securities will be accounted for as a dividend.

Interest on the securities is due and payable only at the sole and absolute discretion of Standard Chartered PLC, subject to certain additional restrictions set out in the terms and conditions. Accordingly, Standard Chartered PLC may at any time elect to cancel any interest payment (or part thereof) which would otherwise be payable on any interest payment date.

The securities convert into ordinary shares of Standard Chartered PLC, at a predetermined price detailed in the table above, should the fully loaded Common Equity Tier 1 ratio of the Group fall below 7.0 per cent. Approximately 1,051 million ordinary shares would be required to satisfy the conversion of all the securities mentioned above.

The securities rank behind the claims against Standard Chartered PLC of (a) unsubordinated creditors, (b) which are expressed to be subordinated to the claims of unsubordinated creditors of Standard Chartered PLC but not further or otherwise; or (c) which are, or are expressed to be, junior to the claims of other creditors of Standard Chartered PLC, whether subordinated or unsubordinated, other than claims which rank, or are expressed to rank, pari passu with, or junior to, the claims of holders of the AT1 securities in a winding-up occurring prior to the conversion trigger. The net proceeds of the issuances of AT1s are used for the general purposes of the Group.

Reserves

The constituents of the reserves are summarised as follows:

The capital reserve represents the exchange difference on redenomination of share capital and share premium from sterling to US dollars in 2001. The capital redemption reserve represents the nominal value of preference shares redeemed.

The amounts in the Capital and Merger Reserve represent the premium arising on shares issued using a cash box financing structure, which required the Company to create a merger reserve under section 612 of the Companies Act 2006. Shares were issued using this structure in 2005 and 2006 to assist in the funding of Korea ($1.9 billion) and Taiwan ($1.2 billion) acquisitions, in 2008, 2010 and 2015 for the shares issued by way of a rights issue, primarily for capital maintenance requirements and for the shares issued in 2009 by way of an accelerated book build, the proceeds of which were used in the ordinary course of business of the Group. The funding raised by the 2008, 2010 and 2015 rights issues and 2009 share issue was fully retained within the Company. Of the 2015 funding, $1.5 billion was used to subscribe to additional equity in Standard Chartered Bank, a wholly owned subsidiary of the Company. Apart from the Korea, Taiwan and Standard Chartered Bank funding, the merger reserve is considered realised and distributable.

Own credit adjustment (OCA) reserve represents the cumulative gains and losses on financial liabilities designated at fair value through profit or loss relating to own credit. Gains and losses on financial liabilities designated at fair value through profit or loss relating to own credit in the year have been taken through other comprehensive income into this reserve. On derecognition of applicable instruments the balance of any OCA will not be recycled to the income statement, but will be transferred within equity to retained earnings.

Fair value through other comprehensive income (FVOCI) debt reserve represents the unrealised fair value gains and losses in respect of financial assets classified as FVOCI, net of expected credit losses and taxation. Gains and losses are deferred in this reserve and are reclassified to the income statement when the underlying asset is sold, matures or becomes impaired.

FVOCI equity reserve represents unrealised fair value gains and losses in respect of financial assets classified as FVOCI, net of taxation. Gains and losses are recorded in this reserve and never recycled to the income statement



 

Cash flow hedge reserve represents the effective portion of the gains and losses on derivatives that meet the criteria for these types of hedges. Gains and losses are deferred in this reserve and are reclassified to the income statement when the underlying hedged item affects profit and loss or when a forecast transaction is no longer expected to occur.

- page 103 -


Translation reserve represents the cumulative foreign exchange gains and losses on translation of the net investment of the Group in foreign operations. Since 1 January 2004, gains and losses are deferred to this reserve and are reclassified to the income statement when the underlying foreign operation is disposed. Gains and losses arising from derivatives used as hedges of net investments are netted against the foreign exchange gains and losses on translation of the net investment of the foreign operations.

Retained earnings represents profits and other comprehensive income earned by the Group and Company in the current and prior periods, together with the after tax increase relating to equity-settled share options, less dividend distributions, own shares held (treasury shares) and share buybacks.

A substantial part of the Group's reserves is held in overseas subsidiary undertakings and branches, principally to support local operations or to comply with local regulations. The maintenance of local regulatory capital ratios could potentially restrict the amount of reserves which can be remitted. In addition, if these overseas reserves were to be remitted, further unprovided taxation liabilities might arise.

As at 30 June 2025, the distributable reserves of Standard Chartered PLC (the Company) were $13.9 billion (31 December 2024: $14.1 billion). Distributable reserves of SC PLC are calculated from the Merger reserve and Retained Earnings with consideration for restricted items in line with sections 830 and 831 of the Companies Act 2006.

Own shares

The 2004 Employee Benefit Trust (2004 Trust) is used in conjunction with the Group's employee share schemes and other employee share-based payments (such as upfront shares and salary shares). Computershare Trustees (Jersey) Limited is the trustee of the 2004 Trust. Group companies fund the 2004 Trust from time to time to enable the trustee to acquire ordinary shares in Standard Chartered PLC to satisfy these arrangements.

Details of the shares purchased and held by the 2004 Trust are set out below.


2004 Trust

30.06.25

31.12.24

30.06.24

Shares purchased during the period

8,765,965

19,604,557

40,707

Market price of shares purchased ($million)

137.45

223

0.35

Shares held at the end of the period

1,799,177

17,589,987

1,863,677

Maximum number of shares held during the period

25,082,882

28,085,688

28,085,688

Except as disclosed, neither the Company nor any of its subsidiaries has bought, sold or redeemed any securities of the Company listed on The Stock Exchange of Hong Kong Limited during the period.

Dividend waivers

The trustees of the 2004 Trust, which holds ordinary shares in Standard Chartered PLC in connection with the operation of its employee share plans, waive any dividend on the balance of ordinary shares that have not been allocated to employees, except for 0.01p per share.

26. Related party transactions

Directors and officers

As at 30 June 2025, Standard Chartered Bank had in place a charge over $67 million (31 December 2024: $68 million) of cash assets in favour of the independent trustee of its employer financed retirement benefit scheme.

There were no changes in the related party transactions described in the Annual Report 2024 that could have or have had a material effect on the financial position or performance of the Group in the period ended 30 June 2025. All related party transactions that have taken place in the period were similar in nature to those disclosed in the Annual Report 2024.

Associate and joint ventures

The following transactions with related parties are on an arm's length basis:


30.06.25
$million

31.12.24
$million

Assets



Derivative assets

9

5

Total assets

9

5

Liabilities



Deposits

380

209

Derivative liabilities

3

4

Total liabilities

383

213

Loan commitments and other guarantees¹

108

14

1   The maximum loan commitments and other guarantees during the period were $108 million (31 December 2024: $14 million)

- page 104 -


 

27. Post balance sheet events

A share buyback for up to a maximum consideration of $1.3 billion has been declared by the directors after 30 June 2025. This will reduce the number of ordinary shares in issue by cancelling the repurchased shares.

The Board has recommended an interim ordinary dividend for the half year 2025 of 12.3 cents a share or $288 million.

On 26 July 2025, Standard Chartered PLC redeemed its $1.0 billion 6.00% Resetting Perpetual Subordinated Contingent Convertible Securities in full at 100 per cent. of their principal amount together with any accrued interest.

28. Corporate governance

The directors confirm that, throughout the period, the Company has complied with the code provisions set out in the Corporate Governance Code contained in Appendix C1 of the Hong Kong Listing Rules. The directors also confirm that the announcement of these results has been reviewed by the Company's Audit Committee. The Company confirms that it has adopted a code of conduct regarding securities transactions by directors on terms no less exacting than the required standard set out in Appendix C3 of the Hong Kong Listing Rules and that, having made specific enquiry of all directors, the directors of the Company have complied with the required standards of the adopted code of conduct throughout the period. Details of the Group's corporate governance arrangements are set out in the Directors' Report within the 2024 Annual Report.

As previously announced, the following changes to the composition of the Board have taken place since 31 December 2024.

On 1 January 2025, Diane Jurgens and Jackie Hunt joined the Board Risk Committee, David Tang stepped down from the Board Risk Committee, and David and Jackie joined the Remuneration Committee.

On 8 May 2025, Maria Ramos commenced her role as Group Chair and Chair of the Governance and Nomination Committee, with José Viñals stepping down from the Board. Consequently, Maria stepped down as Senior Independent Director, Chair of the Board Risk Committee and as a member of the Audit and Remuneration Committees. Maria has a contract for services with the Company and will receive a fee of £1,293,000 per annum for her services as Group Chair with effect from 8 May 2025.

With effect from the same date, Phil Rivett, was appointed Chair of the Board Risk Committee, subject to regulatory approval, and assumed the role immediately on an interim basis. He was also appointed as Senior Independent Director and succeeds Maria in both roles. Jackie was appointed as Chair of the Audit Committee, subject to regulatory approval. Phil remains Chair of the Audit Committee ahead of Jackie receiving regulatory approval to assume that role. Jackie was also appointed to the Governance and Nomination Committee.

In compliance with Rule 13.51B(1) of the Hong Kong Listing Rules, the Company confirms that, effective 30 April 2025, Bill Winters was appointed to the board of Stripe Inc as a non-executive director after retiring as a non-executive director of Novartis International AG on 6 March 2025. Maria Ramos retired as a non-executive director on the board of Compagnie Financière Richemont SA on 31 March 2025. As announced on 26 February 2025, Robin Lawther will join the Board of Intermediate Capital Group plc as a non-executive director on 1 November 2025.

Biographies for each of the directors and a list of the committees' membership can be found at www.sc.com/ourpeople.

29. Statutory accounts

The information in this Half Year Report is unaudited and does not constitute statutory accounts within the meaning of section 434 of the Companies Act 2006. This document was approved by the Board on 31 July 2025. The statutory accounts for the year ended 31 December 2024 have been audited and delivered to the Registrar of Companies in England and Wales. The report of the auditors was (i) unqualified, (ii) did not include a reference to any matters to which the auditors drew attention by way of emphasis without qualifying their report, and (iii) did not contain a statement under sections 498(2) and 498(3) of the Companies Act 2006.



- page 105 -


 

30. Cash flow statement

Adjustment for non-cash items and other adjustments included within income statement


30.06.25
$million

30.06.24
$million

Amortisation of discounts and premiums of investment securities

(700)

249

Interest expense on subordinated liabilities

302

394

Interest expense on senior debt securities in issue

1,216

1,291

Pension costs for defined benefit schemes

30

27

Share-based payment costs

206

172

Impairment losses on loans and advances and other credit risk provisions

336

240

Other impairment

19

147

Gain on disposal of property, plant and equipment

(6)

(13)

(Gains)/loss on disposal of FVOCI and Actively Managed Certificate financial assets

(2)

86

(Gains)/loss on disposal of business1

(242)

169

Depreciation and amortisation

544

516

Fair value changes taken to income statement

(1,085)

(1,034)

Foreign currency revaluation

207

(110)

Profit from associates and joint ventures

(79)

(144)

Movement in fair value hedges on FVOCI assets1

(5)

(191)

Other non-cash items1

(52)

(69)

Total

689

1,730

1   (Gains)/loss on disposal of business and Movement in fair value hedges on FVOCI assets previously reported within Other non-cash items have been re-presented as separate items

Change in operating assets


30.06.25
$million

30.06.24
$million

Net decrease in derivative financial instruments

18,128

1,370

Net increase in debt securities, treasury bills and equity shares held at fair value through profit or loss

(13,673)

(25,183)

Net increase in loans and advances to banks and customers

(6,856)

(9,614)

Net decrease/(increase) in prepayments and accrued income

189

(227)

Net increase in other assets

(26,081)

(7,928)

Total

(28,293)

(41,582)

Change in operating liabilities


30.06.25
$million

30.06.24
$million

Net decrease in derivative financial instruments

(13,117)

(5,059)

Net increase in deposits from banks, customer accounts, debt securities in issue, Hong Kong notes in circulation and short positions

62,397

17,512

Net decrease in accruals and deferred income

(751)

(380)

Net increase in other liabilities

1,651

8,393

Total

50,180

20,466

 



- page 106 -


 

Changes in financing activities - subordinated and senior debts


30.06.25
$million

30.06.24
$million

Subordinated debt (including accrued interest):



Opening balance

10,536

12,216

Interest paid

(247)

(252)

Repayment

(2,175)

(1,000)

Foreign exchange movements

365

(91)

Fair value hedge adjustments

202

(92)

Accrued interest and others

221

244

Closing balance

8,902

11,025




Senior debt (including accrued interest):



Opening balance

40,576

41,350

Proceeds from the issue

7,953

7,698

Interest paid

(1,678)

(548)

Repayment

(7,040)

(7,191)

Foreign exchange movements

914

(292)

Fair value hedge adjustments

275

(92)

Accrued interest and others

1,617

1,612

Closing balance

42,617

42,537

Senior debt is presented as part of debt securities in issue in the condensed consolidated interim balance sheet.



- page 107 -


 

Other supplementary information

Supplementary financial information

Insured and uninsured deposits

The Group operates and provides services to customers across many countries and insured deposit is determined on the basis of limits enacted within local regulations.


30.06.25

31.12.24

Insured deposits

Uninsured deposits

Total
$million

Insured deposits

Uninsured deposits

Total
$million

Bank deposits
$million

Customer accounts
$million

Bank deposits
$million

Customer accounts
$million

Bank deposits
$million

Customer accounts
$million

Bank deposits
$million

Customer accounts
$million

Current accounts

10

18,339

25,043

168,286

211,678

8

15,596

19,844

152,101

187,549

Savings deposits

-

34,549

-

98,419

132,968

-

31,977

-

86,579

118,556

Time deposits

29

32,486

7,229

189,415

229,159

-

28,417

6,717

170,752

205,886

Other deposits

-

112

9,978

40,526

50,616

-

104

9,393

37,737

47,234

Total

39

85,486

42,250

496,646

624,421

8

76,094

35,954

447,169

559,225

UK and non-UK deposits

The following table summarises the split of Bank and Customer deposits into UK and Non-UK deposits for respective account lines based on the domicile or residence of the clients.


30.06.25

31.12.24

UK deposits

Non-UK deposits

Total
$million

UK deposits

Non-UK deposits

Total
$million

Bank deposits
$million

Customer accounts
$million

Bank deposits
$million

Customer accounts
$million

Bank deposits
$million

Customer accounts
$million

Bank deposits
$million

Customer accounts
$million

Current accounts

554

8,348

24,499

178,277

211,678

544

7,734

19,308

159,963

187,549

Savings deposits

-

301

-

132,667

132,968

-

145

-

118,411

118,556

Time deposits

516

8,650

6,742

213,251

229,159

315

7,731

6,402

191,438

205,886

Other deposits

2,262

11,437

7,716

29,201

50,616

2,342

12,744

7,051

25,097

47,234

Total

3,332

28,736

38,957

553,396

624,421

3,201

28,354

32,761

494,909

559,225

Contractual maturity of Loans, Investment securities and Deposits


30.06.25

Loans and advances
to banks
$million

Loans and advances to customers
$million

Investment securities - treasury and other eligible bills
$million

Investment securities - Debt securities
$million

Investment securities - Equity shares
$million

Bank deposits
$million

Customer accounts
$million

One year or less

64,441

178,323

52,942

46,771

-

35,416

520,025

Between one and five years

13,108

71,408

19

86,009

-

6,870

58,782

Between five and ten years

1,645

22,390

-

27,935

-

2

1,487

Between ten years and fifteen years

59

13,369

-

5,450

-

-

1,216

More than fifteen years and undated

91

65,128

-

31,720

8,420

-

623

Total

79,344

350,618

52,961

197,885

8,420

42,288

582,133









Total amortised cost and FVOCI exposures

42,386

286,731






Of which: Fixed interest rate exposures

35,638

151,270






Of which: Floating interest rate exposures

6,748

135,461






- page 108 -


 



 


31.12.24

Loans and advances to banks
$million

Loans and advances to customers $million

Investment securities - treasury and other eligible bills
$million

Investment securities - Debt securities
$million

Investment securities - Equity shares
$million

Bank deposits
$million

Customer accounts
$million

One year or less

66,448

181,863

41,966

47,959

-

29,678

463,566

Between one and five years

12,122

63,006

41

74,197

-

6,281

57,062

Between five and ten years

1,680

21,139

-

23,319

-

3

849

Between ten years and fifteen years

71

13,236

-

5,876

-

-

1,217

More than fifteen years and undated

239

60,313

-

26,743

6,480

-

569

Total

80,560

339,557

42,007

178,094

6,480

35,962

523,263









Total amortised cost and FVOCI exposures

43,593

281,032






Of which: Fixed interest rate exposures

35,383

153,575






Of which: Floating interest rate exposures

8,210

127,457






Maturity and yield of debt securities, additional tier one and other eligible bills held at amortised cost


One year or less

Between one and
five years

Between five and
ten years

More than ten years

Total

$million

Yield
%

$million

Yield
%

$million

Yield
%

$million

Yield
%

$million

Yield
%

Central and other government agencies











- US

2,096

1.42

9,055

1.91

5,800

1.73

4,267

2.62

21,218

1.95

- UK

77

0.50

618

2.06

49

0.88

-

-

744

1.82

- Other

4,719

2.63

9,457

2.69

3,350

3.04

36

6.77

17,562

2.75

Other debt securities

1,420

6.90

2,376

6.09

6,460

4.83

5,430

5.14

15,686

5.32

At 30 June 2025

8,312

3.03

21,506

2.72

15,659

3.28

9,733

4.04

55,210

3.16

 


One year or less

Between one and
five years

Between five and
ten years

More than ten years

Total

$million

Yield
%

$million

Yield
%

$million

Yield
%

$million

Yield
%

$million

Yield
%

Central and other government agencies











- US

1,864

1.53

9,607

1.98

5,187

1.88

4,353

2.76

21,011

2.08

- UK

192

1.70

684

2.07

44

0.88

-

-

920

1.93

- Other

3,081

3.20

11,454

3.39

2,932

3.93

25

7.55

17,492

3.46

Other debt securities

1,687

6.21

2,676

6.30

4,620

4.86

6,731

5.41

15,714

5.49

At 31 December 2024

6,824

3.45

24,421

3.12

12,783

3.42

11,109

4.38

55,137

3.48

The maturity distributions are presented in the above table on the basis of contractual maturity dates. The weighted average yield for each range of maturities is calculated by dividing the annualised interest income for the year by the book amount of debt securities at that date.

Average balance sheets and yields

Average balance sheets and yields

For the purposes of calculating net interest margin, the following adjustments are made:

reported net interest income is adjusted to remove interest expense on amortised cost liabilities used to provide funding to the Global Markets business

financial instruments measured at fair value through profit or loss are classified as non-interest earning

premiums on financial guarantees purchased to manage interest-earning assets are treated as interest expense. In the Group's view, this results in a net interest margin that is more reflective of banking book performance.

The following tables set out the average balances and yields for the Group's assets and liabilities for the periods ended 30 June 2025 and 30 June 2024 under the revised definition of net interest margin. For the purpose of these tables, average balances have been determined on the basis of daily balances, except for certain categories, for which balances have been determined less frequently. The Group does not believe that the information presented in these tables would be significantly different had such balances been determined on a daily basis.

- page 109 -


 

Average assets


6 months ended 30.06.25

Average non-interest- earning balance
$million

Average
interest- earning balance
$million

Interest income
$million

Gross yield
interest-earning balance
%

Gross yield
total balance
%

Cash and balances at central banks

10,239

57,677

1,036

3.62

3.08

Gross loans and advances to banks

44,580

46,672

1,109

4.79

2.45

Gross loans and advances to customers

70,108

288,614

7,276

5.08

4.09

Impairment provisions against loans and advances to banks and customers

-

(5,300)

-

-

-

Investment securities - treasury and other eligible bills

22,343

27,494

621

4.55

2.51

Investment securities - debt securities

70,219

126,228

2,443

3.90

2.51

Investment securities - equity shares

6,817

-

-

-

-

Property, plant and equipment and intangible assets

6,239

-

-

-

-

Prepayments, accrued income and other assets

140,721

-

-

-

-

Investment associates and joint ventures

1,065

-

-

-

-

Total average assets

372,331

541,385

12,485

4.65

2.76

Adjustment for trading book funding cost and others



256



Total average assets

372,331

541,385

12,741

4.75

2.81

 


6 months ended 30.06.24

Average non-interest earning balance
$million

Average
interest- earning balance
$million

Interest income
$million

Gross yield interest- earning balance
%

Gross yield
total balance
%

Cash and balances at central banks

10,244

59,865

1,360

4.57

3.90

Gross loans and advances to banks

39,425

41,801

1,052

5.06

2.60

Gross loans and advances to customers

56,445

285,940

8,259

5.81

4.85

Impairment provisions against loans and advances to banks and customers

-

(5,501)

-

-

-

Investment securities - treasury and other eligible bills

13,364

28,990

807

5.60

3.83

Investment securities - debt securities

53,058

132,693

2,716

4.12

2.94

Investment securities - equity shares

4,545

-

-

-

-

Property, plant and equipment and intangible assets

6,263

-

-

-

-

Prepayments, accrued income and other assets

120,866

-

-

-

-

Investment associates and joint ventures

1,052

-

-

-

-

Total average assets

305,262

543,788

14,194

5.25

3.36

Adjustment for trading book funding cost and others



371



Total average assets

305,262

543,788

14,565

5.39

3.45

Average liabilities


6 months ended 30.06.25

Average non-interest bearing balance
$million

Average
interest-bearing balance
$million

Interest
expense
$million

Rate paid interest-bearing balance
%

Rate paid
total balance
%

Deposits by banks

17,730

22,344

326

2.94

1.64

Customer accounts:






Current accounts

42,054

137,384

1,945

2.85

2.19

Savings deposits

-

122,554

875

1.44

1.44

Time deposits

20,779

191,578

4,083

4.30

3.88

Other deposits

39,189

7,154

150

4.23

0.65

Debt securities in issue

12,153

71,832

1,727

4.85

4.15

Accruals, deferred income and other liabilities

166,756

1,303

33

5.11

0.04

Subordinated liabilities and other borrowed funds

-

9,907

302

6.15

6.15

Non-controlling interests

389

-

-

-

-

Shareholders' funds

50,610

-

-

-

-


349,660

564,056

9,441

3.38

2.08

Adjustment for trading book funding cost and others



(2,199)



Total average liabilities and shareholders' funds

349,660

564,056

7,242

2.59

1.60

 



- page 110 -


 


6 months ended 30.06.24

Average non-interest bearing balance
$million

Average
interest-bearing balance
$million

Interest
expense
$million

Rate paid interest-bearing balance
%

Rate paid
total balance
%

Deposits by banks

15,374

21,300

441

4.16

2.42

Customer accounts:






Current accounts

39,666

128,079

2,245

3.52

2.69

Savings deposits

0

113,627

1,204

2.13

2.13

Time deposits

19,131

186,811

4,642

5.00

4.53

Other deposits

36,403

11,734

299

5.12

1.25

Debt securities in issue

11,642

64,678

1,794

5.58

4.73

Accruals, deferred income and other liabilities

138,565

0

0

-

-

Subordinated liabilities and other borrowed funds

0

11,379

394

6.96

6.96

Non-controlling interests

389

0

0

-

-

Shareholders' funds

50,272

0

0

-

-


311,442

537,608

11,019

4.12

2.61

Adjustment for trading book funding cost and others



(1,816)



Total average liabilities and shareholders' funds

311,442

537,608

9,203

3.44

2.18

Net interest margin


6 months ended 30.06.25
$million

6 months ended 30.06.24
$million

Interest income (reported)

12,485

14,194

Adjustment for trading book funding cost and others1

256

 371

Interest income adjusted for trading book funding cost and others

12,741

14,565

Average interest-earning assets

541,385

543,788

Gross yield (%)

4.75

5.39




Interest expense (reported)

9,441

11,019

Adjustment for trading book funding cost and others

(2,199)

(1,816)

Interest expense adjusted for trading book funding cost and others

7,242

9,203

Average interest-bearing liabilities

564,056

537,608

Rate paid (%)

2.59

3.44

Net yield (%)

2.16

1.95




Adjusted net interest income1

5,499

5,362

Net interest margin (%)

2.05

1.98

1   Adjusted net interest income has been re-presented in line with the RNS on Re-Presentation of Financial Information issued on 2 April 2025 to reflect the reclassification of funding cost mismatches to non-net interest income (non NI)I. Adjusted NIL is reported NIL less trading book funding cost, treasury currency management activities, cash collateral and prime service



- page 111 -


 

Additional items

A. Our Fair Pay Charter

Our Fair Pay Charter brings all People Leaders and colleagues to a shared understanding of our fundamental principles around reward which are key considerations in our decision-making. The four focus areas in the Charter - Equal pay; Purpose-led; Competitive opportunities; Performance-driven - drive our remuneration policies and processes, ensuring equity and transparency are at the forefront of decision-making, and that sustainable high performance, delivered in line with our valued behaviours, is recognised and rewarded appropriately. Our 2024 Diversity, Equality and Inclusion Impact Report gives further detail on our Fair Pay Charter and is available on our Group website.

B. Group share plans

Discretionary share plans

The 2021 Standard Chartered Share Plan (the 2021 Plan) was approved by shareholders in May 2021 and is the Group's main share plan, replacing the 2011 Standard Chartered Share Plan (the 2011 Plan) for new awards from June 2021. It is used to deliver various types of share awards to employees and former employees of the Group, including directors and former executive directors:

Award type

Description and performance measures

Long-Term Incentive Plan (LTIP) awards

Long-Term Incentive Plan (LTIP) awards are granted with a vesting period of between three to seven years (with a further 12 month retention period post vesting), subject to performance measures which have previously included:

•  relative total shareholder return (TSR);

•  return on tangible equity (RoTE) (with a Common Equity Tier 1 (CET1) underpin); and

•  strategic measures (including targets set for sustainability linked to business strategy)

Each measure is assessed independently over a three-year period. All LTIP awards have an individual conduct gateway requirement that results in the award lapsing if not met, and the outcome of LTIP awards granted from 2025 onwards are subject to a risk and control modifier.

Deferred shares

Used to deliver:

•  the deferred portion of year-end variable remuneration, in line with both market practice and regulatory requirements. These awards vest in instalments on anniversaries of the award date specified at the time of grant. This enables the Group to meet regulatory requirements relating to deferral levels, and is in line with market practice.

•  replacement buyout awards to new joiners who forfeit awards on leaving their previous employers. These vest in the quarter most closely following the date when the award would have vested at the previous employer. This enables the Group to meet regulatory requirements relating to buyouts, and is in line with market practice.

Deferred share awards have various vesting periods and are not subject to any performance measures.

Under the 2021 Plan and 2011 Plan, no grant price is payable to receive an award. The remaining life of the 2021 Plan during which new awards can be made is six years. The 2011 Plan has expired and no further awards can be granted under this plan.

All employee share plans

The Standard Chartered 2023 Sharesave Plan was approved by shareholders in May 2023, replacing the Standard Chartered 2013 Sharesave Plan. Under the 2023 Sharesave Plan, employees may open a savings contract. Within a maturity period of six months after the third anniversary, employees may purchase ordinary shares in the Company at a discount of up to 20 per cent on the share price at the date of invitation. The vesting period of the Sharesave options is three years. There are no performance measures attached to options granted under the 2023 Sharesave Plan and no grant price is payable to receive an option.

In some countries in which the Group operates, it is not possible to deliver shares under the 2023 Sharesave Plan, typically due to securities laws and regulatory restrictions. In these countries, where possible, the Group offers an equivalent cash-based plan to its employees.

Valuation of share awards

Details of the valuation models used in determining the fair values of share awards granted under the Group's share plans are detailed in the Group's 2024 Annual Report.



- page 112 -


 

Information on options and awards granted and available for grant under our share plans

As at 1 January 2025 and 30 June 2025, the share awards outstanding under our discretionary and Sharesave plans adopted by Standard Chartered PLC and its subsidiaries represented 5.1 per cent and 5.3 per cent of the issued ordinary share capital of Standard Chartered PLC respectively. Accordingly, the number of Standard Chartered PLC shares available to be granted under all discretionary and Sharesave plans at the beginning and the end of the period were 123,504,051 and 124,710,668 respectively.

The maximum number of Standard Chartered PLC shares that may be issued in respect of share options and awards granted under the discretionary and Sharesave plans during the period divided by the weighted average number of Standard Chartered PLC shares in issue at the end of the period is 0.7 per cent.

Reconciliation of share award movements for the year to 30th June 2025


LTIP1

Deferred/Buy-out
awards
1

Sharesave5

Weighted average Sharesave exercise price
(£)

Outstanding on 1 January 2025

9,640,693

51,693,726

20,565,111

5.48

Granted2,3,4

2,159,737

15,012,117

-

-

Lapsed6

(324,419)

(286,441)

(568,281)

5.61

Vested/Exercised

(1,272,072)

(19,184,061)

(1,138,037)

3.77

Outstanding on 30 June 2025

10,203,939

47,235,341

18,858,793

5.57

Total number of securities available for issue under the plan

 10,203,939

 47,235,341

 18,858,793

5.57

Percentage of the issued shares this represents as of 30 June 2025

0.44

 2.03

 0.81

Exercisable as of 30 June 2025

-

102,277

60,887

5.18

Range of exercise prices (£)

-

-

3.67 - 6.10


Intrinsic value of vested but not exercised options ($ million)

0.00

1.69

0.58


Weighted average contractual remaining life (years)

7.65

8.42

2.20


Weighted average share price for awards exercised during the period (£)

11.78

 11.54

 11.17


1   Granted under the 2021 Plan and 2011 Plan. Employees do not contribute to the cost of these awards

2   2,159,737 (LTIP) granted on 12 May 2025. The closing price of the shares immediately before the date on which the awards were granted was £10.675

3   14,537,101 (Deferred shares) granted on 14 March 2025. The closing price of the shares immediately before the date on which the awards were granted was £11.58. 141,397 (Deferred shares) notional dividend uplift on 27 March 2025. 333,619 (Deferred shares) granted on 12 May 2025. The closing price of the shares immediately before the date on which the awards were granted was £10.675

4   No discretionary awards (LTIP or deferred/buy-out awards) have been granted in the form of options since June 2015. For historic awards granted as options and exercised in the period to 30 June 2025, the exercise price of deferred/ Buy-out shares options was nil

5   All Sharesave awards are in the form of options. The exercise price of Sharesave options exercised was £ 6.10 for options granted in 2024, £ 5.88 for options granted in 2023, £4.23 for options granted in 2022 and £3.67 for options granted in 2021

6   No options or share awards were cancelled in the period

C. Group Chair and independent non-executive directors' interests in ordinary shares at 30 June 20251,2


Shares beneficially
held as of
31 December 2024

Shares beneficially
held as of
30 June
2025

Chair



M Ramos3

2,000

2,000

Independent non-executive directors



S M Apte

2,000

2,000

J Hunt

2,000

2,000

D E Jurgens

8,888

8,888

R A Lawther, CBE

2,000

2,000

L Leong

13,369

13,369

P G Rivett

2,128

2,128

D Tang

2,000

2,000

J Viñals4

45,000

-

L Y Yueh, CBE

2,000

2,000

1   Independent non-executive directors are required to hold shares with a nominal value of $1,000. All the directors have met this requirement

2   The beneficial interests of directors and their related parties in the ordinary shares of the Company are set out above. The directors do not have any non-beneficial interests in the Company's shares. None of the directors used ordinary shares as collateral for any loans. No director had either i) an interest in the Company's preference shares or loan stocks of any subsidiary or associated undertaking of the Group or ii) any corporate interests in the Company's ordinary shares. All figures as of 30 June 2025

3   Maria Ramos was appointed as Group Chair on 8 May 2025

4   J Viñals retired from the Board on 8 May 2025



- page 113 -


 

D. Executive directors' interests in ordinary shares at 30 June 2025

Scheme interests awarded, exercised and lapsed during the period

Employees, including executive directors, are not permitted to engage in any personal investment strategies with regards to their Company shares, including hedging against the share price of Company shares. The main features of the outstanding shares and long-term incentive plan (LTIP) awards are summarised below:

LTIP award1

Performance measures

Performance outcome

2018-2020

33% Return on equity (RoE)

33% Relative TSR

33% Strategic

26%

2019-2021

23%

2020-2022

36.8%

2021-2023

57%

2022-2024

88%

2023-2025

To be assessed at the end of 2025

2024-2026

30% RoTE

30% Relative TSR

25% Environmental, Social and
Governance (ESG)

15% Other strategic

To be assessed at the end of 2026

2025-2027

40% RoTE

40% Relative TSR

20% Sustainability

To be assessed at the end of 2027

1   LTIP awards are delivered in five equal tranches



- page 114 -


 

The following table shows the changes in share interests.


Date of grant

Changes in interests from 1 January to 30 June 2025

Share award price (£)

At
1 January

Awarded1,2

Vested3

Lapsed

At
30 June

Performance
period end

Vesting date

Bill Winters1










2018-2020 LTIP

9 Mar 2018

7.782

28,179

-

28,179

-

-

9 Mar 2021

9 Mar 2025

2019-2021 LTIP

11 Mar 2019

6.105

30,604

-

30,604

-

-

11 Mar 2022

11 Mar 2025




30,605

-

-

-

30,605


11 Mar 2026

2020-2022 LTIP

9 Mar 2020

5.196

59,282

-

59,282

-

-

9 Mar 2023

9 Mar 2025




59,282

-

-

-

59,282


9 Mar 2026




59,282

-

-

-

59,282


9 Mar 2027

2021-2023 LTIP

15 Mar 2021

4.901

85,853

-

85,853

-


15 Mar 2024

15 Mar 2025




85,853

-

-

-

85,853


15 Mar 2026




85,853

-

-

-

85,853


15 Mar 2027




85,853

-

-

-

85,853


15 Mar 2028

2022-2024 LTIP

14 Mar 2022

4.876

151,386

-

133,219

18,167


14 Mar 2025

14 Mar 2025




151,386

-

-

18,167

133,219


14 Mar 2026




151,386

-

-

18,167

133,219


14 Mar 2027




151,386

-

-

18,167

133,219


14 Mar 2028




151,388

-

-

18,167

133,221


14 Mar 2029

2023-2025 LTIP

13 Mar 2023

7.398

101,209

-

-

-

101,209

13 Mar 2026

13 Mar 2026




101,209

-

-

-

101,209


13 Mar 2027




101,209

-

-

-

101,209


13 Mar 2028




101,209

-

-

-

101,209


13 Mar 2029




101,209

-

-

-

101,209


13 Mar 2030

2024-2026 LTIP

12 Mar 2024

6.600

123,275

-

-

-

123,275

12 Mar 2027

12 Mar 2027




123,275

-

-

-

123,275


12 Mar 2028




123,275

-

-

-

123,275


12 Mar 2029




123,275

-

-

-

123,275


12 Mar 2030




123,278

-

-

-

123,278


12 Mar 2031

2025-2027 LTIP

12 May 2025

10.675

-

163,242

-

-

163,242

31 Dec 2027

12 May 2028




-

163,242

-

-

163,242


12 May 2029




-

163,242

-

-

163,242


12 May 2030




-

163,242

-

-

163,242


12 May 2031




-

163,245

-

-

163,245


12 May 2032

Diego De Giorgi1










2024-2026 LTIP

12 Mar 2024

6.600

80,812

-

-

-

80,812

12 Mar 2027

12 Mar 2027




80,812

-

-

-

80,812


12 Mar 2028




80,812

-

-

-

80,812


12 Mar 2029




80,812

-

-

-

80,812


12 Mar 2030




80,814

-

-

-

80,814


 12 Mar 2031

2025-2027 LTIP

12 May 2025

10.675

-

90,394

-

-

90,394

31 Dec 2027

12 May 2028




-

90,394

-

-

90,394


12 May 2029




-

90,394

-

-

90,394


12 May 2030




-

90,394

-

-

90,394


12 May 2031




-

90,395

-

-

90,395


12 May 2032

1   The unvested LTIP awards held by Bill and Diego are conditional rights. They do not have to pay towards these awards. Under these awards, shares are delivered on vesting or as soon as practicable thereafter

2   For the 2025-2027 LTIP awards granted to Bill and Diego on 12 May 2025, the values granted were: Bill: £7.4 million; Diego: £4.1 million. The number of shares awarded in respect of the LTIP took into account the lack of dividend equivalents (calculated by reference to market consensus dividend yield) such that the overall value of the award was maintained. Performance measures apply to 2025-2027 LTIP awards. The closing price on the day before grant was £10.675

3   Shares (before tax) were delivered to Bill from the vesting element of LTIP awards. The closing share price on the day before the shares were delivered were as follows:

•   10 March 2025: Shares in respect of the 2018-2020 LTIP and 2020-2022 LTIP. Previous day closing share price: £12.150

•   11 March 2025: Shares in respect of the 2019-2021 LTIP. Previous day closing share price: £11.705

•   17 March 2025: Shares in respect of the 2021-2023 LTIP. Previous day closing share price: £11.765

•   19 March 2025: Shares in respect of the 2022-2024 LTIP. Previous day closing share price: £12.060

4   The weighted average closing price for Bill's awards that vested during the period was £11.976

At 30 June 2025, none of the directors had registered an interest or short position in the shares, underlying shares or debentures of the Company or any of its associated corporations that was required to be recorded pursuant to section 352 of the Securities and Futures Ordinance, or as otherwise notified to the Company and the Hong Kong Stock Exchange pursuant to the Model Code for Securities Transactions by Directors of Listed Issuers.

- page 115 -


 

Shareholdings and share interests

The following table summarises the executive directors' shareholdings and share interests.


Shares held beneficially1,2,3

Unvested share awards not subject to performance measures
(net of tax)
4,5

Total shares counting towards shareholding requirement

Shareholding requirement

Salary3

Value of shares counting towards shareholding requirement as a percentage
of salary
1

Unvested share awards subject to performance measures (before tax)

Bill Winters

3,180,013

497,989

 3,678,002

500% salary

£1,500,000

2,960%

 1,938,636

Diego De Giorgi

100,908

-

 100,908

400% salary

£1,100,000

111%

 856,033

1   All figures are as of 30 June 2025 unless stated otherwise. The closing share price on 30 June 2025 was £12.07. No director had either: (i) an interest in Standard Chartered PLC's preference shares or loan stocks of any subsidiary or associated undertaking of the Group; or (ii) any corporate interests in Standard Chartered PLC's ordinary shares

2   The beneficial interests of directors and connected persons in the ordinary shares of the Company are set out above. The executive directors do not have any non-beneficial interest in the Company's shares. Neither of the executive directors used ordinary shares as collateral for any loans

3   The shares held beneficially include shares awarded to deliver the share element of executive directors' salary prior to 1 April 2025, when part of salary was delivered in shares. Since this date, all salary is delivered in cash

4   88 per cent of the 2022-2024 LTIP award is no longer subject to performance measures due to achievement against 2022-2024 RoTE, relative TSR and strategic measures

5   As Bill and Diego are UK taxpayers, 47 per cent tax is assumed to apply to other unvested share awards (marginal combined PAYE rate of income tax at 45 per cent and employee National Insurance contributions at 2 per cent) - rates may change

E. Share price information

The middle market price of an ordinary share at the close of business on 30 June 2025 was 1,207.0 pence. The share price range during the first half of 2025 was 878.8 pence to 1,269.0 pence (based on the closing middle market prices).

F. Free float percentage

At 30 June 2025, the free float percentage of voting rights attached to all of the Company's listed ordinary and preference shares in issue was approximately 99.87 per cent.

For information on the outstanding Fixed Rate Resetting Perpetual Subordinated Contingent Convertible AT1 securities
issued by Standard Chartered PLC and the rights attached to them and further information on our website at www.sc.com/en/investors/credit-ratings-fixed-income/capital-securities-in-issue/.

G. Substantial shareholders

The Company and its shareholders have been granted partial exemption from the disclosure requirements under Part XV of the Securities and Futures Ordinance (SFO). As a result of this exemption, shareholders no longer have an obligation under Part XV of the SFO (other than Divisions 5, 11 and 12 thereof) to notify the Company of substantial shareholding interests, and the Company is no longer required to maintain a register of interests of substantial shareholders under section 336 of the SFO. The Company is, however, required to file with The Stock Exchange of Hong Kong Limited any disclosure of interests made in the UK.

H. Code for Financial Reporting Disclosures

The UK Finance Code for Financial Reporting Disclosure (the Code) sets out five disclosure principles together with supporting guidance. The principles are that UK banks will: provide high-quality, meaningful and decision-useful disclosures; review and enhance their financial instrument disclosures for key areas of interest; keep under review and commit to ongoing re-evaluation and enhancement of financial instrument disclosures for key areas of interest, acknowledging the importance of good practice recommendations and similar guidance issued from time to time by relevant regulators and standard-setters and assessing the applicability and relevance of such guidance to disclosures; seek to enhance the comparability of financial statement disclosures across the UK banking sector; and clearly differentiate in their annual reports between information that is audited and information that is unaudited.

The Group's interim financial statements for the six months ended 30 June 2025 have been prepared in accordance with the Code's principles.



- page 116 -


 

I. Employees

The details regarding our remuneration policies, bonus schemes and training schemes have not materially changed from our 2024 Annual Report and Accounts and we will be updating these in the 2025 Annual Report.

Employee headcount

The following table summarises the number of employees within the Group:


Business1

Support services2

Total3,4

At 30 June 2025

29,613

51,082

80,695

At 31 December 2024

29,563

51,582

81,145

1   Business is defined as employees directly under the remit of the businesses

2   Support services include employees who support businesses' operations or investments where costs are fully recharged to the businesses. Decrease in support services H1 in 2025 is mainly due to decrease in technology and operations support resources as tighter hiring controls are in place and we continue to review our workforce composition and skills' 

3   Excludes 498 employees (headcount) from Digital Ventures entities (Appro, Audax, Cashenable/Labamu, Furaha, Letsbloom, Libeara, MyZoi, Qatalyst, Solv Ghana, Solv Kenya, TASConnect, Zodia Custody, Zodia Markets)

4   Includes employees operating in discontinued/restructured businesses



- page 117 -


 

Shareholder information

Dividend and interest payment dates

Ordinary shares

 2025 interim dividend (cash only)

Results and dividend announced

31 July 2025

Ex-dividend date

7 (UK) 6 (HK) August 2025

Record date

8 August 2025

Last date to amend currency election instructions for cash dividend*

5 September 2025

Dividend payment date

30 September 2025

*   in either US dollars, sterling, or Hong Kong dollars


 2025 final dividend (provisional only)

Results and dividend announcement date

 24 February 2026

 

Preference shares

 Second half-yearly dividend

7 3/8 per cent non-cumulative irredeemable preference shares of £1 each

1 October 2025

8 ¼ per cent non-cumulative irredeemable preference shares of £1 each

1 October 2025

6.409 per cent non-cumulative preference shares of $5 each

30 July 2025 and 30 October 2025

7.014 per cent non-cumulative preference shares of $5 each

30 July 2025

Further details regarding dividends can be found on our website at www.sc.com/shareholders.

ShareCare

ShareCare is available to shareholders on the Company's UK register who have a UK address and bank account. It allows you to hold your Standard Chartered PLC shares in a nominee account. Your shares will be held in electronic form so you will no longer have to worry about keeping your share certificates safe. If you join ShareCare, you will still be invited to attend the Company's AGM and you will receive any dividend paid at the same time as everyone else. ShareCare is free to join and there are no annual fees to pay. If you would like to receive more information, please visit our website at www.sc.com/sharecare or contact the shareholder helpline on 0370 702 0138.

Donating shares to ShareGift

Shareholders who have a small number of shares often find it uneconomical to sell them. An alternative is to consider donating them to the charity ShareGift (registered charity 1052686), which collects donations of unwanted shares until there are enough to sell and uses the proceeds to support UK charities. There is no implication for capital gains tax (no gain or loss) when you donate shares to charity, and UK taxpayers may be able to claim income tax relief on the value of their donation. Further information can be obtained from the Company's registrars or from ShareGift on 020 7930 3737 or from
www.sharegift.org.

Bankers' Automated Clearing System (BACS)

Dividends can be paid straight into your bank or building society account. Please register online at www.investorcentre.co.uk or contact our registrar for a mandate form.

Registrars and shareholder enquiries

If you have any enquiries relating to your shareholding and you hold your shares on the UK register, please contact our registrar at www.investorcentre.co.uk/contactus. Alternatively, please contact Computershare Investor Services PLC, The Pavilions, Bridgwater Road, Bristol, BS99 6ZZ or call the shareholder helpline number on 0370 702 0138.

If you hold your shares on the Hong Kong branch register and you have enquiries, please contact Computershare Hong Kong Investor Services Limited, 17M Floor, Hopewell Centre, 183 Queen's Road East, Wan Chai, Hong Kong. You can check your shareholding at: computershare.com/hk/investors.



- page 118 -


 

Chinese translation

If you would like a Chinese version of this Half Year Report, please contact: Computershare Hong Kong Investor Services Limited at 17M Floor, Hopewell Centre, 183 Queen's Road East, Wan Chai, Hong Kong.

本半年報告之中文譯本可向香港中央證券登記有限公司索取,地址:香港灣仔皇后大道東183號合和中心17M樓。

Shareholders on the Hong Kong branch register who have asked to receive corporate communications in either Chinese or English can change this election by contacting Computershare. If there is a dispute between any translation and the English version of this Half Year Report, the English text shall prevail.

Electronic communications

If you hold your shares on the UK register and in future you would like to receive the Half Year Report electronically rather than by post, please register online at: investorcentre.co.uk. Click on 'register now' and follow the instructions. You will need to have your shareholder or ShareCare reference number to hand. You can find this on your share certificate or ShareCare statement. Once you have registered and confirmed your email communication preference, you will receive future notifications via email enabling you to submit your proxy vote online. In addition, as a member of Investor Centre, you will be able to manage your shareholding online and change your bank mandate or address information.



- page 119 -


 

Important notices

Forward-looking statements

The information included in this document may contain 'forward-looking statements' based upon current expectations or beliefs as well as statements formulated with assumptions about future events. Forward-looking statements include, without limitation, projections, estimates, commitments, plans, approaches, ambitions and targets (including, without limitation, ESG commitments, ambitions and targets). Forward-looking statements often use words such as 'may', 'could', 'will', 'expect', 'intend', 'estimate', 'anticipate', 'believe', 'plan', 'seek', 'aim', 'continue' or other words of similar meaning to any of the foregoing. Forward-looking statements may also (or additionally) be identified by the fact that they do not relate only to historical or current facts.

By their very nature, forward-looking statements are subject to known and unknown risks and uncertainties and other factors that could cause actual results, and the Group's plans and objectives, to differ materially from those expressed or implied in the forward-looking statements. Readers should not place reliance on, and are cautioned about relying on, any forward-looking statements.

There are several factors which could cause the Group's actual results and its plans and objectives to differ materially from those expressed or implied in forward-looking statements. The factors include (but are not limited to): changes in global, political, economic, business, competitive and market forces or conditions, or in future exchange and interest rates; changes in environmental, geopolitical, social or physical risks; legal, regulatory and policy developments, including regulatory measures addressing climate change and broader sustainability-related issues; the development of standards and interpretations, including evolving requirements and practices in ESG reporting; the ability of the Group, together with governments and other stakeholders to measure, manage, and mitigate the impacts of climate change and broader sustainability-related issues effectively; risks arising out of health crises and pandemics; risks of cyber attacks, data, information or security breaches or technology failures involving the Group; changes in tax rates or policy; future business combinations or dispositions; and other factors specific to the Group, including those identified in Standard Chartered PLC's Annual Report and the financial statements of the Group. To the extent that any forward-looking statements contained in this document are based on past or current trends and/or activities of the Group, they should not be taken as a representation that such trends or activities will continue in the future.

No statement in this document is intended to be, nor should be interpreted as, a profit forecast or to imply that the earnings of the Group for the current year or future years will necessarily match or exceed the historical or published earnings of the Group. Each forward-looking statement speaks only as of the date that it is made. Except as required by any applicable laws or regulations, the Group expressly disclaims any obligation to revise or update any forward-looking statement contained within this document, regardless of whether those statements are affected as a result of new information, future events or otherwise.

Please refer to Standard Chartered PLC's Annual Report and the financial statements of the Group for a discussion of certain of the risks and factors that could adversely impact the Group's actual results, and cause its plans and objectives to differ materially from those expressed or implied in any forward-looking statements.

Non-IFRS performance measures and alternative performance measures

This document may contain: (a) financial measures and ratios not specifically defined under: (i) International Financial Reporting Standards (IFRS) (Accounting Standards) as adopted by the European Union; or (ii) UK-adopted International Accounting Standards (IAS); and/or (b) alternative performance measures as defined in the European Securities and Market Authority guidelines. Such measures may exclude certain items which management believes are not representative of the underlying performance of the business and which distort period-on-period comparison. These measures are not a substitute for IAS or IFRS measures and are based on a number of assumptions that are subject to uncertainties and change. Please refer to Standard Chartered PLC's Annual Report and the financial statements of the Group for further information, including reconciliations between the underlying and reported measures.

Financial instruments

Nothing in this document shall constitute, in any jurisdiction, an offer or solicitation to sell or purchase any securities or other financial instruments, nor shall it constitute a recommendation or advice in respect of any securities or other financial instruments or any other matter.



- page 120 -


 

Caution regarding climate and environment-related information

Some of the climate and environment-related information in this document is subject to certain limitations, and therefore the reader should treat the information provided, as well as conclusions, projections and assumptions drawn from such information, with caution. The information may be limited due to a number of factors, which include (but are not limited to): a lack of reliable data; a lack of standardisation of data; and future uncertainty. The information includes externally sourced data that may not have been verified. Furthermore, some of the data, models and methodologies used to create the information is subject to adjustment which is beyond our control, and the information is subject to change without notice.

General

You are advised to exercise your own independent judgement (with the advice of your professional advisers as necessary) with respect to the risks and consequences of any matter contained in this document. The Group, its affiliates, directors, officers, employees or agents expressly disclaim any liability and responsibility for any decisions or actions which you may take and for any damage or losses you may suffer from your use of or reliance on the information contained in this document.



- page 121 -


 

Glossary

Absolute financed emissions

A measurement of our attributed share of our clients' greenhouse gas emissions.

Additional Tier 1 capital (AT1)

Additional Tier 1 capital consists of instruments other than Common Equity Tier 1 that meet the Capital Requirements Regulation (as it forms part of UK domestic law) criteria for inclusion in Tier 1 capital.

Additional value adjustment (AVA)

See Prudent valuation adjustment.

Advanced Internal Rating Based (AIRB) approach

The AIRB approach under the Basel framework is used to calculate credit risk capital based on the Group's own estimates of prudential parameters.

Alternative performance measures (APM)

A financial measure of historical or future financial performance, financial position, or cash flows, other than a financial measure defined or specified in the applicable financial reporting framework.

Assets under management (AUM)

Total market value of assets such as deposits, securities and funds held by the Group on behalf of the clients.

Associate of South East Asian Nations (ASEAN)

Includes the Group's operations in Brunei, Indonesia, Malaysia, Philippines, Singapore, Thailand and Vietnam.

Basel III

The global regulatory standards on capital adequacy and liquidity developed by the Basel Committee on Banking Supervision (BCBS) in response to the financial crisis of 2007-2009. It was originally issued in December 2010 and finalised in December 2017. The standards have been in the process of being phased into UK policy since 2022.

Basel Committee on Banking Supervision (BCBS)

A forum on banking supervisory matters which develops global supervisory standards for the banking industry. Its members are officials from 45 central banks or prudential supervisors from 27 countries and territories.

Basic earnings per share (EPS)

Represents earnings divided by the basic weighted average number of shares.

Basis point (bps)

One hundredth of a per cent (0.01 per cent); 100 basis points is 1 per cent.

Capital-lite income

Income derived from products with low risk-weighted asset consumption or products which are non-funding in nature.

CRD or Capital Requirements Directive

A capital adequacy legislative package adopted by the Prudential Regulation Authority. CRD comprises the Capital Requirements Directive and the UK onshored Capital Requirements Regulation (CRR). The package implements the Basel III framework together with transitional arrangements for some of its requirements. CRD IV came into force on 1 January 2014. The EU CRR II and CRD V amending the existing package came into force in June 2019 with most changes starting to apply from 28 June 2021. Only those parts of the EU CRR II that applied on or before 31 December 2020, when the UK was a member of the EU, have been implemented. The PRA recently finalised the UK's version of the CRR II for implementation on 1 January 2022.

Capital resources

Sum of Tier 1 and Tier 2 capital after regulatory adjustments.

- page 122 -


 

CGU or Cash-generating unit

The smallest identifiable group of assets that generates cash inflows that are largely independent of the cash inflows from other assets or groups of assets.

Cash shortfall

The difference between the cash flows that are due in accordance with the contractual terms of the instrument and the cash flows that the Group expects to receive over the contractual life of the instrument.

Clawback

An amount an individual is required to pay back to the Group, which has to be returned to the Group under certain circumstances.

Commercial real estate

Includes office buildings, industrial property, medical centres, hotels, malls, retail stores, shopping centres, farm land, multi-family housing buildings, warehouses, garages, and industrial properties. Commercial real estate loans are those backed by a package of commercial real estate assets.

Common Equity Tier 1 capital (CET1)

Common Equity Tier 1 capital consists of the common shares issued by the Group and related share premium, retained earnings, accumulated other comprehensive income and other disclosed reserves, eligible non-controlling interests and regulatory adjustments required in the calculation of Common Equity Tier 1.

CET1 ratio

A measure of the Group's CET1 capital as a percentage of risk-weighted assets.

Contractual maturity

Contractual maturity refers to the final payment date of a loan or other financial instrument, at which point all the remaining outstanding principal and interest is due to be paid.

Countercyclical capital buffer

The countercyclical capital buffer (CCyB) is part of a set of macroprudential instruments, designed to help counter procyclicality in the financial system. CCyB as defined in the Basel III standard provides for an additional capital requirement of up to 2.5 per cent of risk-weighted assets in a given jurisdiction. The Bank of England's Financial Policy Committee has the power to set the CCyB rate for the United Kingdom. Each bank must calculate its 'institution-specific' CCyB rate, defined as the weighted average of the CCyB rates in effect across the jurisdictions in which it has credit exposures. The institution-specific CCyB rate is then applied to a bank's total risk-weighted assets.

Counterparty credit risk

The risk that a counterparty defaults before satisfying its obligations under a derivative, a securities financing transaction (SFT) or a similar contract.

Credit conversion factor (CCF)

An estimate of the amount the Group expects a customer to have drawn further on a facility limit at the point of default. This is either prescribed by CRR or modelled by the bank.

Credit default swaps (CDS)

A credit derivative is an arrangement whereby the credit risk of an asset (the reference asset) is transferred from the buyer to the seller of protection. A credit default swap is a contract where the protection seller receives premium or interest-related payments in return for contracting to make payments to the protection buyer upon a defined credit event. Credit events normally include bankruptcy, payment default on a reference asset or assets, or downgrades by a rating agency.

Credit institutions

An institution whose business is to receive deposits or other repayable funds from the public and to grant credits for its own account.

- page 123 -


 

Credit risk mitigation

Credit risk mitigation is a process to mitigate potential credit losses from any given account, customer or portfolio by using a range of tools such as collateral, netting agreements, credit insurance, credit derivatives and guarantees.

Credit valuation adjustments (CVA)

An adjustment to the fair value of derivative contracts that reflects the possibility that the counterparty may default such that the Group would not receive the full market value of the contracts.

Customer accounts

Money deposited by all individuals and companies which are not credit institutions including securities sold under repurchase agreement (see repo/reverse repo). Such funds are recorded as liabilities in the Group's balance sheet under customer accounts.

Days past due

One or more days that interest and/or principal payments are overdue based on the contractual terms.

Debit valuation adjustment (DVA)

An adjustment to the fair value of derivative contracts that reflects the possibility that the Group may default and not pay the full market value of contracts.

Debt securities

Debt securities are assets on the Group's balance sheet and represent certificates of indebtedness of credit institutions, public bodies or other undertakings, excluding those issued by central banks.

Debt securities in issue

Debt securities in issue are transferable certificates of indebtedness of the Group to the bearer of the certificate. These are liabilities of the Group and include certificates of deposits.

Default

Financial assets in default represent those that are at least 90 days past due in respect of principal or interest and/or where the assets are otherwise considered to be unlikely to pay, including those that are credit-impaired.

Deferred tax asset (DTA)

Income taxes recoverable in future periods in respect of deductible temporary differences between the accounting and tax base of an asset or liability that will result in tax deductible amounts in future periods, the carry-forward of tax losses or the carry-forward of unused tax credits.

Deferred tax liability (DTL)

Income taxes payable in future periods in respect of taxable temporary differences between the accounting and tax base of an asset or liability that will result in taxable amounts in future periods.

Defined benefit obligation

The present value of expected future payments required to settle the obligations of a defined benefit scheme resulting from employee service.

Defined benefit scheme

Pension or other post-retirement benefit scheme other than a defined contribution scheme.

Defined contribution scheme

A pension or other post-retirement benefit scheme where the employer's obligation is limited to its contributions to the fund.

Delinquency

A debt or other financial obligation is considered to be in a state of delinquency when payments are overdue. Loans and advances are considered to be delinquent when consecutive payments are missed. Also known as arrears.

- page 124 -


 

Deposits by banks

Deposits by banks comprise amounts owed to other domestic or foreign credit institutions by the Group including securities sold under repo.

Diluted earnings per share

Represents earnings divided by the weighted average number of shares that would have been outstanding assuming the conversion of all dilutive potential ordinary shares.

Dividend per share

Represents the entitlement of each shareholder in the share of the profits of the Company. Calculated in the lowest unit of currency in which the shares are quoted.

Early alert, purely and non-purely precautionary

A borrower's account which exhibits risks or potential weaknesses of a material nature requiring closer monitoring, supervision, or attention by management. Weaknesses in such a borrower's account, if left uncorrected, could result in deterioration of repayment prospects and the likelihood of being downgraded to credit grade 12 or worse. When an account is on early alert, it is classified as either purely precautionary or non-purely precautionary. A purely precautionary account is one that exhibits early alert characteristics, but these do not present any imminent credit concern. If the symptoms present an imminent credit concern, an account will be considered for classification as non-purely precautionary.

Effective tax rate

The tax on profit/(losses) on ordinary activities as a percentage of profit/(loss) on ordinary activities before taxation.

Encumbered assets

On-balance sheet assets pledged or used as collateral in respect of certain of the Group's liabilities.

ESG

Environmental, Social and Governance.

European Union

The European Union is a political and economic union of 27 member states that are located primarily in Europe.

Eurozone

Represents the 19 EU countries that have adopted the euro as their common currency.

Expected credit loss (ECL)

Represents the present value of expected cash shortfalls over the residual term of a financial asset, undrawn commitment or financial guarantee. This comprises ECL generated by the models, management judgements and individually assessed credit impairment provisions.

Expected loss (EL)

The Group measure of anticipated loss for exposures captured under an internal ratings-based credit risk approach for capital adequacy calculations. It is measured as the Group-modelled view of anticipated loss based on probability of default, loss given default and exposure at default, with a one-year time horizon.

Exposures

Credit exposures represent the amount lent to a customer, together with any undrawn commitments.

Exposure at default (EAD)

The estimation of the extent to which the Group may be exposed to a customer or counterparty in the event of, and at the time of, that counterparty's default. At default, the customer may not have drawn the loan fully or may already have repaid some of the principal, so that exposure is typically less than the approved loan limit.



- page 125 -


 

External Credit Assessment Institution (ECAI)

External credit ratings are used to assign risk-weights under the standardised approach for sovereigns, corporates and institutions. The external ratings are from credit rating agencies that are registered or certified in accordance with the credit rating agencies regulation or from a central bank issuing credit ratings, which is exempt from the application of this regulation.

Financial Conduct Authority (FCA)

The Financial Conduct Authority regulates the conduct of financial firms and, for certain firms, prudential standards in the UK. It has a strategic objective to ensure that the relevant markets function well.

Forbearance

Forbearance takes place when a concession is made to the contractual terms of a loan in response to an obligor's financial difficulties. The Group classifies such modified loans as either 'Forborne - not impaired loans' or 'Loans subject to forbearance - impaired'. Once a loan is categorised as either of these, it will remain in one of these two categories until the loan matures or satisfies the 'curing' conditions described in Note 8 to the financial statements in the 2024 Annual Report.

Forborne - not impaired loans

Loans where the contractual terms have been modified due to financial difficulties of the borrower, but the loan is not considered to be impaired. See 'Forbearance'.

Funded/unfunded exposures

Exposures where the notional amount of the transaction is funded or unfunded. Represents exposures where a commitment to provide future funding is made but funds have been released/not released.

Funding valuation adjustment (FVA)

FVA reflects an adjustment to fair value in respect of derivative contracts that reflects the funding costs that the market participant would incorporate when determining an exit price.

G-SIB buffer

A CET1 capital buffer which results from designation as a G-SIB. The G-SIB buffer is between 1 per cent and 3.5 per cent, depending on the allocation to one of five buckets based on the annual scoring. In the UK, the G-SIB buffer is implemented via the CRD as Global Systemically Important Institutions (G-SII) buffer requirement.

Global Systemically Important Banks (G-SIBs)

Global banking financial institutions whose size, complexity and systemic interconnectedness mean that their distress or failure would cause significant disruption to the wider financial system and economic activity. The list of G-SIBs is assessed under a framework established by the Financial Stability Board (FSB) and the BCBS. In the UK, the G-SIB framework is implemented via the CRD and G-SIBs are referred to as Global Systemically Important Institutions (G-SIIs).

Green and Sustainable Product Framework

Sets out underlying eligible qualifying themes and activities that may be considered ESG. This has been developed with the support of external experts, and has been informed by industry and supervisory principles and standards such as the Green Bond Principles and EU Taxonomy for sustainable activities.

Interest Rate Risk

The risk of an adverse impact on the Group's income statement due to changes in interest rates.

Internal model approach

The approach used to calculate market risk capital and risk-weighted assets with an internal market risk model approved by the Prudential Regulation Authority under the terms of CRD/CRR.


- page 126 -


 

Internal ratings-based approach (IRB)

Risk-weighting methodology in accordance with the Basel Capital Accord where capital requirements are based on a firm's own estimates of prudential parameters.

International Accounting Standard (IAS)

A standard that forms part of the International Financial Reporting Standards framework.

International Accounting Standards Board (IASB)

An independent standard-setting body responsible for the development and publication of IFRS, and approving interpretations of IFRS that are recommended by the IFRS Interpretations Committee (IFRIC).

International Financial Reporting Standards (IFRS)

A set of international accounting standards developed and issued by the International Accounting Standards Board, consisting of principles-based guidance contained within IFRS and IAS. All companies that have issued publicly traded securities in the EU are required to prepare annual and interim reports under IFRS and IAS that have been endorsed by the EU.

IFRIC

The IFRS Interpretations Committee supports the IASB in providing authoritative guidance on the accounting treatment of issues not specifically dealt with by existing IFRS and IAS.

Investment grade

A debt security, treasury bill or similar instrument with a credit rating measured by external agencies of AAA to BBB.

Leverage ratio

A ratio introduced under CRD IV that compares Tier 1 capital to total exposures, including certain exposures held off-balance sheet as adjusted by stipulated credit conversion factors. Intended to be a simple, non-risk-based backstop measure.

Liquidation portfolio

A portfolio of assets which is beyond our current risk appetite metrics and is held for liquidation.

Liquidity coverage ratio (LCR)

The ratio of the stock of high-quality liquid assets to expected net cash outflows over the following 30 days. High-quality liquid assets should be unencumbered, liquid in markets during a time of stress and, ideally, be central bank eligible.

Loan exposure

Loans and advances to customers reported on the balance sheet held at amortised cost or FVOCI, non-cancellable credit commitments and cancellable credit commitments for credit cards and overdraft facilities.

Loans and advances to banks

Drawn amounts loaned to credit institutions including securities bought under Reverse repo.

Loans and advances to customers

This represents drawn lending made under bilateral agreements with customers entered into in the normal course of business and is based on the legal form of the instrument.

Loans past due

Loans on which payments have been due for up to a maximum of 90 days including those on which partial payments are being made.


- page 127 -


 

Loans subject to forbearance - impaired

Loans where the terms have been renegotiated on terms not consistent with current market levels due to financial difficulties of the borrower. Loans in this category are necessarily impaired. See 'Forbearance'.

Loan-to-value ratio (LTV)

A calculation which expresses the amount of a first mortgage lien as a percentage of the total appraised value of real property. The loan-to-value ratio is used in determining the appropriate level of risk for the loan and therefore the correct price of the loan to the borrower.

Loss given default (LGD)

The percentage of an exposure that a lender expects to lose in the event of obligor default.

Loss rate

Uses an adjusted gross charge-off rate, developed using monthly write-off and recoveries over the preceding 12 months and total outstanding balances.

Malus

An arrangement that permits the Group to prevent vesting of all or part of the amount of an unvested variable remuneration award, due to a specific crystallised risk, behaviour, conduct or adverse performance outcome.

Master netting agreement

An agreement between two counterparties that have multiple derivative contracts with each other that provides for the net settlement of all contracts through a single payment, in a single currency, in the event of default on, or termination of, any one contract.

Mezzanine capital

Financing that combines debt and equity characteristics. For example, a loan that also confers some profit participation to the lender.

Minimum requirement for own funds and eligible liabilities (MREL)

A requirement under the Bank Recovery and Resolution Directive for EU resolution authorities to set a minimum requirement for own funds and eligible liabilities for banks, implementing the FSB's Total Loss Absorbing Capacity (TLAC) standard. MREL is intended to ensure that there is sufficient equity and specific types of liabilities to facilitate an orderly resolution that minimises any impact on financial stability and ensures the continuity of critical functions and avoids exposing taxpayers to loss.

Net asset value (NAV) per share

Ratio of net assets (total assets less total liabilities) to the number of ordinary shares outstanding at the end of a reporting period.

Net interest income (NII)

The difference between interest received on assets and interest paid on liabilities.

Net stable funding ratio (NSFR)

The ratio of available stable funding to required stable funding over a one-year time horizon, assuming a stressed scenario. It is a longer-term liquidity measure designed to restrain the amount of wholesale borrowing and encourage stable funding over a one-year time horizon.

Net zero

The commitment to reaching net zero carbon emissions from our operations by 2025 and from our financing by 2050.


- page 128 -


 

Non-linearity

Non-linearity of expected credit loss occurs when the average of expected credit loss for a portfolio is higher than the base case (median) due to the fact that bad economic environment could have a larger impact on ECL calculation than good economic environment.

Non-performing loans (NPLs)

An NPL is any loan that is more than 90 days past due or is otherwise individually impaired. All NPLs are reported as part of Stage 3.

Normalised items

Refer 'Underlying/Normalised' in the Alternative performance measures section.

Operating expenses

Staff and premises costs, general and administrative expenses, depreciation and amortisation. Underlying operating expenses exclude expenses as described in 'Underlying earnings'. A reconciliation between underlying and reported earnings is contained in Note 2 to the financial statements.

Operating income or operating profit

Net interest, net fee and net trading income, as well as other operating income. Underlying operating income represents the income line items above, on an underlying basis. See 'Underlying earnings'.

Over-the-counter (OTC) derivatives

A bilateral transaction (e.g. derivatives) that is not exchange traded and that is valued using valuation models.

Own credit adjustment (OCA)

An adjustment to the Group's issued debt designated at fair value through profit or loss that reflects the possibility that the Group may default and not pay the full market value of the contracts.

Physical risks

The risk of increased extreme weather events including flood, drought and sea level rise.

Pillar 1

The first pillar of the three pillars of the Basel framework which provides the approach to calculation of the minimum capital requirements for credit, market and operational risk. Minimum capital requirements are 8 per cent of the Group's risk-weighted assets.

Pillar 2

The second pillar of the three pillars of the Basel framework which requires banks to undertake a comprehensive assessment of their risks and to determine the appropriate amounts of capital to be held against these risks where other suitable mitigants are not available.

Pillar 3

The third pillar of the three pillars of the Basel framework which aims to provide a consistent and comprehensive disclosure framework that enhances comparability between banks and further promotes improvements in risk practices.

Priority Banking

Priority Banking customers are individuals who have met certain criteria for deposits, AUM, mortgage loans or monthly payroll. Criteria varies by country.


- page 129 -


 

Private equity investments

Equity securities in operating companies generally not quoted on a public exchange. Investment in private equity often involves the investment of capital in private companies. Capital for private equity investment is raised by retail or institutional investors and used to fund investment strategies such as leveraged buyouts, venture capital, growth capital, distressed investments and mezzanine capital.

Probability of default (PD)

PD is an internal estimate for each borrower grade of the likelihood that an obligor will default on an obligation over a given time horizon.

Probability weighted

Obtained by considering the values the metric can assume, weighted by the probability of each value occurring.

Profit (loss) attributable to ordinary shareholders

Profit (loss) for the year after non-controlling interests and dividends declared in respect of preference shares classified as equity.

Prudent valuation adjustment (PVA)

An adjustment to CET1 capital to reflect the difference between fair value and prudent value positions, where the application of prudence results in a lower absolute carrying value than recognised in the financial statements.

Prudential Regulation Authority (PRA)

The Prudential Regulation Authority is the statutory body responsible for the prudential supervision of banks, building societies, credit unions, insurers and a small number of significant investment firms in the UK. The PRA is a part of the Bank of England.

Regulatory consolidation

The regulatory consolidation of Standard Chartered PLC differs from the statutory consolidation in that it includes Akashaverse Pte. Ltd, ASCENTA IV, CFZ Holding Limited and its subsidiaries, Global Digital Asset Holdings Limited, Olea Global Pte. Ltd and its subsidiaries, Partior Holdings Pte. Ltd, SBI Zodia Custody Co. Ltd, Seychelles International Mercantile Banking Corporation Limited, and Vault22 Solutions Holdings Ltd on a proportionate consolidation basis. These entities are equity consolidated for statutory accounting purposes.

The regulatory consolidation further excludes the following entities, which are consolidated for statutory accounting purposes: Appro marketing solutions L.L.C, Audax Financial Technology Pte. Ltd, Furaha Finserve Uganda Limited, Letsbloom India Private Limited, Letsbloom Pte. Ltd , PointSource Technologies Pte. Ltd, PT Labamu Sejahtera Indonesia, Qatalyst Pte. Ltd, Qlarion Ltd, Regwise Ltd, SCV Research and Development Pte. Ltd., SCV Research and Development Pvt. Ltd., Solv Vietnam Company Limited, Solvezy Technology Ghana Ltd, Solvezy Technology Kenya Ltd, Standard Chartered Assurance Limited, Standard Chartered Bancassurance Intermediary Limited, Standard Chartered Bank Insurance Agency (Proprietary) Limited, Standard Chartered Botswana Education Trust, Standard Chartered Isle of Man Limited , TASConnect (Hong Kong) Private Limited, TASConnect (Malaysia) Sdn. Bhd, and TASConnect (Shanghai) Financial Technology Pte. Ltd.

Repo/reverse repo

A repurchase agreement or repo is a short-term funding agreement, which allows a borrower to sell a financial asset, such as asset-backed securities or government bonds as collateral for cash. As part of the agreement the borrower agrees to repurchase the security at some later date, usually less than 30 days, repaying the proceeds of the loan. For the party on the other end of the transaction (buying the security and agreeing to sell in the future), it is a reverse repurchase agreement or reverse repo.

Residential mortgage

A loan to purchase a residential property which is then used as collateral to guarantee repayment of the loan. The borrower gives the lender a lien against the property, and the lender can foreclose on the property if the borrower does not repay the loan per the agreed terms. Also known as a home loan.

- page 130 -


 

Return on risk-weighted assets (RoRWA)

Profit before tax for year as a percentage of RWA. Profit may be statutory or underlying and is specified where used.

See 'RWA' and 'Underlying earnings'.

Revenue-based carbon intensity

A measurement of the quantity of greenhouse gases emitted by our clients per USD of their revenue.

Risk-weighted assets (RWA)

A measure of a bank's assets adjusted for their associated risks, expressed as a percentage of an exposure value in accordance with the applicable standardised or IRB approach provisions.

Risks not in VaR (RNIV)

A framework for identifying and quantifying marginal types of market risk that are not captured in the Value at Risk (VaR) measure for any reason, such as being a far-tail risk, or the necessary historical market data not being available.

Roll rate

Uses a matrix that gives average loan migration rate from delinquency states from period to period. A matrix multiplication is then performed to generate the final PDs by delinquency bucket over different time horizons.

Scope 1 emissions

Arise from the consumption of energy from direct sources during the use of property occupied by the Group. On-site combustion of fuels such as diesel, liquefied petroleum gas and natural gas is recorded using meters or, where metering is not available, collated from fuel vendor invoices. Emissions from the combustion of fuel in Group-operated transportation devices, as well as fugitive emissions, are excluded as being immaterial.

Scope 2 emissions

Arise from the consumption of indirect sources of energy during the use of property occupied by the Group. Energy generated off-site in the form of purchased electricity, heat, steam or cooling is collected as kilowatt hours consumed using meters or, where metering is not available, collated from vendor invoices. For leased properties we include all indirect and direct sources of energy consumed by building services (among other activities) within the space occupied by the Group. This can include base building services under landlord control but over which we typically hold a reasonable degree of influence. All data centre facilities with conditioning systems and hardware remaining under the operational control of the Group are included in the reporting. This does not include energy used at outsourced data centre facilities which are captured under Scope 3.

Scope 3 emissions

Occur as a consequence of the Group's activities but arising from sources not controlled by the Group. Business air travel data is collected as person kilometres travelled by seating class by employees of the Group. Data is drawn from country operations that have processes in place to gather accurate employee air travel data from travel management companies. Flights are categorised as short, medium or long haul trips. Emissions from other potential Scope 3 sources such as electricity transmission and distribution line losses are not currently accounted for on the basis that they cannot be calculated with an acceptable level of reliability or consistency. The Group does however capture Scope 3 emissions from outsourced data centres managed by third parties.

Secured (fully and partially)

A secured loan is a loan in which the borrower pledges an asset as collateral for a loan which, in the event that the borrower defaults, the Group is able to take possession of. All secured loans are considered fully secured if the fair value of the collateral is equal to or greater than the loan at the time of origination. All other secured loans are considered to be partially secured.


- page 131 -


 

Securitisation

Securitisation is a process by which credit exposures are aggregated into a pool, which is used to back new securities.

Under traditional securitisation transactions, assets are sold to a structured entity which then issues new securities to investors at different levels of seniority (credit tranching). This allows the credit quality of the assets to be separated from the credit rating of the originating institution and transfers risk to external investors in a way that meets their risk appetite. Under synthetic securitisation transactions, the transfer of risk is achieved by the use of credit derivatives or guarantees, and the exposures being securitised remain exposures of the originating institution.

Senior debt

Debt that takes priority over other unsecured or otherwise more 'junior' debt owed by the issuer. Senior debt has greater seniority in the issuer's capital structure than subordinated debt. In the event the issuer goes bankrupt, senior debt theoretically must be repaid before other creditors receive any payment.

Significant increase in credit risk (SICR)

Assessed by comparing the risk of default of an exposure at the reporting date to the risk of default at origination (after considering the passage of time).

Solo

The solo regulatory group as defined in the Prudential Regulation Authority waiver letter dated 10 August 2020 differs from Standard Chartered Bank Company in that it includes the full consolidation of nine subsidiaries, namely Standard Chartered Holdings (International) B.V., Standard Chartered MB Holdings B.V., Standard Chartered UK Holdings Limited, Standard Chartered Grindlays PTY Limited, SCMB Overseas Limited, Standard Chartered Capital Management (Jersey) LLC, Cerulean Investments L.P., SC Ventures Innovation Investment L.P. and SC Ventures G.P. Limited.

Sovereign exposures

Exposures to central governments and central government departments, central banks and entities owned or guaranteed by the aforementioned. Sovereign exposures, as defined by the European Banking Authority, include only exposures to central governments.

Stage 1

Financial assets within the scope of IFRS 9 ECL that have not experienced a significant increase in credit risk since origination and impairment recognised on the basis of 12 months expected credit losses.

Stage 2

Financial assets within the scope of IFRS 9 ECL that have experienced a significant increase in credit risk since origination and impairment is recognised on the basis of lifetime expected credit losses.

Stage 3

Financial assets within the scope of IFRS 9 ECL that are in default and considered credit-impaired (non-performing loans).

Standardised approach

In relation to credit risk, a method for calculating credit risk capital requirements using External Credit Assessment Institution (ECAI) ratings and supervisory risk weights. In relation to operational risk, a method of calculating the operational capital requirement by the application of a supervisory defined percentage charge to the gross income of eight specified business lines.

Structured note

An investment tool which pays a return linked to the value or level of a specified asset or index and sometimes offers capital protection if the value declines. Structured notes can be linked to equities, interest rates, funds, commodities and foreign currency.

- page 132 -


 

Subordinated liabilities

Liabilities which, in the event of insolvency or liquidation of the issuer, are subordinated to the claims of depositors and other creditors of the issuer.

Sustainability aspirations

A series of targets and metrics by which we aim to promote social and economic development, and deliver sustainable outcomes in the areas in which we can make the most material contribution to the delivery of the UN Sustainable Development Goals.

Sustainable Finance assets

Assets from clients whose activities are aligned with the Green and Sustainable Product Framework and/or from transactions for which the use of proceeds will be utilised directly to contribute towards eligible themes and activities set out within the Green and Sustainable Product Framework.

Sustainable Finance revenue

Revenue from clients whose activities are aligned with the Green and Sustainable Product Framework and/or from transactions for which proceeds will be utilised directly to contribute towards eligible themes and activities set out within the Green and Sustainable Product Framework and/or from approved 'labelled' transactions such as any transaction referred to as 'green', 'social', 'sustainable', 'SDG (sustainable development goal) aligned', 'ESG', 'transition', 'COVID-19 facility' or 'COVID-19 response' which have been approved by the Sustainable Finance Governance Committee.

Tier 1 capital

The sum of Common Equity Tier 1 capital and Additional Tier 1 capital.

Tier 1 capital ratio

Tier 1 capital as a percentage of risk-weighted assets.

Tier 2 capital

Tier 2 capital comprises qualifying subordinated liabilities and related share premium accounts.

Total loss absorbing capacity (TLAC)

An international standard for TLAC issued by the FSB, which requires G-SIBs to have sufficient loss-absorbing and recapitalisation capacity available in resolution, to minimise impacts on financial stability, maintain the continuity of critical functions and avoid exposing public funds to loss.

Transition risks

The risk of changes to market dynamics or sectoral economics due to governments' response to climate change.

UK bank levy

A levy that applies to certain UK banks and the UK operations of foreign banks. The levy is payable each year based on a percentage of the chargeable equities and liabilities on the Group's UK tax resident entities' balance sheets. Key exclusions from chargeable equities and liabilities include Tier 1 capital, insured or guaranteed retail deposits, repos secured on certain sovereign debt and liabilities subject to netting.

Unbiased

Not overly optimistic or pessimistic, represents information that is not slanted, weighted, emphasised, de-emphasised or otherwise manipulated to increase the probability that the financial information will be received favourably or unfavourably by users.


- page 133 -


 

Unlikely to pay

Indications of unlikeliness to pay shall include: placing the credit obligation on non-accrued status; the recognition of a specific credit adjustment resulting from a significant perceived decline in credit quality subsequent to the Group taking on the exposure; selling the credit obligation at a material credit-related economic loss; the Group consenting to a distressed restructuring of the credit obligation where this is likely to result in a diminished financial obligation caused by the material forgiveness, or postponement, of principal, interest or, where relevant fees; filing for the obligor's bankruptcy or a similar order in respect of an obligor's credit obligation to the Group; the obligor has sought or has been placed in bankruptcy or similar protection where this would avoid or delay repayment of a credit obligation to the Group.

Value at Risk (VaR)

A quantitative measure of market risk estimating the potential loss that will not be exceeded in a set time period at a set statistical confidence level.

Value in Use (ViU)

The present value of the future expected cash flows expected to be derived from an asset or CGU.


- page 134 -


 

CONTACT INFORMATION

Global headquarters

Standard Chartered Group
1 Basinghall Avenue
London, EC2V 5DD
United Kingdom

telephone: +44 (0)20 7885 8888

Investor Relations

For further information, please contact:

Manus Costello, Global Head of Investor Relations
+44 (0) 20 7885 0017

Manus.Costello@sc.com

Shareholder enquiries

ShareCare information
website: sc.com/shareholders
helpline: +44 (0)370 702 0138

ShareGift information
website: ShareGift.org
helpline: +44 (0)20 7930 3737

Registrar information

UK

Computershare Investor Services PLC

The Pavilions
Bridgwater Road
Bristol, BS99 6ZZ

helpline: +44 (0)370 702 0138

Hong Kong

Computershare Hong Kong Investor Services Limited

17M Floor, Hopewell Centre
183 Queen's Road East
Wan Chai
Hong Kong

website: computershare.com/hk/investors

Chinese translation

Computershare Hong Kong Investor Services Limited

17M Floor, Hopewell Centre
183 Queen's Road East
Wan Chai
Hong Kong

Register for electronic communications

website: investorcentre.co.uk

 

LSE Stock code: STAN.LN
HKSE Stock code: 02888

- page 135 -


 

This information is provided by RNS, the news service of the London Stock Exchange. RNS is approved by the Financial Conduct Authority to act as a Primary Information Provider in the United Kingdom. Terms and conditions relating to the use and distribution of this information may apply. For further information, please contact rns@lseg.com or visit www.rns.com.

RNS may use your IP address to confirm compliance with the terms and conditions, to analyse how you engage with the information contained in this communication, and to share such analysis on an anonymised basis with others as part of our commercial services. For further information about how RNS and the London Stock Exchange use the personal data you provide us, please see our Privacy Policy.
 
END
 
 
IR DZGFNGMLGKZG